Symbol Technologies Water Dispenser MC9000 K User Manual

MC9000-K/S  
Product Reference Guide  
®
for Embedded Windows CE .NET  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET  
Product Reference Guide  
72-65262-03  
Revision A  
June 2004  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
© 2004 by Symbol Technologies, Inc. All rights reserved.  
No part of this publication may be reproduced or used in any form, or by any electrical or mechanical means,  
without permission in writing from Symbol. This includes electronic or mechanical means, such as  
photocopying, recording, or information storage and retrieval systems. The material in this manual is subject to  
change without notice.  
The software is provided strictly on an “as is” basis. All software, including firmware, furnished to the user is  
on a licensed basis. Symbol grants to the user a non-transferable and non-exclusive license to use each  
software or firmware program delivered hereunder (licensed program). Except as noted below, such license may  
not be assigned, sublicensed, or otherwise transferred by the user without prior written consent of Symbol. No  
right to copy a licensed program in whole or in part is granted, except as permitted under copyright law. The  
user shall not modify, merge, or incorporate any form or portion of a licensed program with other program  
material, create a derivative work from a licensed program, or use a licensed program in a network without  
written permission from Symbol. The user agrees to maintain Symbol’s copyright notice on the licensed  
programs delivered hereunder, and to include the same on any authorized copies it makes, in whole or in part.  
The user agrees not to decompile, disassemble, decode, or reverse engineer any licensed program delivered to  
the user or any portion thereof.  
Symbol reserves the right to make changes to any software or product to improve reliability, function, or design.  
Symbol does not assume any product liability arising out of, or in connection with, the application or use of any  
product, circuit, or application described herein.  
No license is granted, either expressly or by implication, estoppel, or otherwise under any Symbol Technologies,  
Inc., intellectual property rights. An implied license only exists for equipment, circuits, and subsystems  
contained in Symbol products.  
Symbol, Spectrum One, and Spectrum24 are registered trademarks of Symbol Technologies, Inc. Bluetooth is a  
registered trademark of Bluetooth SIG. Microsoft, Windows and ActiveSync are either registered trademarks  
or trademarks of Microsoft Corporation. Other product names mentioned in this manual may be trademarks or  
registered trademarks of their respective companies and are hereby acknowledged.  
Symbol Technologies, Inc.  
One Symbol Plaza  
Holtsville, New York 11742-1300  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Revision History  
Changes to the previous manual are listed below:  
Change  
-01 to -02  
Date  
1/15/04  
Description  
Updated Operating system to Win CE 4.2. Added new screens and menus,  
Chapter 2 and Chapter 3.  
Updated Chapter 6, to include Mobile Companion upgrade from version 3.9.1 to  
version 3.9.2.  
-02 to -03  
6/18/04  
Updated Chapter 3, to include new Bluetooth setup and to include new Power  
settings.  
Updated Chapter 6, to include additional Mobile Companion upgrades for version  
3.9.2.  
Added new VCD9000 Vehicle Cradle to Chapter 7, Accessories.  
Added new MDM9000 Modem Module to Chapter 7, Accessories.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Contents  
Chapter. About This Guide  
Chapter 1. Getting Started  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
vi  
MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Chapter 2. Operating the MC9000-K/S  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Contents  
vii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
viii  
MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Contents  
ix  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
x
MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Contents  
xi  
Chapter 6. Spectrum24 Network Configuration  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
xii  
MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Universal Battery Charger (UBC) Adapter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-42  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Contents  
xiii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
xiv  
MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Chapter 10. Mobile Computer Configuration  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Contents  
xv  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
xvi  
MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Appendix A. Technical Specifications  
Glossary  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
xviii MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
About This Guide xix  
Introduction  
The MC9000-K/S Product Reference Guide provides information about the MC9000-K and  
MC9000-S mobile computers using the Embedded Windows® CE .NET operating system and its  
accessories. The MC9000-K and MC9000-S includes the following variations:  
MC9000-K: Windows® CE operating system performs 1-dimensional bar code scanning  
with batch communication; memory configuration (32 or 64) MB ROM/(32 or 64) MB RAM;  
28-key, 43-key and 53-key interchangeable keypads; QVGA color touch panel display.  
MC9060-K: Windows® CE operating system performs 1-dimensional bar code scanning  
(models with an integrated laser scanner), or 1-dimensional and 2-dimensional bar code  
scanning (models with an integrated imager); 802.11b Spectrum24® wireless technology to  
perform wireless local area network (WLAN) communication; monochrome or QVGA color  
touch panel display; memory configuration (32 or 64) MB ROM/(32 or 64) MB RAM; 28-key,  
43-key and 53-key interchangeable keypads.  
MC9000-S: Windows® CE operating system performs 1-dimensional bar code scanning  
with batch communication; memory configuration (32 or 64) MB ROM/(32 or 64) MB RAM;  
28-key keypad; QVGA color touch panel display.  
MC9010-S: Windows® CE operating system performs 1-dimensional bar code scanning  
with integrated laser scanner; 802.11 Spectrum24® wireless technology to perform  
wireless local area network (WLAN) communication; memory configuration (32 or 64) MB  
ROM/(32 or 64) MB RAM; 28-key keypad; QVGA monochrome touch panel display.  
MC9060-S: Windows® CE operating system performs 1-dimensional bar code scanning  
with integrated laser scanner; 802.11b Spectrum24® wireless technology to perform  
wireless local area network (WLAN) communication; memory configuration (32 or 64) MB  
ROM/(32 or 64) MB RAM; 28-key keypad; monochrome or QVGA color touch panel display.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
xx MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Chapter Descriptions  
Topics covered in this guide are as follows:  
Chapter 1, Getting Started describes the mobile computer’s physical characteristics,  
explains how to install and charge the batteries, explains how to replace the strap lanyard,  
and explains how to start the mobile computer for the first time.  
Chapter 2, Operating the MC9000-K/S explains how to use the mobile computer. This  
includes instructions for powering on and resetting the mobile computer, entering and  
scanning.  
Chapter 3, Settings explains how to adjust settings on the mobile computer.  
Chapter 4, Communications explains how to use Microsoft® ActiveSync™ for  
communications between the mobile computer and host computer.  
Chapter 5, Applications explains how to use the installed applications.  
Chapter 6, Spectrum24 Network Configuration explains how to configure the Spectrum24  
wireless connection.  
Chapter 7, Accessories describes the mobile computer accessories, including setup and  
configuration.  
Chapter 8, Software Installation provides an overview of the Software Mobility Developer’s  
Kit (SMDK) installation and its uses.  
Chapter 9, AirBEAM Smart explains how to set up the mobile computer to synchronize with  
a server using the AirBEAM Smart Client and AirBEAM Staging applications.  
Chapter 10, Mobile Computer Configuration describes how to use the Terminal  
Configuration Manager (TCM) and describes how to use the Initial Program Loader (IPL).  
Chapter 11, Desktop Emulator provides instructions for installing the desktop emulator on  
the host computer and using the desktop emulator as an aid in developing applications.  
Chapter 12, Maintenance and Troubleshooting provides information on proper mobile  
computer maintenance and troubleshooting.  
Appendix A, Technical Specifications includes the technical specifications and connector pin  
outs for the mobile computer.  
Appendix B, Keypad Maps provides the keypad mapping information for the mobile  
computer.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
About This Guide xxi  
Notational Conventions  
The following conventions are used in this document:  
“Mobile computer” refers to any Symbol terminal.  
“User” refers to anyone using an application on the terminal.  
Italics are used to highlight the following:  
• chapters and sections in this and related documents  
• dialog box, window and screen names  
• drop-down list and list box names  
• check box and radio button names  
• icons on a screen.  
Bold text is used to highlight the following:  
• key names on a keypad  
• button names on a screen.  
Bullets (•) indicate:  
• action items  
• lists of alternatives  
• lists of required steps that are not necessarily sequential.  
Sequential lists (e.g., those that describe step-by-step procedures) appear as numbered  
lists.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
xxii MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Related Documents and Software  
The following documents provide more information about the MC9000-K and MC9000-S.  
MC9000-G Quick Start Guide (poster), p/n 72-63360-xx  
MC9000-G Licensing, Patent and Regulatory Information, p/n 72-65260-xx  
Windows CE Help File for Symbol Terminals, p/n 72E-38880-xx  
UBC 2000 Quick Reference Guide 70-33188-xx.  
Symbol Mobility Developer Kit for .NET (SMDK for .NET), available at:  
Symbol Windows CE SMDK for Series 9000, available at:  
eConnect software, available at: http://devzone.symbol.com  
ActiveSync software, available at the Microsoft web site:  
Service Information  
If you have a problem with your equipment, contact the Symbol Support Center for your region. See  
page xxiii for contact information. Before calling, have the model number, serial number and several  
of your bar code symbols at hand.  
Call the Support Center from a phone near the scanning equipment so that the service person can try  
to talk you through your problem. If the equipment is found to be working properly and the problem  
is symbol readability, the Support Center will request samples of your bar codes for analysis at our  
plant.  
If your problem cannot be solved over the phone, you may need to return your equipment for servicing.  
If that is necessary, you will be given specific directions.  
Symbol Technologies is not responsible for any damages incurred  
during shipment if the approved shipping container is not used.  
Shipping the units improperly can possibly void the warranty. If the  
original shipping container was not kept, contact Symbol to obtain a  
new shipping container.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
About This Guide xxiii  
Symbol Support Center  
For service information, warranty information or technical assistance contact or call the Symbol  
Support Center in:  
United States  
Canada  
Symbol Technologies, Inc.  
One Symbol Plaza  
Symbol Technologies Canada, Inc.  
2540 Matheson Boulevard East  
Holtsville, New York 11742-1300  
Mississauga, Ontario, Canada L4W 4Z2  
Tel: 1-800-653-5350  
Tel: 905-629-7226  
United Kingdom  
Asia/Pacific  
Symbol Technologies  
Symbol Place  
Winnersh Triangle, Berkshire RG41 5TP  
United Kingdom  
Symbol Technologies Asia, Inc (Singapore Branch)  
230 Victoria Street #05-07/09  
Bugis Junction Office Tower  
Singapore 188024  
Tel: 0800 328 2424 (Inside UK)  
Tel: +44 118 945 7529 (Outside UK)  
Tel: +65-6796-9600  
Fax: +65-6337-6488  
Australia  
Austria/Österreich  
Symbol Technologies Pty. Ltd.  
432 St. Kilda Road  
Melbourne, Victoria 3004  
Symbol Technologies Austria GmbH  
Prinz-Eugen Strasse 70 / 2.Haus  
1040 Vienna, Austria  
Tel: 1-800-672-906 (Inside Australia)  
Tel: +61-3-9866-6044 (Outside Australia)  
Tel: 01-5055794-0 (Inside Austria)  
Tel: +43-1-5055794-0 (Outside Austria)  
Denmark/Danmark  
Europe/Mid-East Distributor Operations  
Contact your local distributor or call:  
Tel: +44 118 945 7360  
Symbol Technologies AS  
Dr. Neergaardsvej 3  
2970 Hørsholm  
Tel: 7020-1718 (Inside Denmark)  
Tel: +45-7020-1718 (Outside Denmark)  
Finland/Suomi  
France  
Oy Symbol Technologies  
Kaupintie 8 A 6  
FIN-00440 Helsinki, Finland  
Symbol Technologies France  
Centre d'Affaire d'Antony  
3 Rue de la Renaissance  
92184 Antony Cedex, France  
Tel: 9 5407 580 (Inside Finland)  
Tel: +358 9 5407 580 (Outside Finland)  
Tel: 01-40-96-52-21 (Inside France)  
Tel: +33-1-40-96-52-50 (Outside France)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
xxiv MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Germany/Deutchland  
Italy/Italia  
Symbol Technologies GmbH  
Waldstrasse 66  
D-63128 Dietzenbach, Germany  
Symbol Technologies Italia S.R.L.  
Via Cristoforo Columbo, 49  
20090 Trezzano S/N Navigilo  
Milano, Italy  
Tel: 6074-49020 (Inside Germany)  
Tel: +49-6074-49020 (Outside Germany)  
Tel: 2-484441 (Inside Italy)  
Tel: +39-02-484441 (Outside Italy)  
Latin America Sales Support  
Mexico/México  
2730 University Dr.  
Coral Springs, FL 33065 USA  
Symbol Technologies Mexico Ltd.  
Torre Picasso  
Boulevard Manuel Avila Camacho No 88  
Lomas de Chapultepec CP 11000  
Mexico City, DF, Mexico  
Tel: 1-800-347-0178 (Inside United States)  
Tel: +1-954-255-2610 (Outside United States)  
Fax: 954-340-9454  
Tel: 5-520-1835 (Inside Mexico)  
Tel: +52-5-520-1835 (Outside Mexico)  
Netherlands/Nederland  
Norway/Norge  
Symbol Technologies  
Kerkplein 2, 7051 CX  
Postbus 24 7050 AA  
Varsseveld, Netherlands  
Symbol’s registered and mailing address:  
Symbol Technologies Norway  
Hoybratenveien 35 C  
N-1055 OSLO, Norway  
Tel: 315-271700 (Inside Netherlands)  
Tel: +31-315-271700 (Outside Netherlands)  
Symbol’s repair depot and shipping address:  
Symbol Technologies Norway  
Enebakkveien 123  
N-0680 OSLO, Norway  
Tel: +47 2232 4375  
South Africa  
Spain/España  
Symbol Technologies Africa Inc.  
Block B2  
Rutherford Estate  
Symbol Technologies S.L.  
Avenida de Bruselas, 22  
Edificio Sauce  
1 Scott Street  
Waverly 2090 Johannesburg  
Republic of South Africa  
Tel: 11-809 5311 (Inside South Africa)  
Tel: +27-11-809 5311 (Outside South Africa)  
Alcobendas, Madrid 28108  
Spain  
Tel: 91 324 40 00 (Inside Spain)  
Tel: +34 91 324 40 00 (Outside Spain)  
Fax: +34.91.324.4010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
About This Guide xxv  
Sweden/Sverige  
“Letter” address:  
Symbol Technologies AB  
Box 1354  
S-171 26 SOLNA  
Sweden  
Visit/shipping address:  
Symbol Technologies AB  
Solna Strandväg 78  
S-171 54 SOLNA  
Sweden  
Tel: Switchboard: 08 445 29 00 (domestic)  
Tel: Call Center: +46 8 445 29 29 (international)  
Support E-Mail: [email protected]  
If the Symbol product was purchased from a Symbol Business Partner, contact that Business Partner  
for service.  
For the latest version of this guide go to:http://www.symbol.com/manuals.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
xxvi MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Getting Started  
Chapter Contents  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Getting Started  
1-3  
Introduction  
This chapter describes the mobile computer’s physical characteristics, how to install and charge the  
batteries, replace the strap lanyard, remove and replace the stylus and start the mobile computer for  
the first time.  
Microphone  
Touch Screen  
Indicator  
LED Bar  
Power  
Scan  
Button  
ALT  
CTRL  
1
SPACE  
ALPHA  
Power  
ABC  
2
DEF  
3
BKSP  
SHIFT  
GHI  
4
JKL  
5
MNO  
6
PQRS  
7
TUV  
8
WXYZ  
9
0
#
Keypad  
MC9000-S  
MC9000-K  
Figure 1-1. MC9000-K and MC9000-S: Front View  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
1-4 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Exit Window  
Exit  
Window  
Headphone Jack  
(optional)  
Headphone  
Jack (optional)  
Scan  
Button  
Primary Battery  
Release  
MC9000-S  
MC9000-K  
Figure 1-2. MC9000-K and MC9000-S: Side View  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Getting Started  
1-5  
Color Camera (optional)  
Color Camera (optional)  
Hand Strap  
Stylus  
Primary Battery  
Release  
MC9000-S  
MC9000-K  
Figure 1-3. MC9000-K and MC9000-S: Back View  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
1-6 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Unpacking  
Carefully remove all protective material from around the mobile computer and save the shipping  
container for storage and/or re-shipping.  
Verify that all of the equipment listed below was received:  
MC9000-K or MC9000-S mobile computer  
Lithium-ion battery  
Strap, attached to the mobile computer  
Stylus, in the hand strap pocket  
Regulatory Guide  
Quick Start Guide (poster).  
Inspect the equipment for damage. If any equipment is missing or damaged, contact the Symbol  
Technologies Support Center immediately. See page xxiii for contact information.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Getting Started  
1-7  
Accessories  
Single Slot Serial/USB Cradle, charges the mobile computer main battery and a spare  
battery. It also synchronizes the mobile computer with a host computer through a serial or a  
USB connection.  
Four Slot Ethernet Cradle, charges the mobile computer main battery and synchronizes the  
mobile computer with a host computer through an Ethernet connection.  
Four Slot Charge Only Cradle, charges the mobile computer main battery.  
Four Slot Spare Battery Charger, charges up to four mobile computer spare batteries.  
Magnetic Stripe Reader (MSR), snaps on to the mobile computer and adds magstripe read  
capabilities.  
Cable Adapter Module (CAM), snap-on required to connect the following cables to the  
mobile computer:  
• AC line cord (country-specific) and power supply, charges the mobile computer.  
• Auto charge cable, charges the mobile computer using a vehicle’s cigarette lighter.  
• DEX cable, connects the mobile computer to a vending machine.  
• Serial cable, adds serial communication capabilities.  
• USB cable, adds USB communication capabilities.  
• Printer cable, adds printer communication capabilities.  
Universal Battery Charger (UBC) Adapter, adapts the UBC for use with series 9000 batteries.  
Wall Mounting Bracket and Shelf Slide: Use for wall mounting applications.  
Optional Keypads: Application specific keypads.  
Multimedia Card (MMC): Provides secondary non-volatile storage.  
Wall Mounting Bracket and Shelf Slide, use for wall mounting applications.  
Spare lithium-ion batteries, MC9000-K (2200 mAh) and MC9000-S (1550 mAh).  
Short Battery Adapter: Required for charging MC9000-S (1550 mAh) batteries on the Four  
Slot Spare Battery Charger and the Single Slot Serial/USB Cradle.  
Stylus, performs pen functions.  
Device Configuration Package for .NET (SMDK for .NET), available at:  
Symbol Windows CE SMDK for Series 9000, available at:  
Holsters, to hold the mobile computer when not in use.  
Headphone, use in noisy environments.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                                             
1-8 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Symbol Windows CE SDK and SMDK  
Symbol offers two development kits for the MC9000-G:  
Symbol Mobility Developer Kit for .NET (SMDK for .NET), available at:  
Symbol Windows CE SDK for Series 9000, available at:  
The Symbol Windows CE SDK for Series 9000 allows users to develop Windows® CE applications for  
Series 9000 mobile computers. This SDK contains libraries and other Symbol value-add software not  
available in the standard Microsoft® Windows® CE Platform SDK. For detailed information, see  
Software Installation on page 8-1. Symbol also offers other development kits, see:  
http://software.symbol.com.  
Getting Started  
The main battery can be charged before insertion into the mobile computer or after it is installed. Use  
one of the spare battery chargers to charge the main battery (out of the mobile computer) or one of  
the cradles to charge the main battery while it is installed in the mobile computer.  
After installing and charging the battery, press the Power button to start the mobile computer.  
Mobile computer startup procedures:  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Getting Started  
1-9  
Main Battery Insertion and Removal  
Insert the main battery into the mobile computer before use. If the main battery is charged the mobile  
computer can be used immediately. If the main battery is not charged see Battery Charging on page  
1-11.  
Insert the Main Battery  
To insert the main battery, slide the battery into the mobile computer, see Figure 1-4.  
Ensure the battery is fully inserted. Two audible clicks can be heard as the  
battery is fully inserted. A partially inserted battery may result in  
unintentional data loss.  
Figure 1-4. Insert Main Battery  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
1-10 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Main Battery Removal  
To remove the main battery:  
1. Prior to removing the battery, press the red Power button to turn off the screen. This sets the  
mobile computer to suspend mode.  
2. Simultaneously press both primary battery releases. The battery partially ejects from the  
mobile computer.  
3. Pause 3-4 seconds while the mobile computer performs battery removal shutdown.  
4. Press the secondary battery release, on top of the battery and slide the battery out of the  
mobile computer.  
Primary Battery Releases  
Secondary Battery Release  
Figure 1-5. MC9000-K: Main Battery Removal  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Getting Started  
1-11  
Primary Battery Release  
Secondary Battery  
Release  
Bottom View  
Top View  
Figure 1-6. MC9000-S: Main Battery Removal  
Battery Charging  
Main Battery and Memory Backup Battery Charging  
The mobile computer’s cradles, snap-ons and spare battery chargers can be used to charge the mobile  
computers main battery.  
Before using the mobile computer for the first time, fully charge the main battery (until the charge  
indicator light remains lit) see Table 1-1 on page 1-13. Charge time is approximately four hours. The  
mobile computer can be charged using a cradle, a CAM or MSR (with a charging cable) or the main  
battery can be removed and charged using a spare battery charger.  
The mobile computer is equipped with a memory backup battery which automatically charges from  
the fully-charged main battery. When the mobile computer is used for the first time, the backup  
battery requires approximately 15 hours to fully charge. This is also true any time the backup battery  
is discharged which occurs when the main battery is removed for several hours. The backup battery  
retains data in memory for at least 30 minutes after the mobile computer's main battery is removed.  
When the mobile computer reaches very low battery state, the combination of main battery and  
backup battery will retain data in memory for at least 72 hours.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
1-12 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Do not remove the main battery within the first 15 hours of use. If the main  
battery is removed before the backup battery is fully charged, data may be  
lost.  
The following accessories can be used to charge batteries.  
Cradles: The mobile computer slips into the cradles for charging the battery in the mobile  
computer (and spare batteries, where applicable). For detailed cradle setup and charging  
procedures see:  
• Single Slot Serial/USB Cradle on page 7-10.  
• Four Slot Ethernet Cradle on page 7-28 and Four Slot Charge Only Cradles on page 7-30.  
Accessories: The mobile computer’s snap-on accessories provide charging capability, when  
used with one of the accessory charging cables. For detailed snap-on setup and charging  
procedures see:  
• CAM on page 7-40  
• MSR on page 7-34.  
Chargers: The mobile computers spare battery charging accessories are used to charge  
batteries that are removed from the mobile computer. For detailed spare battery charging  
accessories setup and charging procedures see:  
• Single Slot Serial/USB Cradle on page 7-10  
• Four Slot Spare Battery Charger onpage 7-32  
• Universal Battery Charger (UBC) on page 7-42.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Getting Started  
1-13  
Mobile Computer Charging Procedures  
The mobile computer main and backup batteries can be charged using a cradle, the CAM or the MSR.  
The CAM and the MSR also require a charging cable and a Symbol approved power supply.  
1. Connect the charging accessory to the appropriate power source, see Chapter 7,  
Accessories for setup information.  
2. Insert the mobile computer into a cradle or attach the appropriate snap-on module.  
3. The mobile computer starts to charge automatically. The amber charge LED, in the Indicator  
LED Bar, lights to show the charge status. See Table 1-1 for charging indications.  
The main battery usually fully charges in less than four hours.  
Table 1-1. Mobile Computer LED Charge Indicators  
LED  
Indication  
Off  
Mobile computer not in cradle/CAM/MSR; mobile computer not placed correctly;  
charger is not powered.  
Fast Blinking Amber  
Slow Blinking Amber  
Solid Amber  
Error in charging; check placement of the mobile computer.  
Mobile computer is charging.  
Charging complete.  
Note: When the battery is initially inserted in the mobile computer, the amber LED  
flashes once if the battery power is low or the battery is not fully inserted.  
Spare Battery Charging  
The mobile computer has three accessories that can be used to charge spare batteries.  
Single Slot Serial/USB Cradle  
Four Slot Spare Battery Charger  
UBC Adapter.  
To charge a spare battery:  
1. Connect the charging accessory to the appropriate power source, see Chapter 7,  
Accessories for setup.  
2. Insert the spare battery into the spare battery charging slot and gently press down on the  
battery to ensure proper contact.  
3. The battery starts to charge automatically. The amber charge LED on the accessory lights to  
show the charge status. See Chapter 7, Accessories for charging indications.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
1-14 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
The battery usually fully charges in less than four hours.  
A Short Battery Adapter is required to charge the MC9000-S spare battery in either the  
Single Slot Serial/USB Cradle or the Four Slot Spare Battery Charger, see Single Slot  
Note  
Stylus  
Use the mobile computer stylus for selecting items and entering information. The stylus functions as  
a mouse. Tap the touch screen once with the stylus to select options and open menu items. The stylus  
pocket is located in the strap, see Figure 1-3 on page 1-5.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Getting Started  
1-15  
Hand Strap  
The hand strap may be moved to either the left or right side of the mobile computer to suit user  
preferences.  
To reposition the MC9000-K hand strap:  
1. Disengage the upper portion of the hand strap by disconnecting the button from the loop  
connector.  
2. Loosen the loop from the bottom of the hand strap and slide the hand strap through.  
3. Slide the loop out of the connector post.  
Figure 1-7. MC9000-K: Hand Strap Repositioning  
4. Reverse the procedure to re-attach the hand strap. Two hand strap connectors are provided  
on the mobile computer’s main body. The hand strap may be attached to either connector.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
1-16 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
To remove the MC9000-S hand strap:  
1. Disengage the upper portion of the hand strap by sliding it through the clip connector.  
2. Unscrew the two screws on either side of the mobile computer.  
Figure 1-8. MC9000-S: Hand Strap Removal  
3. Reverse the procedure to re-attach the hand strap.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Getting Started  
1-17  
Starting the Mobile Computer  
Insert the battery, if the mobile computer does not power on perform a cold boot, see Resetting the  
When the mobile computer is powered on for the first time, it initializes its flash file system. The  
Symbol splash screen appears for a short period of time, followed by the calibration screen. These  
screens also appear when a cold boot is performed.  
Figure 1-9. Symbol Splash Screen  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
1-18 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Calibration Screen  
Use calibrate screen to align the touch screen:  
1. Remove the stylus from the handle.  
2. Carefully press and briefly hold the tip of stylus on the center of the calibration screen target.  
Repeat the procedure as the target moves and stops at different locations on the screen.  
3. If the mobile computer already has screen calibration settings, the confirm calibration  
resave screen appears. Tap screen within 30 seconds to overwrite the existing calibration  
settings with the new settings or allow the timer to expire and the new calibration settings  
will not be saved.  
Calibration Screen  
Confirm Calibration Resave  
Screen  
Figure 1-10. Calibration Screen  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Getting Started  
1-19  
Mobile Computer Configuration  
The following chapters provide the mobile computer configuration information:  
To customize the mobile computer settings, see Chapter 3, Settings.  
To set up ActiveSync to synchronize the mobile computer and accessories with the host  
computer, see Chapter 4, Communications.  
To configure the mobile computer for Spectrum24, see Chapter 6, Spectrum24 Network  
To install development software on the development PC, see Chapter 8, Software  
To set up AirBEAM to synchronize the mobile computer with the host server, see Chapter 9,  
To configure the mobile computer using the Terminal Configuration Manager, see Chapter  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
1-20 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Operating the MC9000-K/S  
Chapter Contents  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
2-2 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Operating the MC9000-K/S  
2-3  
Introduction  
This chapter provides basic instructions for using and navigating the mobile computer.  
Keypads  
The mobile computer has five interchangeable modular keypad configurations:  
28-key keypad, see page 2-4  
43-key keypad, see page 2-8  
53-key keypad, see page 2-11.  
The modular keypads can be changed in the field, as necessary, to support specialized applications.  
See Keypads on page 7-7 for installation and removal procedures.  
For detailed keypad configurations including ASCII values and VK codes, see  
For information about using the soft keyboard input panel, see Entering Information  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
2-4 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
28-Key Keypad  
The 28-key keypad is used on both the MC9000-K, see Figure 2-1 and the MC9000-S, see Figure 2-2.  
It contains a Power button, application keys, scroll keys and a function key. The keypad is color-coded  
to indicate the alternate function key (blue) values and the alternate ALPHA key (orange) values. Note  
that keypad functions can be changed by an application so the mobile computer’s keypad may not  
function exactly as described. See Table 2-1 on page 2-6 for key and button descriptions and Table 2-  
7 on page 2-23 for the keypads special functions.  
Figure 2-1. MC9000-K: 28-Key Keypad  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Operating the MC9000-K/S  
2-5  
ALT  
CTRL  
SPACE  
ALPHA  
ABC  
2
DEF  
3
BKSP  
SHIFT  
1
GHI  
4
JKL  
5
MNO  
6
PQRS  
TUV  
WXYZ  
7
8
9
0
#
Figure 2-2. MC9000-S: 28-Key Keypad  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
2-6 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Table 2-1. MC9000-K and MC9000-S: 28-Key Keypad Descriptions  
Key  
Description  
Power (red)  
Powers the mobile computer on and off.  
Used to reset the mobile computer, see Resetting the Mobile Computer on page 2-39.  
Green/Red Dot  
Scan (yellow)  
Unassigned application function key. See Appendix B, Keypad Maps for mapping details.  
Scan key - used for scanning applications, this key has the same function as pushing the  
right scan button.  
Scroll Up and Down  
Scroll Left and Right  
Moves up and down from one item to another.  
Increases/decreases specified values.  
Moves left and right from one item to another.  
Increases/decreases specified values.  
ESC  
Exits the current operation.  
SPACE  
BKSP  
Performs the space functions.  
Performs the backspace functions.  
One/Star  
Produces the number one in default state.  
Produces an asterisk in Alpha state.  
1
Alphanumeric  
In default state, produces the numeric value on the key.  
GHI  
4
JKL  
5
MNO  
6
In Alpha state, produces the lower case alphabetic characters on the key. Each key press  
produces the next alphabetic character in sequence. For example, press and release the  
ALPHA key and then press the 4 key once to produce the letter ‘g’; press and release  
the ALPHA key and then press the 4 key three times to produce the letter ‘i’.  
. . .  
When the SHIFT key is pressed in Alpha state, the upper case alphabetic characters on  
the key are produced. For example, press and release the ALPHA key, press and hold the  
SHIFT key and then press the 4 key once to produce the letter ‘G’; press and release the  
ALPHA key, press and hold the SHIFT key and then press the 4 key three times to  
produce the letter ‘I’.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Operating the MC9000-K/S  
2-7  
Table 2-1. MC9000-K and MC9000-S: 28-Key Keypad Descriptions (Continued)  
Key  
Function (blue)  
Description  
Press and release the blue function key to activate the keypad alternate functions  
(shown on the keypad in blue). The keypad LED lights and the  
taskbar, see Table 2-9 on page 2-27. Press and release the blue function key again to  
return to the normal keypad functions.  
icon appears on the  
LED  
Control  
Press and release the CTRL key to activate the keypad alternate CTRL functions. The  
keypad LED lights and the  
key again to return to the normal keypad functions.  
icon appears on the taskbar. Press and release the CTRL  
LED  
ALPHA (orange)  
The default keypad mode is the num-lock (number lock) mode. The num-lock icon  
appears on the taskbar to indicate num-lock mode is active. Press the orange ALPHA key  
to de-activate the num-lock mode and to access the alternate ALPHA characters (shown  
on the keypad in orange).  
LED  
Shift  
Press and release the SHIFT key to activate the keypad alternate SHIFT functions. The  
icon appears on the taskbar. Press and release the SHIFT key again to return to the  
normal keypad functions.  
Period/Decimal Point  
Produces a period for alpha entries and a decimal point for numeric entries.  
Zero  
In default state, produces a zero.  
In Alpha state, produces a space.  
0
Pound  
Produces a pound/number sign.  
#
Enter  
Executes a selected item or function.  
For detailed keypad configurations including ASCII values and VK codes, see  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2-8 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
43-Key Keypad  
The 43-key keypad is available only on the MC9000-K, see Figure 2-3. It contains a Power button,  
application keys, scroll keys and a function key. The keypad is color-coded to indicate the alternate  
function key (blue) values and the alternate ALPHA key (orange) values. Note that keypad functions  
can be changed by an application so the mobile computer’s keypad may not function exactly as  
described. See Table 2-2 on page 2-9 for key and button descriptions and Table 2-7 on page 2-23 for  
the keypad’s special functions.  
Figure 2-3. MC9000-K: 43-Key Keypad  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Operating the MC9000-K/S  
2-9  
Table 2-2. MC9000-K: 43-Key Descriptions  
Key  
Description  
Power (red)  
Powers the mobile computer on and off.  
Used to reset the mobile computer, see see Resetting the Mobile Computer on page 2-39.  
Green/Red Dot  
Scan (yellow)  
Unassigned application function key. See Appendix B, Keypad Maps for mapping details.  
Scan key - used for scanning applications, this key has the same function as pushing the  
right scan button.  
Scroll Up and Down  
Scroll Left and Right  
ESC  
Moves up and down from one item to another.  
Increases/decreases specified values.  
Moves left and right from one item to another.  
Increases/decreases specified values.  
Exits the current operation.  
SPACE/BKSP  
Space and backspace functions.  
Numeric/Special Function/ Numeric or special function (  
or  
) by default or alpha value when the ALPHA key  
Alpha  
is selected.  
. . .  
Alpha/Application  
These keys can have an application assigned to the function value and have an alpha  
value assigned when used with the ALPHA function key.  
. . .  
Function (blue)  
Press and release the blue function key to activate the keypad alternate functions (shown  
on the keypad in blue). The keypad LED lights and the  
icon appears on the taskbar,  
LED  
see Table 2-9 on page 2-27. Press and release the blue function key again to return to the  
normal keypad functions.  
Control  
Press and release the CTRL key to activate the keypad alternate CTRL functions. The  
keypad LED lights and the  
key again to return to the normal keypad functions.  
icon appears on the taskbar. Press and release the CTRL  
LED  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
2-10 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Table 2-2. MC9000-K: 43-Key Descriptions (Continued)  
Key  
Description  
ALT  
ALT  
Press and release the ALT key to activate the keypad ALT (alternate) functions. The  
icon appears on the taskbar. Press and release the ALT key again to return to the normal  
keypad functions.  
ALPHA (orange)  
The default keypad mode is the num-lock (number lock) mode. The num-lock icon  
appears on the taskbar to indicate num-lock mode is active. Press the orange ALPHA key  
to de-activate the num-lock mode and to access the alternate ALPHA characters (shown  
on the keypad in orange).  
LED  
Shift  
Press and release the SHIFT key to activate the keypad alternate SHIFT functions. The  
icon appears on the taskbar. Press and release the SHIFT key again to return to the normal  
keypad functions.  
Period/Decimal Point  
Produces a period for alpha entries, a decimal point for numeric entries and the alphabetic  
character X when the ALPHA function key is activated.  
Star  
Produces an asterisk and the alphabetic character Z when the ALPHA function key is  
activated.  
Enter  
Executes a selected item or function.  
For detailed keypad configurations including ASCII values and VK codes, see  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Operating the MC9000-K/S  
2-11  
53-Key Keypad  
There are two physical configurations of the 53-key keypad, however both of the keypads are  
functionally identical. The 53-key keypad is available only on the MC9000-K. It contains a Power  
button, application keys, scroll keys and function keys. The keypad is color-coded to indicate the  
alternate function key (blue) values. Note that keypad functions can be changed by an application so  
the mobile computer’s keypad may not function exactly as described. See Table 2-3 on page 2-12 for  
key and button descriptions and Table 2-7 on page 2-23 for the keypad’s special functions.  
Figure 2-4. MC9000-K: 53-Key Keypad  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
2-12 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Table 2-3. MC9000-K: 53-Key Descriptions  
Key  
Description  
Power (red)  
Powers the mobile computer on and off.  
Used to reset the mobile computer, see Resetting the Mobile Computer  
Green/Red Dot  
Scan (yellow)  
Unassigned application function key. See Appendix B, Keypad Maps for  
mapping details.  
Scan key - used for scanning applications, this key has the same  
function as pushing the right scan button.  
Scroll Up and Down  
Scroll Left and Right  
ESC  
Moves up and down from one item to another.  
Increases/decreases specified values.  
Moves left and right from one item to another.  
Increases/decreases specified values.  
Exits the current operation.  
Alpha  
Use the alpha keys for alphabetic characters.  
Space and backspace functions.  
. . .  
SPACE/BKSP  
Numeric/Application  
Numeric value keys - can have applications assigned with function  
key(s).  
. . .  
Function (blue)  
Press and release the blue function key to activate the keypad alternate  
functions (shown on the keypad in blue). The keypad LED lights and the  
icon appears on the taskbar, see Table 2-9 on page 2-27. Press and  
release the blue function key again to return to the normal keypad  
functions.  
LED  
Control  
Press and release the CTRL key to activate the keypad alternate CTRL  
functions. The keypad LED lights and the  
taskbar. Press and release the CTRL key again to return to the normal  
keypad functions.  
icon appears on the  
LED  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Operating the MC9000-K/S  
2-13  
Table 2-3. MC9000-K: 53-Key Descriptions (Continued)  
Key  
Description  
Press and release the SHIFT key to activate the keypad alternate SHIFT  
functions. The icon appears on the taskbar. Press and release the  
Shift  
SHIFT key again to return to the normal keypad functions.  
Period/Decimal Point  
Produces a period for alpha entries and a decimal point for numeric  
entries.  
Star  
Produces an asterisk.  
Enter  
Executes a selected item or function.  
For detailed keypad configurations including ASCII values and VK codes, see  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2-14 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
3270 Emulator  
The 3270 emulator keypad is available only on the MC9000-K. It contains a Power button, application  
keys, scroll keys and a function key. The keypad is color-coded to indicate the alternate function key  
(blue) values. Note that keypad functions can be changed by an application so the mobile computer’s  
keypad may not function exactly as described. See Table 2-4 on page 2-15 for key and button  
descriptions and Table 2-7 on page 2-23 for the keypad’s special functions.  
Figure 2-5. 3270 Emulator Keypad  
The 3270 emulator keypad is only used when the mobile computer is running  
the 3270 emulation software. When the mobile computer is not running the  
3270 emulation software, the 3270 keypad functions are the same as a 53-  
key keypad.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Operating the MC9000-K/S  
2-15  
Table 2-4. 3270 Emulator Descriptions  
Key  
Description  
Power (red)  
Powers the mobile computer on and off.  
Used to reset the mobile computer, see Resetting the Mobile Computer  
Green/Red Dot  
Scan (yellow)  
Unassigned application function key. See Appendix B, Keypad Maps for  
mapping details.  
Scan key - used for scanning applications, this key has the same  
function as pushing the scan button.  
Scroll Up and Down  
Scroll Left and Right  
CLR  
Moves up and down from one item to another.  
Increases/decreases specified values.  
Moves left and right from one item to another.  
Increases/decreases specified values.  
Exits the current operation.  
Alpha  
Use the alpha keys for alphabetic characters.  
. . .  
SPACE/BKSP  
Application  
Space and backspace functions.  
These keys can be assigned to an application.  
. . .  
Function (blue)  
Press and release the blue function key to activate the keypad alternate  
functions (shown on the keypad in blue). The keypad LED lights and the  
icon appears on the taskbar, see Table 2-9 on page 2-27. Press and  
release the blue function key again to return to the normal keypad  
functions.  
LED  
Control  
Press and release the CTRL key to activate the keypad alternate CTRL  
functions. The keypad LED lights and the  
icon appears on the  
taskbar. Press and release the CTRL key again to return to the normal  
keypad functions.  
LED  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
2-16 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Table 2-4. 3270 Emulator Descriptions (Continued)  
Key  
Description  
Shift  
Press and release the SHIFT key to activate the keypad alternate SHIFT  
functions. The  
icon appears on the taskbar. Press and release the  
SHIFT key again to return to the normal keypad functions.  
Period/Decimal Point  
Produces a period for alpha entries and a decimal point for numeric  
entries.  
Star  
Produces an asterisk.  
Enter  
Executes a selected item or function.  
For detailed keypad configurations including ASCII values and VK codes, see  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Operating the MC9000-K/S  
2-17  
5250 Emulator  
The 5250 emulator keypad is available only on the MC9000-K. It contains a Power button, application  
keys, scroll keys and a function key. The keypad is color-coded to indicate the alternate function key  
(blue) values. Note that keypad functions can be changed by an application so the mobile computer’s  
keypad may not function exactly as described. See Table 2-5 on page 2-18 for key and button  
descriptions and Table 2-7 on page 2-23 for the keypad’s special functions.  
Figure 2-6. 5250 Emulator Keypad  
The 5250 emulator keypad is only used when the mobile computer is running  
the 5250 emulation software. When the mobile computer is not running the  
5250 emulation software, the 5250 keypad functions are the same as a 53-  
key keypad.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
2-18 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Table 2-5. 5250 Emulator Descriptions  
Key  
Description  
Power (red)  
Powers the mobile computer on and off.  
Used to reset the mobile computer, see see Resetting the Mobile Computer  
Green/Red Dot  
Scan (yellow)  
Unassigned application function key. See Appendix B, Keypad Maps for  
mapping details.  
Scan key - used for scanning applications, this key has the same function  
as pushing the scan button.  
Scroll Up and Down  
Scroll Left and Right  
ENT  
Moves up and down from one item to another.  
Moves left and right from one item to another.  
Exits the current operation.  
Alpha  
Use the alpha keys for alphabetic characters.  
. . .  
SPACE/BKSP  
Application  
Space and backspace functions.  
These keys can be assigned to an application.  
. . .  
Function (blue)  
Press and release the blue function key to activate the keypad alternate  
functions (shown on the keypad in blue). The keypad LED lights and the  
icon appears on the taskbar, see Table 2-9 on page 2-27. Press and  
release the blue function key again to return to the normal keypad  
functions.  
LED  
Control  
Press and release the CTRL key to activate the keypad alternate CTRL  
functions. The keypad LED lights and the  
icon appears on the taskbar.  
LED  
Press and release the CTRL key again to return to the normal keypad  
functions.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Operating the MC9000-K/S  
2-19  
Table 2-5. 5250 Emulator Descriptions (Continued)  
Key  
Description  
Shift  
Press and release the SHIFT key to activate the keypad alternate SHIFT  
functions. The  
icon appears on the taskbar. Press and release the  
SHIFT key again to return to the normal keypad functions.  
Period/Decimal Point  
Produces a period for alpha entries and a decimal point for numeric entries.  
Star  
Produces an asterisk.  
Enter  
Executes a selected item or function.  
For detailed keypad configurations including ASCII values and VK codes, see  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2-20 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
VT Emulator  
The VT emulator keypad is available only on the MC9000-K. It contains a Power button, application  
keys, scroll keys and a function key. The keypad is color-coded to indicate the alternate function key  
(blue) values. Note that keypad functions can be changed by an application so the mobile computer’s  
keypad may not function exactly as described. See Table 2-6 on page 2-21 for key and button  
descriptions and Table 2-7 on page 2-23 for the keypad’s special functions.  
Figure 2-7. VT Emulator Keypad  
The VT emulator keypad is only used when the mobile computer is running  
the VT emulation software. When the mobile computer is not running the VT  
emulation software, the VT keypad functions are the same as a 53-key  
keypad.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Operating the MC9000-K/S  
2-21  
Table 2-6. VT Emulator Descriptions  
Key  
Description  
Power (red)  
Powers the mobile computer on and off.  
Used to reset the mobile computer, see Resetting the Mobile Computer  
Green/Red Dot  
Scan (yellow)  
Unassigned application function key. See Appendix B, Keypad Maps for  
mapping details.  
Scan key - used for scanning applications, this key has the same  
function as pushing the scan button.  
Scroll Up and Down  
Scroll Left and Right  
ESC  
Moves up and down from one item to another.  
Moves left and right from one item to another.  
Exits the current operation.  
Alpha  
Use the alpha keys for alphabetic characters.  
. . .  
SPACE/BKSP  
Application  
Space and backspace functions.  
These keys can be assigned to an application.  
. . .  
Function (blue)  
Press and release the blue function key to activate the keypad alternate  
functions (shown on the keypad in blue). The keypad LED lights and the  
icon appears on the taskbar, see Table 2-9 on page 2-27. Press and  
release the blue function key again to return to the normal keypad  
functions.  
LED  
Control  
Press and release the CTRL key to activate the keypad alternate CTRL  
functions. The keypad LED lights and the  
icon appears on the  
taskbar. Press and release the CTRL key again to return to the normal  
keypad functions.  
LED  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
2-22 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Table 2-6. VT Emulator Descriptions (Continued)  
Key  
Description  
Shift  
Press and release the SHIFT key to activate the keypad alternate SHIFT  
functions. The  
icon appears on the taskbar. Press and release the  
SHIFT key again to return to the normal keypad functions.  
Period/Decimal Point  
Produces a period for alpha entries and decimal point for numeric  
entries.  
Star  
Produces an asterisk.  
Enter  
Executes a selected item or function.  
For detailed keypad configurations including ASCII values and VK codes, see  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Operating the MC9000-K/S  
2-23  
Keypad Special Functions  
The keypad special functions are color coded on the keypads. For example, on the 53-key keypad, the  
display backlight icon is blue indicating that the blue function key must be selected first to access the  
display backlight. On the 43-key keypad, the display backlight icon is white indicating that the display  
backlight is the default value for that key.  
Table 2-7. Keypad Special Functions  
53-Key, 3270,  
28-Key,  
43-Key  
5250, VT  
Icon  
Keystrokes  
Keystrokes  
Keystrokes  
Special Function  
Blue function key  
and #  
key  
key  
Blue function key Turns on and off the display backlight.  
and Z  
Blue function key  
Blue function key Turns on and off the keypad backlight.  
and 0  
and X  
Blue function key Bluefunctionkey Blue function key Increases display contrast (on monochromatic  
and 1 and F1 and D units only).  
Blue function key Bluefunctionkey Blue function key Decreases display contrast (on monochromatic  
and 4 and F5 and I units only).  
Blue function key Bluefunctionkey Blue function key Increases beeper volume.  
and 3 and F4 and H  
Blue function key Bluefunctionkey Blue function key Decreases beeper volume.  
and 6  
and F8  
and M  
*
Blue function key Not Available  
Blue function key Enables Alt keypad functions.  
and CTRL  
and CTRL  
Use of display and keypad backlighting can significantly reduce battery life.  
Mobile computers with color screens do not have contrast settings.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                 
2-24 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Power Button  
Press the red Power button to turn the mobile computer screen on and off. The mobile computer is on  
when the display is on and the mobile computer is in suspend mode when the display is off. For more  
Do not hold down any key, button or the scan button, other than the Power  
button during a reset.  
Cold boot resets the mobile computer, to the default settings. All added applications and  
all stored data will be removed. Do not cold boot without support desk approval.  
Any data previously synchronized with a computer can be restored during the  
next ActiveSync operation. See Chapter 4, Communications for detailed  
ActiveSync instructions.  
The Power button is also used to reset the mobile computer by performing a warm or cold boot.  
Warm Boot (Soft Reset) - Resets the mobile computer.  
Cold Boot (Hard Reset) - Resets the mobile computer, removes all added applications, stored  
data restores the default settings.  
For information about rebooting the mobile computer, refer to Resetting the Mobile Computer on page  
2-39.  
Headphone  
An optional headphone is available. The headset plugs into the optional headphone jack located at  
the top of the mobile computer, see Figure 1-2 on page 1-4. Set the mobile computer volume  
appropriately before putting on the headset. When a headset is plugged into the jack, the speaker is  
muted.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                         
Operating the MC9000-K/S  
2-25  
Series 9000 Demo Window  
On initial power up (or on a warm or cold boot) the Series 9000 Demo window appears. The Series  
9000 Demo window icon functions are provided in Table 2-8.  
Figure 2-8. Series 9000 Demo Window  
Table 2-8. Series 9000 Demo Window Functions  
Icon  
Description  
Displays the Test Applications window, see Introduction on page 5-3 for a description of  
the Test Applications window.  
Use to set up and run the demonstration scan application, see ScanSamp2 on page 5-6.  
Displays the system file structure, see InkWiz File Browser on page 5-9.  
Displays the AudioSamp sample application, see AudioSamp on page 5-13.  
Displays the image viewer sample application, see Images on page 5-14.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
2-26 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Table 2-8. Series 9000 Demo Window Functions (Continued)  
Icon  
Description  
Displays the control panel menu, see Control Panel on page 3-40.  
Starts the PC Link application, see PC Link on page 5-16.  
Provides access to the terminal emulators, see Terminal Emulators on page 2-44.  
Provides access to the S24 DS Settings, see Mobile Companion on page 6-4.  
Provides access to the S24 FH Settings, see Spectrum24 Frequency Hopping (FH) Settings  
Provides information about the OTL application, see About OTL on page 5-17.  
The Series 9000 Demo window is the factory default launcher menu.  
Application specific shells may vary.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Operating the MC9000-K/S  
2-27  
Taskbar  
The taskbar (at the bottom of the window) displays the Start button, active programs (in this case PC  
Link and Mobile Companion), battery status and the communication status. The default taskbar icons  
are described in Table 2-9 and the default taskbar buttons are described in Table 2-10 on page 2-28.  
The Start button functions are described in Sart Button on page 2-29.  
Start Button  
Open Programs and Status Icons  
Desktop  
Menu and Application Buttons  
Keyboard Input Panel  
Figure 2-9. Taskbar  
.
Table 2-9. Taskbar Icons  
Icon  
Description  
Indicates that the battery is charging.  
Indicates that the battery charge is fully charged (100% charge).  
The battery status icons provide the battery status in 10% increments from 10% to 100%.  
Indicates that the battery is fully charged and the mobile computer is running on external power.  
Indicates IP status. Only displays when the mobile computer is in emulation mode.  
Indicates that the ActiveSync application is running.  
Indicates that the Shift character selection is selected.  
Indicates that the Function character selection is selected.  
Indicates that the Control character selection is selected.  
Indicates that the ALT character selection is selected.  
ALT  
Indicates that the Num-lock character selection is selected.  
The Mobile Companion utility. Tap to display the LAN status selection menu.  
Indicated that the mobile computer is in Alpha mode. The mobile computer automatically enters  
Alpha mode when the Terminal Emulators are run.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
2-28 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Table 2-10. Taskbar Buttons  
Icon  
Description  
The Start button. Tap to display the Start menu.  
The Keyboard Input Panel, display button. Tap to display the Keyboard Input Panel.  
The Keyboard Input Panel hide button. Tap to hide the Keyboard Input Panel.  
The Desktop display button. Tap to display the Desktop.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Operating the MC9000-K/S  
2-29  
Sart Button  
Tap the Start button to launch the Start Menu or tap the Start button while in the ALT state and the  
Task Manager, Properties menu appears, see Task Manager and Properties on page 2-31.  
Programs: Use to access available programs  
Favorites: Displays files in Favorites  
Documents: Displays files in Documents  
Settings: Accesses the Control Panel, the Network and Dial-up Connections and the Taskbar  
and Start Menus.  
Run: Runs a program or application  
Suspend: Suspends the mobile computer.  
Figure 2-10. Start Menu  
Keyboard Input Panel Button  
Use the Keyboard Input Panel as an alternate input device, see Entering Information Using the  
Desktop Button  
Use the Desktop button to minimize all open programs and display the Desktop.  
Major desktop functions include:  
My Computer: Double-tap icon to open My Computer  
Recycle Bin: Deleted files remain in the recycle bin until the recycle bin is emptied. Once  
emptied the files cannot be retreived.  
Remote Desktop Connection: Use the Remote Desktop Connection icon to access the  
Remote Desktop Connection window.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
2-30 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Taskbar Icons  
The taskbar icons display the function status, indicate what programs are active and indicate the  
battery charge status. The taskbar icons are provided in Table 2-9 on page 2-27.  
Status Icons  
The status icons indicate the function key status. Icond indicate if the Function, Shift, CTRL or ALT  
functions are active.  
Active Programs Icons  
If more than one program is active, the applications’ icons can be used to toggle between the open  
programs (applications). Tap on a taskbar application to maximize the application.  
AC Power/Battery Status Icons  
The AC Power/Battery Status icons are shown in the taskbar to indicate the present power supply  
status of the mobile computer. The battery status icons provide the battery status in 10% increments  
from 10% to 100%, see Table 2-9 on page 2-27 . Battery status can also be viewed on the battery  
status window, see Battery on page 3-46.  
The amber LED in the mobile computer indicator LED bar, see Figure 1-1 on  
page 1-3, also indicates low battery status and/or incorrect battery insertion.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Operating the MC9000-K/S  
2-31  
Task Manager and Properties  
Use the Task Manager to stop applications and use the Properties functions to set display and clock  
options.  
Task Manager  
1. Select Function - CTRL, (to activate the ALT state) and tap the Start button to display the  
Task Manager, Properties Selection menu.  
2. Tap Task Manager to display the Task Manager window.  
Figure 2-11. Task Manager, Properties Selection Menu  
3. Tap a task in the Active Tasks list and tap Switch To to make that task the primary task, or  
tap End Task to end the selected task.  
4. Tap X to exit the Task Manager window.  
Figure 2-12. Task Manager Window  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
2-32 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Properties  
1. Select Function - CTRL, (to activate the ALT state) and tap the Start button to display the  
Task Manager, Properties window, see Figure 2-11 on page 2-31.  
2. Tap Properties to display the Taskbar and Start Menu, General Tab.  
3. This menu provides taskbar options:  
• Check the Always on Top checkbox to keep the taskbar on top of all other windows.  
• Check the AutoHide checkbox to make the taskbar disappear, touch the bottom of the  
display to make the taskbar return.  
• Check the Show Clock checkbox to display the clock on the taskbar.  
4. Tap OK to save the settings and exit the window.  
Figure 2-13. Taskbar and Start Menu, General Tab  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Operating the MC9000-K/S  
2-33  
Advanced Tab  
1. Tap the Advanced tab to enter the Taskbar and Start Menu, Advanced Tab.  
2. Tap the Clear button to delete all of the documents listed in the Start - Documents entry,  
see Sart Button on page 2-29. Typically this list is empty, but if there were documents in the  
list the Clear button would delete them.  
3. Tap the Expand Control Panel checkbox to display the entire contents of the MS control  
panel in list form, rather than Icons..  
Figure 2-14. Taskbar and Start Menu, Advanced Tab  
4. Tap OK to save the settings and exit the window.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2-34 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Entering Information  
To enter information:  
Use the keypad.  
Use the input panel (soft keyboard) to enter typed text.  
Scan bar code data into data fields.  
Use Microsoft® ActiveSync® to synchronize or copy information from the host computer to  
the mobile computer. For more information on ActiveSync, see Chapter 4, Communications  
or ActiveSync Help on the host computer.  
Entering Information Using Keypad  
The alphanumeric keypads produce the 26-character alphabet (A-Z), numbers (0-9), function keys and  
assorted characters. The keypads’ default characters/functions are printed white and the function  
character/functions are printed blue. See Keypads on page 2-3 for keypad configurations and see  
Table 2-7 on page 2-23 for keypad special functions.  
Entering Information Using the Keyboard Input Panel  
Use the keyboard input panel to enter information in any program. To launch the keyboard input panel,  
tap Start, tap the Soft KeyBd menu selection and then tap the  
icon. Tap on a key to enter the key’s  
value. Tap on the keyboard selection icon to display or to hide the keyboard input panel.  
Figure 2-15. Keyboard Input Panel  
Entering Data via the Bar Code Scanner (Scan Wedge)  
The integrated bar code scanner uses the Scan Wedge program to scan data into data fields in the  
same way data is entered via the keypad. The Scan Wedge program is provided as a sample  
application in the SMDK, see Chapter 8, Software Installation for the SMDK installation.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Operating the MC9000-K/S  
2-35  
Data Capture  
The mobile computer has an integrated scanner used to collect data by scanning bar codes.  
Laser Scanning  
To scan bar codes with the mobile computer:  
1. Ensure that the mobile computer is loaded with a scanning application. See ScanSamp2 on  
page 5-6 for a sample scanning application.  
2. Aim the scan exit window at the bar code.  
3. Push the scan button. Ensure the red scan beam covers the entire bar code. The indicator  
LED bar illuminates red to indicate that the laser is on. The indicator LED bar illuminates  
green and a beep sounds to indicate a successful decode.  
Wrong  
Right  
Figure 2-16. Laser Aiming  
Optimal scanning distance varies with bar code density and scanner optics.  
• Hold the scanner farther away for larger symbols.  
• Move the scanner closer for symbols with bars that are close together.  
Scanning procedures depend on the application and mobile computer  
configuration. An application may use different scanning procedures from the  
one listed above.  
Indicator LED Bar  
The Indicator LED bar provides a visual indication of the scan status, see Figure 1-1 on page 1-3.  
Table 2-11. Scan LED Indicators  
LED Status  
Indication  
Off  
Not scanning.  
Solid Red  
Laser enabled, scanning in process.  
Successful decode.  
Solid Green  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                 
2-36 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Scanning Considerations  
Typically, scanning is a simple matter of aim, scan/decode and a few quick trial efforts master it.  
However, two important considerations can be used to optimize any scanning performance:  
Range  
Any scanning device decodes well over a particular working range — minimum and  
maximum distances from the bar code. This range varies according to bar code density and  
scanning device optics.  
Scanning within range brings quick and constant decodes; scanning too close or too far  
away prevents decodes. Move the scanner closer and further away to find the right working  
range for the bar codes being scanned. However, the situation is complicated by the  
availability of various integrated scanning modules. The best way to specify the appropriate  
working range per bar code density is through a chart called a decode zone for each scan  
module. A decode zone simply plots working range as a function of minimum element widths  
of bar code symbols.  
Angle  
Scanning angle is important for promoting quick decodes. When laser beams reflect directly  
back into the scanner from the bar code, this specular reflection can “blind” the scanner.  
To avoid this, scan the bar code so that the beam does not bounce directly back. But don’t  
scan at too sharp an angle; the scanner needs to collect scattered reflections from the scan  
to make a successful decode. Practice quickly shows what tolerances to work within.  
Contact the Symbol Support Center if chronic scanning difficulties develop.  
Decoding of properly printed bar codes should be quick and effortless.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Operating the MC9000-K/S  
2-37  
Imaging  
The imager version of the mobile computer has the following features:  
Omnidirectional reading of a variety of bar code symbologies, including the most popular  
linear, postal, PDF417 and 2-D matrix code types.  
The ability to capture and download images to a host for a variety of imaging applications.  
Advanced intuitive laser aiming for easy point-and-shoot operation.  
Imager  
The imager uses digital camera technology to take a digital picture of a bar code, stores the resulting  
image in its memory and executes state-of-the-art software decoding algorithms to extract the data  
from the image. A typical bar code decoding process is as follows:  
1. Aim the imager version of the mobile computer at a bar code and push the scan button.  
2. The red laser aiming pattern turns on to assist in aiming the mobile computer.  
3. If necessary, the mobile computer turns on its red LEDs to illuminate the target bar code.  
4. The mobile computer takes a digital picture (image) of the bar code and stores it in memory  
for decoding.  
5. An audible beep occurs indicating the bar code was decoded properly.  
6. Release the scan button.  
This process usually occurs instantaneously. Steps 2 - 4 are repeated on poor or difficult bar codes as  
long as the scan button remains pulled.  
Operational Modes  
The imager version of the mobile computer has two modes of operation: Decode Mode and Image  
Capture Mode, activated by pushing the scan button.  
Decode Mode  
In this default mode, upon pushing the scan button, the Imager attempts to locate and decode  
enabled bar codes within its field of view. The Imager remains in this mode as long as the scan button  
is pressed, or until a bar code is decoded.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
               
2-38 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Aiming the Imager  
The imager version of the mobile computer projects a laser aiming pattern (shown below) similar to  
those used on cameras. The aiming pattern is used to position the bar code or object within the field  
of view.  
Figure 2-17. Laser Aiming Pattern  
Imager symbol scanning:  
1. Center the symbol in any orientation within the aiming pattern. Ensure the entire symbol is  
within the rectangular area formed by the brackets in the aiming pattern.  
Linear bar code  
PDF417 symbol  
Symbol  
View Finder  
(Aiming Pattern)  
Figure 2-18. Centering Symbol in Aiming Pattern  
The imager can also read a bar code presented within the aiming pattern but not centered,  
such as the figure below on the left. The figure on the right, however, can not be decoded.  
Right  
Wrong  
Figure 2-19. Imager Aiming  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Operating the MC9000-K/S  
2-39  
2. The aiming pattern is smaller when the Imager is closer to the symbol and larger when it is  
farther from the symbol. Scan symbols with smaller bars or elements (mil size) closer to the  
unit and those with larger bars or elements (mil size) farther from the unit.  
3. Hold the mobile computer between two and nine inches (depending on symbol density) from  
the symbol, centering the aiming pattern cross hairs on the symbol.  
4. Press and hold the scan button until the mobile computer beeps, indicating the bar code is  
successfully decoded.  
Resetting the Mobile Computer  
If the mobile computer stops responding to input, reset it. There are two reset functions, warm boot  
and cold boot. A warm boot restarts the mobile computer by closing all running programs. All data  
that is not saved to flash memory is lost.  
A cold boot also restarts the mobile computer, but erases all stored records and entries. In addition it  
returns formats, preferences and other settings to the factory default settings.  
Perform a warm boot first. This restarts the mobile computer and saves all stored records and entries.  
If the mobile computer still does not respond, perform a cold boot.  
Performing a Warm Boot  
Hold down the Power button for approximately five seconds. As soon as the mobile computer starts  
to perform a warm boot release the Power button.  
Or the the warm boot command can be excuted from the Programs menu, tap Start - Programs - Warm  
Boot.  
Files that remain open during a warm boot may not be retained.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
2-40 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Performing a Cold Boot  
A cold boot restarts the mobile computer and erases all user stored records and entries. Never  
perform a cold boot unless a warm boot does not solve the problem.  
Do not hold down any key, button or the scan button, other than the Power  
button during a reset.  
Cold boot resets the mobile computer, to the default settings. All added applications and  
all stored data will be removed. Do not cold boot without support desk approval.  
Any data previously synchronized with a computer can be restored during the  
next ActiveSync operation. See Chapter 4, Communications for detailed  
ActiveSync instructions.  
To perform a cold boot:  
1. Press the mobile computer’s primary battery releases to partially eject the battery. The  
secondary battery release tab is now visable, see Figure 1-5 on page 1-10.  
2. While the battery is partially ejected, press and hold the Power button, while pushing the  
battery back into the fully inserted position.  
3. Continue holding the Power button for 15 seconds. After the first five seconds the unit may  
start to perform a warm boot. The message Warm Boot appears in the upper left hand corner  
of the screen. Continue holding the Power button and the unit cycles into a cold boot. The  
message Booting System appears in the top center of the screen.  
4. As the mobile computer initializes its Flash File system, the Symbol splash window, Figure  
1-6 on page 1-11 appears for about a minute.  
5. Calibrate the screen. See Calibration Screen on page 1-18 to calibrate the mobile computer  
display.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Operating the MC9000-K/S  
2-41  
Waking the Mobile Computer  
The wakeup conditions are configurable and the current factory default settings are subject to  
change/update.  
The mobile computer wakeup configuration is set in the registry file, registry file editing procedures  
are provided in the SMDK, refer to Chapter 8, Software Installation for the SMDK installation. Table  
2-12 lists the wakeup conditions settings.  
Table 2-12. Wakeup Conditions  
Status  
Description  
Action  
Conditions for wakeup  
Power Off  
When the mobile computer goes into Power  
sleep mode by pressing Power,  
1. Power button is pressed.  
2. AC power added or removed.  
Scan button is pressed.  
these actions wake the mobile  
Scan  
computer.  
Button  
WLAN  
Clock  
Wireless LAN accesses the mobile computer.  
Real Time Clock set to wake up.  
Auto Off  
When the mobile computer goes into Power  
sleep mode by an automatic power-  
off function, these actions wake the  
1. Power button is pressed.  
2. AC power added or removed.  
Scan  
Scan button is pressed.  
mobile computer.  
Button  
WLAN  
Clock  
Wireless LAN accesses the mobile computer.  
Real Time Clock set to sleep.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
2-42 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
File System Directory Structure  
The mobile computer directory structure displays all of the file folders, see Figure 2-20. The pre-  
installed folders are in flash file system memory and optional removable storage devices (MMC  
storage cards).  
Figure 2-20. Mobile Computer Directory Structure  
Application and Platform folders are located in flash file system memory.  
The Windows, Program Files, profiles, and My Documents folders are composites, RAM  
based folders generated from ROM (many of these files are marked read only).  
The Network folder is a link to file systems mapped using the network redirector. The files  
do not physically reside on the terminal.  
The Temp and Recycled folders typically contain RAM based files.  
All files copied to the RAM based folders are lost after a cold boot.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Operating the MC9000-K/S  
2-43  
Flash Storage  
In addition to the RAM-based storage the mobile computer is also equipped with a non-volatile Flash-  
based storage area which can store data (partitions) that can not be corrupted by a cold boot, see  
Flash Storage on page 10-27 for a detailed discussion.  
Startup Folder  
The Applications/Startup folder is used to launch programs automatically when the mobile computer  
is started, either after a warm or cold boot.  
The Windows/Startup folder is not supported.  
There are two ways to launch programs automatically:  
1. Place the executable in the Startup folder of the Application partition.  
2. Place a .run file in the Startup folder of the Application partition.  
Refer to the Windows CE Help File for Symbol Terminals included with the SMDK for more  
information on the Startup folder.  
Run Files  
A .run file is a simple text file that contains the path to an application as well as the name of the  
application to run.  
Refer to the Windows CE Help File for Symbol Terminals included with the SMDK for more  
information on the Startup folder.  
Audio Event Aliasing  
Audio Event Aliasing is the means by which standard Windows .wav files are rendered on a non-  
audio terminal using only a beeper.  
The audio driver of the mobile computer supports a feature called Event Aliasing. This feature allows  
a special .wav file to play. This .wav file replaces the sound normally produced when running a .wav  
file with other actions (such as LED flashing, etc.).  
This feature allows applications that play .wav files to be portable between two devices, one that  
supports real audio and one that supports audio aliasing.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
2-44 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Terminal Emulators  
Use the Terminal Emulators icon to enter the Wavelink terminal emulator application.  
From the Series 9000 Demo window, double-tap the Terminal Emulators icon. The Terminal Emulator  
window appears.  
To exit, tap TelnetCE Options and tap ExitExit.  
Figure 2-21. Terminal Emulator Window  
Refer to the documentation provided with the terminal emulator software package for setup and use.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Settings  
Chapter Contents  
Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
3-2 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Settings  
3-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3-4 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Settings  
3-5  
Introduction  
This chapter provides basic instructions for customizing the mobile computer by adjusting settings.  
The system settings are accessed from the Windows CE Control Panel menu (see Table 3-1 on page  
3-6) , the Series 9000 Demo menu (see Table 3-4 on page 3-39) and the Control Panel menu (see Table  
Windows Control Panel Menu  
To view available options for the mobile computer settings, tap Start - Settings - Control Panel.  
Figure 3-1. Windows Control Panel Menu  
Table 3-1 lists the applications available in the Windows Control Panel Menu.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
3-6 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Table 3-1. Windows Control Panel Menu Icons  
Icon  
Description  
Scan for, and setup Bluetooth compatible hardware, see Bluetooth Device Properties on page 3-8  
for more information.  
View and modify digital certificates which are used by some applications for establishing trust for  
secure communications, see Certificates on page 3-15 for more information.  
Change date, time and time zone information, see Date/Time on page 3-16 for more information.  
Configure device management, install and view available software, see Device Management on  
page 3-17 for more information.  
Set dialing properties for modem communication and change telephony settings, see Dialing on  
page 3-18 for more information.  
Change desktop background, appearance, backlight, and brightness, see Display on page 3-20 for  
more information.  
Switch input methods and set input options, see Input Panel on page 3-22 for more information.  
Change keyboard repeat delay and rate, see Keyboard on page 3-23 for more information.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Settings  
3-7  
Table 3-1. Windows Control Panel Menu Icons (Continued)  
Icon  
Description  
Adjust double-click sensitivity for both the speed and timing.  
Connect to other computers, networks, and the Internet through a modem, see Certificates on page  
3-15 for more information.  
Change owner's personal profiles, see Owner on page 3-26 for more information.  
Change settings for connectivity of a host computer, see PC Connection on page 3-28 for more  
information.  
Change how numbers, currencies, dates, and times are displayed, see Regional Settings on page  
3-29 for more information.  
Remove loaded programs from RAM, see Remove Programs on page 3-32 for more information.  
Calibrate the touch screen and adjust double-tap timing, see Stylus on page 3-33 for more  
information.  
View system information, and change memory settings, see System on page 3-35 for more  
information.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
3-8 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Bluetooth Device Properties  
Use the Bluetooth Manager window to discover and create bonds with other Bluetooth devices. The  
mobile computer can receive information from discovered devices, without creating a bond. However,  
the exchange of information between the mobile computer and a bonded device occurs automatically  
when the Bluetooth radio is turned on. Creating a bond involves entering the same PIN on the two  
devices to bond. Once a bond is created, and the Bluetooth radios are turned on, the devices recognize  
the bond and are able to exchange information without re-entering a PIN.  
Bluetooth/S24 Power Settings  
Both the S24, 802.11b and Bluetooth operate in the same 2.4 GHz unlicensed frequency band. Sharing  
the same frequency band could result in performance degradation. To minimize interference use the  
power settings to turn off the S24 radio while the Bluetooth radio is being used.  
1. To turn off the S24 radio and turn on the Bluetooth radio double tap Control Panel - Power  
Settings:  
Control Panel Icon  
Power Settings  
Figure 3-2. Control Panel Power Settings  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Settings  
3-9  
2. Scroll down the Power Settings window and double tap wlp1: Wireless LAN.  
3. Double tap D4 in the S24 Power Selection window. This setting turns off the S24 radio.  
S24 Power Settings  
S24 Power Selection  
Figure 3-3. S24 Power Settings  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3-10 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
4. Scroll up the Power Settings window and double tap com3: Bluetooth serial.  
5. Double tap D0 in the Bluetooth Power Selection window. This turns on the Bluetooth radio.  
Power Settings  
Bluetooth Power Selection  
Figure 3-4. Bluetooth Power Settings  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Settings  
3-11  
Starting Bluetooth  
1. Select Start - Settings - Control Panel, and double-tap the Bluetooth Device Properties icon.  
Figure 3-5. Bluetooth Manager Window  
2. Tap the Scan Device button to initiate a scan for Bluetooth hardware. The Bluetooth  
manager lists the Bluetooth devices that it finds, see Figure 3-6. If Bluetooth hardware is not  
found the Bluetooth Error window appears, see Figure 3-7. Table 3-2 described the Bluetooth  
Icons.  
Figure 3-6. Bluetooth Manager Device List Window  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
3-12 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Figure 3-7. Bluetooth Error Window  
If the device to which the mobile computer is bonding does not appear in the  
list, ensure it is turned on, in discoverable mode, and within range (30 feet/  
10 meters) of the mobile computer.  
Table 3-2. Bluetooth Icons  
Icon  
Description  
Unknown device icon Device is not defined  
Locked icon  
Device is locked and cannot be bonded to.  
Device is not locked and can be bonded to.  
Not locked icon  
Bluetooth device icon Bluetooth device  
Bonded device icon  
Mobile device icon  
Phone icon  
Bonded Bluetooth device  
Device is a mobile device  
Device is a phone.  
Printer icon  
Device is a printer  
Network icon  
Linked icon  
Device is a network.  
Device is linked.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Settings  
3-13  
3. Double tap the device to connect to on the device list. The Bluetooth Manager  
Authentication window appears. Tap No to connect to the device without authentication, or  
tap Yes to authenticate the device before connecting.  
Figure 3-8. Bluetooth Manager Authentication Window  
4. If the Yes button was selected in the Bluetooth Manager Authentication window, the enter  
PIN windows appears. Enter a PIN (between 1 and 16 characters) in the Enter PIN: text box,  
and tap OK. The mobile computer sends the PIN request to the device for bonding.  
Figure 3-9. Bluetooth Enter PIN Window  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3-14 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
5. When prompted, the same PIN must be entered on the other device. When the PIN is  
entered correctly on the other device, the bonded icon  
appears on the device list.  
Figure 3-10. Bluetooth Bonded Devices Window  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Settings  
3-15  
Certificates  
Certificates are used by some applications for establishing trust and for secure communications.  
Certificates are signed and issued by certificate authorities and are valid for a prescribed period of  
time. Windows CE manages multiple certificate stores.  
1. Select Start - Settings - Control Panel, and double-tap the Certificates icon.  
Figure 3-11. Certificates Window  
2. Select the certificate group (from the drop-down list) to be viewed or modified.  
• The Trusted Authorities store lists the top-level certificates for trusted authorities.  
• The My Certificates store contains the personal certificates, which are used for  
identification.  
The Other Authorities store lists intermediate certificate authorities that help establish  
a chain of trust.  
3. To add a certificate or associated private key to the selected store, tap Import.  
4. To view more details of the selected certificate, such as the expanded name or expiration  
date, tap View.  
5. To delete a certificate, select it in the drop-down list and tap Remove.  
6. Tap OK for the settings to take effect.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
3-16 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Date/Time  
Use the Date/Time Properties window to change the date, time and time zone information.  
1. Select Start - Settings - Control Panel, and double-tap the Date/Time icon.  
Figure 3-12. Date/Time Properties Window  
2. Use the arrows to select the month in the Date/Time tab.  
3. Tap the date, to select it.  
4. Tap to highlight the hours, minutes or seconds entry. Tap the up or down arrows to increment  
the highlighted value.  
5. Select the appropriate time zone from the Time Zone drop down list.  
6. Tap Apply or OK to save the new settings.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Settings  
3-17  
Device Management  
Use Device Management to keep track of software and hardware, inventory, and configure devices  
remotely.  
The device management client contains a download/install engine that allows users to receive  
software and notifications when there are new applications or Operating System (OS) updates. The  
device management system also allows the downloading and running of scripts to enable  
configuration and customized management. The Windows CE Device Management Client works with  
the Microsoft Systems Management Server (SMS), to provide the required capabilities.  
1. Select Start - Settings - Control Panel, and double-tap the Device Management icon.  
Figure 3-13. Device Management Window  
2. Enter the host system server name or IP address (the System Administrator can supply this  
information) in the Server name or IP address field.  
3. Tap the Use Secure connection selection box to require that a secure connection is used  
4. Tap OK to close the window and set up the next poll to contact the new server.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
3-18 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Dialing  
Use the Dialing Properties window to set dialing properties for modem communication and change  
telephony settings.  
1. Select Start - Settings - Control Panel, and double-tap the Dialing icon.  
Figure 3-14. Dialing Properties Window  
2. To remove a location from the Location: drop-down list, select the location and tap Remove.  
3. Enter or edit the area code and local country code as needed.  
4. Select Tone dialing or Pulse dialing (most phone lines are tone.)  
5. Select the Disable call waiting check box to automatically disable call waiting. Then select  
the appropriate number sequence from the dial drop-down list, or enter a new sequence.  
6. To create a new location, tap New and enter a name for the new location in the Location  
name field.  
Figure 3-15. Create New Location Window  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Settings  
3-19  
7. To edit the dialing properties select the location from the Location: drop-down list, and tap  
Edit. The Edit Dialing Patterns window appears.  
8. Use the codes listed in Table 3-3, edit the dialing patterns in the Edit Dialing Patterns  
window. Tap OK to save the new entries or tap X to exit without saving the new entries.  
Figure 3-16. Edit Dialing Patterns Window  
To use characters other than the ones listed in Table 3-3, use manual dialing.  
Hyphens and spaces in dialing strings are ignored.  
Some modems may not respond to the characters listed, even though the mobile  
computer lets them to be added to the dial string.  
Table 3-3. Dialing Characters  
To  
Enter  
Dial country code (specified by the dialing program)  
Dial area code (specified by the dialing program)  
Dial local number (specified by the dialing program)  
Insert a pause (typically 2 seconds)  
E
F
G
, (comma)  
Wait for credit card tone (specified by the dialing program)  
Wait for second tone (typically used after $)  
Tone-dial the following numbers  
$(dollar sign)  
W
T
Pulse-dial the following numbers  
P
Transfer to another extension (0.5 sec on hook, 0.5 sec off hook) ! (hookflash)  
Wait for “quiet answer” (typically indicated by 6.5 seconds of  
silence followed by a ringing tone)  
@
Use special controls on some systems (tone only)  
ABCD or * or #  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
3-20 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Display  
Use the Display Properties window to change desktop background image and the display appearance.  
Background Tab  
To select the background image:  
1. Select Start - Settings - Control Panel, and double-tap the Display icon, tap the Background  
tab.  
Figure 3-17. Display Properties - Background Tab  
2. From the Image: drop-down list, select the desktop background image. To locate an image  
in another folder, tap Browse.  
3. To have the image cover the entire background, select Tile image on background.  
4. Tap OK to save settings.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Settings  
3-21  
Appearance Tab  
To change the color scheme:  
1. Select Start - Settings - Control Panel, and double-tap the Display icon, tap the Appearance  
tab.  
Figure 3-18. Display Properties - Appearance Tab  
2. From the Scheme: drop-down list, select a scheme.  
3. Select the color scheme item from the Item: drop-down list.  
4. View the choice in the preview box, tap Apply to apply the scheme  
To create a custom scheme:  
1. Select Start - Settings - Control Panel, and double-tap the Display icon, tap the Appearance  
tab.  
2. From the Item: drop-down list, select a display item.  
3. Tap the square next to the Item: drop-down list.  
4. From the Basic colors: list, select a color, and tap OK.  
5. View the color selection(s) in the preview box.  
6. Tap Save to save the scheme.  
7. In the Save scheme As box, enter a name for the scheme, and tap OK.  
8. Tap Apply.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
3-22 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Input Panel  
Use the Input Panel Properties window to switch input methods and to set the input options.  
1. Select Start - Settings - Control Panel, and double-tap the Input Panel icon.  
Figure 3-19. Input Panel Properties  
2. From the Current input method: drop-down list, select the input method.  
3. Tap Options to open the Soft Keyboard Options window.  
Figure 3-20. Soft Keyboard Options Window  
4. Make the settings changes.  
5. Tap OK to save the changes and exit the Soft Keyboard Options window.  
6. Tap OK to apply the changes.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Settings  
3-23  
Keyboard  
Use the Keyboard Properties window to change the keyboard repeat rate and repeat delay.  
1. Select Start - Settings - Control Panel, and double-tap the Keyboard icon.  
Figure 3-21. Keyboard Properties - Repeat Tab  
2. Tap the Enable character repeat check box.  
3. Drag the Repeat delay: slider, to change the repeat delay time.  
4. Drag the Repeat rate: slider, to change the repeat rate.  
5. Test the new settings in the text box provided.  
6. Tap OK to apply the changes.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
3-24 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Mouse  
Use the Mouse Properties window to adjust stylus double-tap timing.  
1. Select Start - Settings - Control Panel, and double-tap the Mouse icon.  
Figure 3-22. Mouse Properties Window  
2. Double-tap the checkerboard grid at a comfortable speed.  
3. Double-tap the clapboard to test the settings.  
4. Tap OK to apply changes.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Settings  
3-25  
Network and Dial-up Connections  
Use the Connection window to set connections to other computers, networks, and the Internet.  
1. Select Start - Settings - Control Panel, and double-tap the Network and Dial-up Connections  
icon.  
Figure 3-23. Connection Window  
2. Double an icon to select a connection type.  
3. Follow the connection type instructions.  
4. Tap OK to apply changes.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
3-26 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Owner  
Use the Owner Properties window to enter the owner information. The information can be displayed  
when the mobile computer is turned on. To enter information:  
Identification Tab  
1. Select Start - Settings - Control Panel, and double-tap the Owner icon.  
2. Select the Identification tab.  
Figure 3-24. Owner Properties Window - Identification Tab  
3. Fill in or edit the owner information.  
4. Select the Display Owner Identification check box to display this information when the  
mobile computer starts.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Settings  
3-27  
Notes Tab  
1. Select the Notes tab and enter information in the Notes box to add more information.  
2. Select the Display owner notes box to include this information on the startup display.  
Figure 3-25. Owner Properties Window - Notes Tab  
Network ID Tab  
To setup identification for remote networks, select the Network ID tab and enter the user name,  
password, and domain name used to log on to the remote network.  
Figure 3-26. Owner Properties Window - Network ID Tab  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
3-28 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
PC Connection  
Use the PC Connection Properties window to set the mobile computer communication baud rate (with  
the host computer).  
1. Select Start - Settings - Control Panel, and double-tap the PC Connection icon.  
Figure 3-27. PC Connection Properties Window  
2. Select the Enable direct connections to the desktop computer checkbox to allow for direct  
connections.  
3. Tap Change Connection to change the selection.  
Figure 3-28. Change Connection Window  
4. Select the connection type from the drop-down list.  
5. Tap OK to select the connection type and exit the Change Connection window.  
6. In the PC Connection Properties window, tap OK to apply the changes.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Settings  
3-29  
Regional Settings  
Use the Regional Settings, to set the way the mobile computer displays dates, times, currency  
amounts, large numbers, and numbers with decimal fractions. The system of measurement can also  
be set to either metric or U.S.  
Region Tab  
The selectable input locales are listed in the Your local: drop-down list. Corresponding User Interface  
Language: choices are provided (where appropriate for a particular location selection). Some location  
selections also provide special features, such as font characters or spell checkers designed for  
different languages.  
1. Select Start - Settings - Control Panel, and double-tap the Regional Settings icon.  
Figure 3-29. Regional Settings Properties - Region Tab  
2. From the Your locale: drop-down list, select the appropriate location.  
3. If applicable, select the appropriate language from the User Interface Language drop-down  
list.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
3-30 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Number Tab  
1. Select the Number tab.  
Figure 3-30. Regional Settings Properties - Number Tab  
2. Select desired options. The available options are determined by the Your local: selection and  
by the User Interface Language selection (on the Region tab).  
Currency Tab  
1. Select the Currency tab.  
Figure 3-31. Regional Settings Properties - Currency Tab  
2. Select desired options. The available options are determined by the Your local: selection and  
by the User Interface Language selection (on the Region tab).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Settings  
3-31  
Time Tab  
1. Select the Time tab.  
Figure 3-32. Regional Settings Properties - Time Tab  
2. Select desired options. The available options are determined by the Your local: selection and  
by the User Interface Language selection (on the Region tab).  
Date Tab  
1. Select the Date tab.  
Figure 3-33. Regional Settings Properties Window - Date Tab  
2. Select desired options. The available options are determined by the Your local: selection and  
by the User Interface Language selection (on the Region tab).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
3-32 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Remove Programs  
Use the Remove Programs window to remove user installed programs from the mobile computer:  
1. Select Start - Settings - Control Panel, and double-tap the Remove Programs icon.  
2. Select the program to be removed from the programs list.  
Figure 3-34. Remove Programs Window  
3. Tap Remove.  
4. Tap OK or X to exit the Remove Programs window.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Settings  
3-33  
Stylus  
Use the Stylus Properties window Double-Tap to adjust double-tap timing and use the Calibrate tab  
to recalibrate the touch screen.  
Double-Tap Tab  
1. Select Start - Settings - Control Panel, and double-tap the Stylus icon.  
Figure 3-35. Stylus Properties - Double-Tap Tab  
2. Select the Double-Tap tab.  
3. Double-tap the checkerboard grid at a comfortable speed.  
4. Double-tap the clapboard to test the settings.  
5. Tap OK to apply changes.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
3-34 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Calibrate Tab  
1. Select Start - Settings - Control Panel, and double-tap the Stylus icon.  
Figure 3-36. Stylus Properties - Calibration Tab  
2. Select the Calibration tab.  
3. In the Calibration tab, tap Recalibrate.  
4. Tap a targets and follow the on-screen messages.  
5. Tap OK.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Settings  
3-35  
System  
Use the System Properties window to view general system properties, change memory settings, input  
device name and view copyright information.  
General Tab  
The General tab view displays general system settings:  
1. Select Start - Settings - Control Panel, and double-tap the System icon.  
2. Select the General tab to view basic system and computer properties.  
Figure 3-37. System Properties - General Tab  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
3-36 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Memory Tab  
Use the Memory tab to adjust the RAM allocation.  
1. Select Start - Settings - Control Panel, and double-tap the System icon.  
2. Select the Memory tab.  
Figure 3-38. System - Memory Tab  
3. To adjust RAM allocation move the slider to allocate more memory for programs or storage.  
If there is not enough space for a file, increase the amount of storage memory. If the mobile  
computer is running slowly, try increasing the amount of program memory.  
Programs supplied with the mobile computer are located in ROM and remain  
after a cold boot. User installed programs are located in RAM and need to be  
reinstalled after a cold boot. Adjust the RAM allocation as required for  
reinstalling user programs.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Settings  
3-37  
Device Name Tab  
Use the Device Name tab to customize the device name and description.  
1. Select Start - Settings - Control Panel, and double-tap the System icon.  
2. Select the Device Name tab.  
Figure 3-39. System Properties - Device Name Tab  
3. Enter a device name for the mobile computer in the Device name (without spaces): field.  
4. Enter a device description for the mobile computer in the Device description: field.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
3-38 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Copyrights Tab  
The Copyrights tab displays relevant copyright information.  
1. Select Start - Settings - Control Panel, and double-tap the System icon.  
2. Tap the Copyrights tab to view the copyrights statement.  
Figure 3-40. System Properties - Copyrights Tab  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Settings  
3-39  
Series 9000 Demo Window  
On mobile computer power up, the Series 9000 Demo window appears, this window is used to access  
the Series 9000 Demo window settings functions and the demo applications. Table 3-4 provides the  
settings functions icons and Table 3-4 on page 3-39 provides the demo application icons.  
Figure 3-41. Series 9000 Demo Menu  
Table 3-4. Series 9000 Demo Window, Settings Functions  
Icon  
Description  
Displays the Control Panel window, see Control Panel on page 3-40.  
Displays the Mobile Companion window, see Mobile Companion on page 6-4.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
3-40 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Control Panel  
Use the Control Panel to change settings for the mobile computer. From the Series 9000 Demo  
window, double-tap the Ctl Panel icon to display the Control Panel window.  
Figure 3-42. Control Panel Window  
Table 3-5. Control Panel Menu  
Menu Item  
Description  
About  
Displays the Control Panel software information, see About Ctl Panel on page 3-42.  
Displays the system software information, see System Version on page 3-43.  
Displays the Unit ID software information, see Unique Unit ID on page 3-44.  
Select the Persist setting, Yes or No, see Persist on page 3-45.  
Displays the battery status information, see Battery on page 3-46.  
Select the Power settings, see Power Settings on page 3-47  
Select the Bluetooth settings, see Bluetooth Settings on page 3-51.  
Select the date and time settings, see Date and Time on page 3-52.  
Calibrate the touch panel, see Calibration Screen on page 1-18.  
Select the printer settings, see Printer Settings on page 3-53.  
Select the communication settings, see Comm Settings on page 3-56.  
Select the display settings, see Display Settings on page 3-57  
Select the sound settings, see Audio Settings on page 3-58  
System Versions  
Unique Unit ID  
Persist  
Battery  
Power settings  
Bluetooth Settings  
Date and Time  
Touch Calibrate  
Printer Settings  
Comm Settings  
Display Settings  
Audio Settings  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Settings  
3-41  
Table 3-5. Control Panel Menu (Continued)  
Menu Item  
Description  
Scanner Settings  
Set scan parameters, see Scanner Settings on page 3-59.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3-42 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
About Ctl Panel  
Use the About Ctl Panel window to view the system’s control panel software version information.  
1. Double-tap the Ctl Panel icon - double-tap About. The About window appears.  
Figure 3-43. About Window  
2. Tap OK to return to the Control Panel window.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Settings  
3-43  
System Version  
Use the System Version window to view the system software versions.  
1. Double-tap the Ctl Panel icon - double-tap System Versions. The System Versions window  
appears.  
Figure 3-44. System Version Window  
2. Tap OK to return to the Control Panel window.  
Version data shown is example data only.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
3-44 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Unique Unit ID  
Use the Unique Unit ID (UUID) window to view the unique unit ID version information. The UUID  
provides a way of uniquely identifying each unit. Some software packages require a UUID.  
1. Double-tap the Ctl Panel icon - double-tap Unique Unit ID. The Unique Unit ID window  
appears.  
Figure 3-45. Unique Unit ID Window  
2. Tap OK to return to the Control Panel window.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Settings  
3-45  
Persist  
The Persist setting is made in the Control Panel window, see Figure 3-42 on page 3-40. It is used in  
conjunction with a parameter settings to save the new setting(s) in a .reg file in the /Applications  
directory. Enable Persist prior to changing any settings if the settings are to be saved over a cold boot.  
1. From the Control Panel window, tap Persist.  
2. Use the right arrow  
button to toggle the value to between Yes or No.  
The created registration files can be found in the root directory of the application drive and the  
filenames are the same as the registry key names. For example, for a key called ZOT with a registry  
path of \HARDWARE\ONE\FUZZY the filename would be HARDWARE.ONE.FUZZY.ZOT.REG.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
3-46 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Battery  
Use the Battery window to view the battery status.  
1. Double-tap the Ctl Panel icon - double-tap Battery. The Battery window appears.  
Figure 3-46. Battery Status Window  
Do not use the Backup voltage value.  
2. Tap OK to return to the Control Panel window.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Settings  
3-47  
Power Settings  
Use the Power Settings window to view and set the power setting parameters.  
Double-tap the Ctl Panel icon - double-tap Power Settings. The Power Settings window appears.  
Figure 3-47. Power Settings Window  
The device list as well as the he parameters settings is dependent on the mobile computer setup and  
configuration. However, the parameter types are defined.  
The parameter types are:  
WakeUp control (Power key, Timeout, and API call) - typical sample device = acp1:  
Timeout control (Battery and AC power) - typical sample device = bkl1:  
State control (D0, D1, D2, D3, D4) - typical sample device = bkl1:  
Activity control (Trigger, Touch, Keyboard, User) - typical sample device = bkl1:  
Use the power settings to set the individual power parameters, see Table 3-6 for parameter settings.  
Tap the up and down arrow buttons to scroll up or down on the menu selections and tap the left or  
right arrow buttons to select a menu item, or to toggle a selection value. The Keypad arrows perform  
the same functions as the arrow buttons. Tap OK to save any new selections and return to the  
previous window or tap Cancel to return to the previous window without saving any new entries.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
3-48 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Use the power settings with caution. Some of the settings allow the user to  
turn off the display, or to disable the keypad/touch screen. If the unit is  
inadvertently disabled with the power settings, see Resetting the Mobile  
Computer on page 2-39 to restore the factory settings.  
Table 3-6. Example Power Setting Parameters  
Parameter  
Value  
Settings  
Last Wake Real Time Clock  
Displays the event that iintiated the last wake up.  
acp1:  
bkl1:  
AC Power  
Backlight  
Power Key Wake  
Timeout Wake  
API Call Wake  
Set the Wake on=Yes, off=No  
Set the Wake on=Yes, off=No  
Set the Wake on=Yes, off=No  
Battery Timeout  
60 (time value in ms)  
AC Power Timeout  
0 (time value in ms)  
D0  
D3  
D4  
When selected feature is on  
When selected feature is on standby  
When selected feature is off  
Activities:  
Trigger  
Touch  
Keyboard  
User  
Select Yes to set Activities to function on  
Battery Power and/or on AC Power. Select No to  
set activities not to function on Battery Power  
and/or on AC Power.  
com1:  
com3:  
ddi1:  
Accessory serial  
Bluetooth serial  
Display  
Power Key Wake  
Timeout Wake  
API Call Wake  
D0  
D3  
D4  
Set the Wake on=Yes, off=No  
Set the Wake on=Yes, off=No  
Set the Wake on=Yes, off=No  
When selected feature is on  
When selected feature is on standby  
When selected feature is off  
Power Key Wake  
Timeout Wake  
API Call Wake  
D0  
D3  
D4  
Set the Wake on=Yes, off=No  
Set the Wake on=Yes, off=No  
Set the Wake on=Yes, off=No  
When selected feature is on  
When selected feature is on standby  
When selected feature is off  
D0  
D4  
When selected the Display is turned on  
When selected the Display is turned off  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Settings  
3-49  
Table 3-6. Example Power Setting Parameters  
Parameter  
Value  
Keyboard  
Settings  
kbd1:  
Power Key Wake  
Timeout Wake  
API Call Wake  
D0  
D3  
D4  
Set the Wake on=Yes, off=No  
Set the Wake on=Yes, off=No  
Set the Wake on=Yes, off=No  
When selected feature is on  
When selected feature is on standby  
When selected feature is off  
klt1:  
Keylight  
Battery Timeout  
60 (time value in ms)  
AC Power Timeout  
0 (time value in ms)  
D0  
D3  
D4  
When selected feature is on  
When selected feature is on standby  
When selected feature is off  
Activities:  
Trigger  
Touch  
Keyboard  
User  
Select Yes to set Activities to function on  
Battery Power and/or on AC Power. Select No to  
set activities not to function on Battery Power  
and/or on AC Power.  
pky1:  
rcm1:  
Power Key  
Display only  
Resource Coordinator Power Key Wake  
Timeout Wake  
Set the Wake on=Yes, off=No  
Set the Wake on=Yes, off=No  
Set the Wake on=Yes, off=No  
API Call Wake  
rtc1:  
Real Time Clock  
System  
Display only  
sys1:  
Battery Timeout  
180 (time value in ms)  
0 (time value in ms)  
AC Power Timeout  
tch1:  
Touch Panel  
Power Key Wake  
Set the Wake on=Yes, off=No  
Timeout Wake  
Set the Wake on=Yes, off=No  
API Call Wake  
Set the Wake on=Yes, off=No  
D0  
D3  
D4  
When selected the Touch Panel is turned on  
When selected feature is on standby  
When selected the Touch Panel is turned off  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3-50 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Table 3-6. Example Power Setting Parameters  
Parameter  
Value  
Settings  
wlp1:  
Wireless LAN  
Power Key Wake  
Timeout Wake  
API Call Wake  
D0  
D3  
D4  
Set the Wake on=Yes, off=No  
Set the Wake on=Yes, off=No  
Set the Wake on=Yes, off=No  
When selected feature is on  
When selected feature is on standby  
When selected feature is off  
usb1:  
USB Cable  
Power Key Wake  
Timeout Wake  
API Call Wake  
Set the Wake on=Yes, off=No  
Set the Wake on=Yes, off=No  
Set the Wake on=Yes, off=No  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Settings  
3-51  
Bluetooth Settings  
Use the Bluetooth Settings window to display the bluetooth parameters.  
Mobile computers that do not have Bluetooth capability display UNKNOWN values.  
1. Double-tap the Ctl Panel icon - double-tap Bluetooth Settings. The Bluetooth Settings  
window displays.  
Figure 3-48. Bluetooth Status Window  
2. Tap OK to return to the Control Panel window.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
3-52 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Date and Time  
Use the Date and Time window to set the date, time and time zone information for the mobile  
computer.  
1. Double-tap the Ctl Panel icon - double-tap Date and Time. The Date and Time window  
appears.  
Figure 3-49. Date and Time Window  
2. To set the Value for any item in the Date and Time column, use the up  
and down  
arrows to select the item.  
3. Use the left  
and right arrow  
buttons to select the value.  
4. Tap OK to return to the Control Panel window.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Settings  
3-53  
Printer Settings  
Use the Printer Settings window to select the printer information.  
1. Double-tap the Ctl Panel icon - double-tap Printer Settings. The Printer Settings window  
appears.  
Figure 3-50. Printer Settings Window  
2. To select a printer, tap the Selected Printer item in the Printer Settings column.  
3. Use the left  
include:  
and right  
arrows to select the printer. Available printer selections  
• QL420  
• Cameo_Series  
• Comtec_RP3  
• Encore_Series  
• Monarch9460  
• Monarch9490  
• QL320.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
3-54 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
4. Double-tap Printer Parameters to enter the Printer Parameters window.  
Figure 3-51. Printer Parameters Window  
5. Tap the Selected Printer item in the Printer Settings column.  
6. Use the left  
include:  
and right  
arrows to select the communication and baud rate. Values  
• Com1: 38400  
• Com1: 19200  
• Com1: 9600  
• Com2: 38400  
• Com2: 19200  
• Com2: 9600  
• Com3: 38400  
• Com3: 19200  
• Com3: 9600  
• Com4: 38400  
• Com4: 19200  
• Com4: 9600  
• LPT1:.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Settings  
3-55  
7. To view the Version Information, double-tap the Version Info item in the Printer Settings  
column.  
8. Version information includes:  
• API Version  
• PDD Version  
• MDD Version  
• TldVersion.  
Figure 3-52. Printer Version Information Window  
9. Tap OK to return to the Control Panel window.  
Developer support for adding additional Symbol printer drivers is provided in  
the SMDK, see Chapter 8, Software Installation for the SMDK installation.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3-56 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Comm Settings  
Use the Comm Settings window to select the communications settings.  
1. Double-tap the Ctl Panel icon - double-tap Comm Settings. The Comm Settings window  
appears.  
Figure 3-53. Comm Settings Window  
2. With Port highlighted, use the left  
and right arrow  
buttons to select the appropriate  
communication setting. Comm port selection values are:  
• USB (default setting)  
• Serial1 @ 115200  
• Serial1 @ 57600  
• Serial1 @ 38400.  
3. Tap OK to return to the Control Panel window.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Settings  
3-57  
Display Settings  
Use the Display Settings window to set the display parameters.  
1. Double-tap the Ctl Panel icon - double-tap Display Settings. The Display Settings window  
appears.  
Figure 3-54. Display Settings Window  
2. To set the Value for any item in the Display Settings column, use the up  
and down  
arrows to select the item.  
3. Once the item in the Display Settings column is highlighted, use the left  
and right arrow  
buttons to select a value. Tap OK to return to the Control Panel window.  
Table 3-7. Display Settings  
Display Setting  
# of colors  
Values  
65536  
Contrast  
Intensity  
0 to 15 (only on monochromatic units)  
Low, Medium, High, Super  
Backlight  
On, Off  
kbLight State  
kbLight Timer  
API Version  
Always off, Always on, Timeout  
5 Sec, 10 Sec, 20 Sec, 30 Sec, 1 Min, 5 Min  
01.07 (display only, not selectable)  
To optimize display performance, do not leave the display turned on to a fixed  
image for an extended period of time. Turn the mobile computer off, or use  
a screen saver when the mobile computer is not in use. Use the mobile  
computer Display Settings to automatically turn off the display when the unit  
is not in use, or use a screen saver application.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
3-58 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Audio Settings  
Use the Audio Settings window to set the audio parameters.  
1. Double-tap the Ctl Panel icon - double-tap Audio Settings. The Audio Settings window  
appears.  
Figure 3-55. Audio Settings Window  
2. Tap Beeper Volume in the Audio Settings column.  
3. Use the left  
and right arrow  
buttons to select the volume value to 0, 1, 2, or 3.  
4. API Version and Notify API Version are display values only.  
5. Tap OK to return to the Control Panel window.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Settings  
3-59  
Scanner Settings  
Use the Scanner Settings window to set the scanner information.  
1. Double-tap the Ctl Panel icon - double-tap Scanner Settings. The Scanner Settings window  
appears.  
Figure 3-56. Scan Settings Window  
2. To change any item in the Scanner Settings column, use the up  
and down  
arrows  
to select the item. Selected Scanner is a display only value.  
3. Double-tap the item to open a new window.  
Reader Parameters, see Reader Parameters on page 3-60.  
Interface Parameters, see Interface Parameters on page 3-61.  
Scan Parameters, see Scan Parameters on page 3-62.  
Device Information, see Device Information on page 3-65.  
Scanner Version, see Scanner Version on page 3-66.  
4. Tap OK to return to the Control Panel window.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
3-60 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Reader Parameters  
Use the Reader Parameters window to set the scanning read parameters.  
1. Double-tap the Ctl Panel icon - double-tap Scanner Settings - double-tap Reader  
Parameters. The Reader Parameters window appears.  
Figure 3-57. Reader Parameters Window  
2. To change any item in the Reader Parameters column, use the up  
and down  
arrows  
to select the item.  
3. Use the left  
and right arrow  
buttons to increment the value. Table 3-8 list the  
Reader Parameter value options.  
Table 3-8. Reader Parameters  
Reader Parameters  
Values  
Reader Type  
Aim Type  
Laser  
Trigger, Timed hold, Timed Release  
0-60,000 in increments of 100  
Dot, Slab, Reticle, None  
Normal, Narrow  
Aim Duration  
Aim Mode  
Beam Width  
Raster Mode  
Beam Timer  
Control LED  
LED Level  
Smart, Cyclone, None, Always Open,  
0-60,000 in increments of 100  
False, True  
High, Low  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Settings  
3-61  
Table 3-8. Reader Parameters (Continued)  
Reader Parameters  
Class 1 Sup  
Values  
False, True  
Redundancy  
None, Bidirectional  
Linear Sec  
(Short, Redun), (Short, Codabar), (All codes *2), (Long*2, Short*3), (All codes *3)  
0-60,000 in increments of 100  
Pointer Timer  
Raster Height  
0-100 in increments of 5  
4. Tap OK to return to the Control Panel window.  
Interface Parameters  
Use the Interface Parameters window to set the scanning interface parameters.  
1. Double-tap the Ctl Panel icon - double-tap Scanner Settings - double-tap Interface  
Parameters. The Interface Parameters window appears  
Figure 3-58. Interface Parameters Window  
2. To change any item in the Interface Parameters column, use the up  
and down  
arrows to select the item.  
3. Use the left  
and right arrow  
buttons to increment the value. Table 3-9 list the  
Reader Parameter value options.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
3-62 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Table 3-9. Interface Parameters  
Interface Parameter  
Interface Type  
Values  
Symbol SSI  
Power Settle Time  
Power Off Settle Time  
0-1000 in increments of 50  
0-1000 in increments of 50  
4. Tap OK to return to the Control Panel window.  
Scan Parameters  
Use the Scan Parameters window to set the scan parameters.  
1. Double-tap the Ctl Panel icon - double-tap Scanner Settings - double-tap Scan Params. The  
Scan Parameters window appears.  
Figure 3-59. Scan Parameters Window  
2. To change any item in the Scan Parameters column, use the up  
and down  
arrows  
to select the item.  
3. Use the left  
and right arrow  
buttons to increment the value. Table 3-10 list the Scan  
Parameter value options.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Settings  
3-63  
Table 3-10. Scan Parameters  
Scan Parameters  
Code ID Type  
Scan Type  
Values  
None, Symbol, AIM  
Forgrnd, Bkgrnd, Monitor  
True, False  
Local Feedback  
WAV File  
See Figure 3-60 on page 3-64, Tap Decrement to move back on  
the WAV file listing and Increment to move forward on the  
WAV file listing. Tap OK to select the WAV file.  
Beep Time  
Beep Freq  
0-5000 in increments of 100  
2500-3500 in increments of 10  
0-5000 in increments of 500  
LED Time  
Start WAV File  
See Figure 3-60 on page 3-64, Tap Decrement to move back on  
the WAV file listing and Increment to move forward on the  
WAV file listing. Tap OK to select the WAV file.  
Start Beep Time  
Start Beep Freq  
Start LED Time  
Interim WAV File  
0-5000 in increments of 100  
2500-3500 in increments of 10  
0-5000 in increments of 500  
See Figure 3-60 on page 3-64, Tap Decrement to move back on  
the WAV file listing and Increment to move forward on the  
WAV file listing. Tap OK to select the WAV file.  
Interim Beep Time  
Interim Beep Freq  
Interim LED Time  
Fatal WAV File  
0-5000 in increments of 100  
2500-3500 in increments of 10  
0-5000 in increments of 500  
See Figure 3-60 on page 3-64, Tap Decrement to move back on  
the WAV file listing and Increment to move forward on the  
WAV file listing. Tap OK to select the WAV file.  
Fatal Beep Time  
Fatal Beep Freq  
Fatal LED Time  
0-5000 in increments of 100  
2500-3500 in increments of 10  
0-5000 in increments of 500  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
3-64 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Table 3-10. Scan Parameters (Continued)  
Scan Parameters  
Values  
Nonfatal WAV File  
See Figure 3-60 on page 3-64, Tap Decrement to move back on  
the WAV file listing and Increment to move forward on the  
WAV file listing. Tap OK to select the WAV file.  
Nonfatal Beep Time  
Nonfatal Beep Freq  
Nonfatal LED Time  
Activity WAV File  
0-5000 in increments of 100  
2500-3500 in increments of 10  
0-5000 in increments of 500  
See Figure 3-60 on page 3-64, Tap Decrement to move back on  
the WAV file listing and Increment to move forward on the  
WAV file listing. Tap OK to select the WAV file.  
Activity Beep Time  
Activity Beep Freq  
Activity LED Time  
0-5000 in increments of 100  
2500-3500 in increments of 10  
0-5000 in increments of 500  
4. Tap OK to return to the Control Panel window.  
WAV File  
Use the WAV File window to select a .wav file. Use the Increment and Decrement buttons to scroll  
through the wav file listing.  
Figure 3-60. Scan WAV File Window  
Tap OK to return to the Control Panel window.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Settings  
3-65  
Device Information  
Use the Device Information window to view the scanner information.  
1. Double-tap the Ctl Panel icon - double-tap Scanner Settings - double-tap Scan Parameters.  
The Scan Parameters window appears.  
Figure 3-61. Device Information Parameters Window  
2. To change any item in the Device Information column, use the up  
and down  
arrows  
to select the item.  
3. Use the left  
and right arrow  
buttons to increment the value. Table 3-11 list the  
Reader Parameter value options.  
Table 3-11. Device Information Parameters  
Device Info Parameter  
Beam Width  
Values  
True  
Aim Mode  
True  
Scan Direction  
Feedback  
False  
False  
None  
(0,0,0,0)  
Supported Fmts  
Max Image Rect  
4. Tap OK to return to the Control Panel window.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
3-66 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Scanner Version  
Use the Scanner Version window to view the scanner version information.  
1. Double-tap the Ctl Panel icon - double-tap Scanner Settings - double-tap Scanner Version.  
The Scanner Version window appears.  
Figure 3-62. Scanner Version Window  
2. To change any item in the Scanner Version column, use the up  
and down  
arrows to  
select the item.  
3. Use the left  
and right arrow  
buttons to increment the value. Table 3-12 list the  
Reader Parameter value options.  
Table 3-12. Version Parameters  
Version Parameter  
API Version  
Values  
04.02  
05.06  
04.11  
00.00  
00.00  
MDD Version  
PDD Version  
Decoder Version  
Hardware Version  
4. Tap OK to return to the Control Panel window.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Communications  
4-3  
Introduction  
The mobile computer is capable of communicating with a number of hosts, including development  
computers, serial devices, printers, etc. The available accessories serve as essential data  
communication devices, enabling the information to be synchronized on the mobile computer with the  
information on the host device using ActiveSync. With the appropriate accessory and software, the  
mobile computer can establish a number of connection types, such as a serial connection, a USB  
connection and an Ethernet connection.  
For an Ethernet connection, use the Four Slot Ethernet Cradle.  
For a serial or USB connection, use one of the accessories listed below.  
Single Slot Serial/USB Cradle  
Cable Adapter Module (CAM)  
Magnetic Stripe Reader (MSR).  
This chapter provides information on installing the appropriate communication software and setting  
up the appropriate accessory to enable communication between the mobile computer and the host  
device. For more information about the accessories available for the mobile computer, Chapter 7,  
Installing Communication Software  
To successfully communicate with the various host devices Microsoft Activesync (version 3.7 or  
higher) must be installed on the host computer.  
Installing ActiveSync  
Use ActiveSync (version 3.7 or higher) to synchronize the information on the mobile computer with  
the information on the host computer. Changes made on the mobile computer or host computer  
appear in both places after synchronization.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
4-4 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
ActiveSync software:  
Allows the user to work with mobile computer-compatible host applications on the host  
computer. ActiveSync replicates data from the mobile computer so data can be viewed,  
entered and modified on the mobile computer with the host application.  
Synchronize files between the mobile computer and host computer. The files are  
automatically converted to the correct format.  
Back up the data stored on the mobile computer. Synchronization is a one-step procedure  
that ensures the data is always safe and up-to-date.  
Copy (rather than synchronize) files between the mobile computer and host computer.  
Control when synchronization occurs by selecting a synchronization mode, e.g., set to  
synchronize continually while the mobile computer is connected to the host computer, or set  
to only synchronize on command.  
Select the types of information to synchronize and control how much data is synchronized.  
To install ActiveSync on the host computer:  
1. Download the latest version of the software from http://www.microsoft.com. Refer to the  
installation and RAS instructions included with the ActiveSync software.  
2. Set up a partnership via the ActiveSync connection using a serial connection to the host  
computer.  
Setting up a Partnership  
After ActiveSync installation is complete, the ActiveSync Setup Wizard helps the user to connect the  
mobile computer to the host computer, set up a partnership to synchronize information between the  
mobile computer and host computer and customize synchronization settings.  
Before setting up a partnership between the mobile computer and host computer, refer to the  
communication setup sections in this chapter for detailed information about Serial, USB and Ethernet  
communication setups.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Communications  
4-5  
To set up a partnership:  
1. If the Get Connected window does not appear on the host computer, select Start - Programs  
- Microsoft ActiveSync - File - Get Connected.  
Figure 4-1. Get Connected Window  
2. Connect the mobile computer to the host computer using the appropriate Serial connection  
3. On the host computer, select Next in the Get Connected window.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-6 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
4. The host computer and the mobile computer attempt to synchronize. The New Partnership  
window appears.  
Figure 4-2. New Partnership Window  
5. Click the Standard partnership radio button and then select Next. The New Partnership/  
Specify how to synchronize data window appears.  
Figure 4-3. How To Sync Window  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Communications  
4-7  
6. Click the Synchronize with this desktop computer radio button and select Next. The New  
Partnership/Select Number of Partnerships window appears.  
Figure 4-4. How To Sync Window  
7. Click the Yes, I want to synchronize with only this computer radio button and then select  
Next. The New Partnership/Select Synchronization Settings window appears.  
Figure 4-5. Select Synchronization Settings Window  
8. To synchronize a particular type of information, select its check box. To stop synchronization  
of that information, clear its check box.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-8 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
9. Select Next. The New Partnership/Setup Complete window appears.  
Figure 4-6. Setup Complete Window  
10. Select Finish.  
Figure 4-7. ActiveSync Connected Window  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Communications  
4-9  
During the first synchronization, information stored on the host computer is copied to the mobile  
computer. When the copy is complete and all data is synchronized, the mobile computer can be  
disconnect from the host computer.  
The first ActiveSync operation must be performed with a local, direct  
connection.  
To retain partnerships after a cold boot, capture partnership registry  
information in a .reg file and save it in the Flash File System, detailed  
information is provided in the SMDK Windows CE Help File for Symbol  
Mobile Computers. See Chapter 8, Software Installation for the SMDK  
installation.  
For more information about using ActiveSync, start ActiveSync on the host computer, then see  
ActiveSync Help.  
Communication Setup  
The mobile computer can communicate with the host computer using serial, USB or Ethernet  
communications. The communication setup procedures for the Single Slot Serial/USB Cradle and the  
Four Slot Ethernet Cradle are provided in this section as an example. See the provided reference for  
detailed procedures for setting up other accessories:  
Serial or USB Connection:  
Ethernet connection:  
For each accessory, follow the instructions on configuring the host computer, setting up the  
connection between the mobile computer and the host computer and configuring the mobile  
computer.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
4-10 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Serial Communications Setup  
The serial communications setup can be used to set up to communicate with a Single Slot Serial/USB  
Cradle, MSR or a CAM.  
For serial communications using the Single Slot Serial/USB Cradle, connect  
only the serial cable, do not connect both the serial cable and the USB cable.  
If both serial and USB communications cables are required, the host  
computer USB port must be disabled in ActiveSync before serial  
communications can be enabled.  
Serial Connection Setup  
1. On the mobile computer double-tap the Ctl Panel icon and double-tap on Comm Settings  
to enter the Comm Settings, window. For detailed procedures, see Comm Settings on page  
3-56.  
Figure 4-8. Comm Settings Window  
2. With Port highlighted, use the left  
and right arrow  
buttons to select the value.  
Comm port default value is set to USB, change the value to: Serial1 @ 115200 (or a serial  
setting appropriate for the host computer).  
3. Tap OK to exit the Comm Settings window and tap Exit to exit the Control Panel window.  
4. Ensure that ActiveSync was installed on the host computer and a partnership was created.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Communications  
4-11  
5. Start ActiveSync if it is not running on the host computer. To start, select Start - Programs -  
Microsoft ActiveSync.  
Figure 4-9. ActiveSync - Not Connected  
6. In the ActiveSync window, select File - Connection Settings and ensure the selections  
shown in Figure 4-10 are made. (Select the appropriate COM port for the host computer.)  
Figure 4-10. Serial Connection Settings  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
4-12 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
7. Tap OK to save any changes made.  
Every mobile computer should have a unique device name. Never try to  
synchronize more than one mobile computer to the same name.  
8. Connect the device to the host computer, see Figure 7-6 on page 7-12 to set up a Single Slot  
Serial/USB Cradle, or see Figure 7-25 on page 7-37 to set up a MSR or a CAM.  
The cradle requires a dedicated port. It cannot share a port with an internal  
modem or other device. Refer to the computer user manual supplied to locate  
the serial port(s).  
9. Upon connection, synchronization occurs automatically.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Communications  
4-13  
USB Connection Setup  
1. The USB communications setup can be used to set up to communicate with a Single Slot  
Serial/USB Cradle, MSR or a CAM.  
2. On the mobile computer double-tap the Ctl Panel icon and double-tap Comm Settings to  
enter the Comm Settings, window.  
Figure 4-11. Comm Settings Window  
3. Confirm that the Comm port default value is set to USB. If it is not set to USB then with Port  
highlighted, use the left  
and right arrow  
buttons to set the value to USB.  
4. Tap OK to exit the Comm Settings window and tap Exit to exit the Control Panel window.  
5. Ensure that ActiveSync was installed on the host computer and a partnership was created.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
4-14 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
6. Start ActiveSync if it is not running on the host computer. To start, select Start - Programs -  
Microsoft ActiveSync.  
Figure 4-12. ActiveSync - Not Connected  
7. In the ActiveSync window, select File - Connection Settings and ensure the selections  
shown in Figure 4-13 are made. Select USB port for the host computer.)  
Figure 4-13. USB Connection Settings  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Communications  
4-15  
8. Tap OK to save any changes made.  
Every mobile computer should have a unique device name. Never try to  
synchronize more than one mobile computer to the same name.  
9. Connect the device to the host computer, see Figure 7-6 on page 7-12 to set up a Single Slot  
Serial/USB Cradle, or see Figure 7-25 on page 7-37 to set up a MSR or a CAM.  
The cradle requires a dedicated port. It cannot share a USB port with any  
other device. Refer to the computer user manual supplied to locate the  
USB(s).  
10. Upon connection, synchronization occurs automatically.  
Using ActiveSync  
1. Review the configuration of the cradle using the MobileDox Cradle Manager.  
a. A WIN server must be present on your network. Ensure that the WINS Address provided  
in the TCP/IP Settings tab matches the IP address of the WIN server on your network.  
b. Ensure that the Use NAT checkbox is not selected in the Port Settings tab.  
2. Insert the terminal into the cradle. The mobile computer displays a succession of dialog  
boxes appear, indicating the status of the connection. Also the ActiveSync icon on the host  
computer’s system tray turns green to indicate that the host computer and the mobile  
computer are communicating.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
4-16 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Ethernet Setup  
The Ethernet connection can only be established with the Four Slot Ethernet cradle. To establish a  
connection between the mobile computer and the host computer to communicate over an Ethernet  
network, perform the following:  
Install MobileDox Cradle Manager  
Install eConnect  
Mobile computer configuration  
Host computer configuration  
DHCP server configuration  
Cradle configuration.  
Installing MobileDox Cradle Manager  
MobileDox Cradle Manager is used only when establishing a connection  
using the Four Slot Ethernet Cradle.  
The Cradle Management software features:  
View cradles that are attached to the network via MobileDox Net  
View cradle status  
Modify cradle settings including:  
• IP address settings  
• DNS and WINS settings  
• Identification settings  
• USB port specific settings  
Restart cradles connected to the network via MobileDox Net  
Update the firmware of MobileDox Net.  
To install the Cradle Management Software on the host computer, download the latest version of the  
software from http://devzone.symbol.com. Refer to the instructions included with the software.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Communications  
4-17  
Installing eConnect  
eConnect is used only when establishing a connection using the Four Slot  
Ethernet Cradle.  
1. To install the eConnect on the mobile computer, download the latest version of the software  
on to the host computer (from http://devzone.symbol.com).  
2. On the mobile computer copy the eConnect .cab file to the /Application directory.  
Figure 4-14. Copy eConnect .cab File Window  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
4-18 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
3. Double-tap the eConnect .cab file, the eConnect install window appears. Double -tap OK.  
Figure 4-15. eConnect Install Window  
4. Double-tap the Files icon, open the Windows directory and double-tap the control.lnk file the  
eConnect Icon window appears.  
Figure 4-16. Windows Directory, control.lnk File  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Communications  
4-19  
5. Double-tap the eConnect icon, the eConnect Properties window appears.  
Figure 4-17. eConnect Icon Window  
6. Tap the Establish TCP/IP Connection checkbox and select USB from the Serial Port Baud Rate  
drop down menu. Double-tap OK to enter the settings and complete the eConnect  
installation.  
Figure 4-18. eConnect Properties Window  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-20 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Mobile Computer Configuration  
Inserting the mobile computer into the cradle provides direct-connect RAS service. Configure each  
mobile computer for use with the cradle, just as any remote client would be configured to connect to  
an Internet Service Provider (ISP). See Persist on page 3-45 to save the settings to the registry.  
The computer comm port to setting was set to USB during the eConnect installation procedure. To  
confirm the setting:  
1. On the mobile computer double-tap the Ctl Panel icon and double-tap Comm Settings to  
enter the Comm Settings, window.  
Figure 4-19. Comm Settings Window  
2. Confirm that the Port Value is set to USB. To change the setting tap Port to highlight and use  
the left  
and right arrow  
buttons to select the USB value.  
3. Tap OK to exit the Comm Settings window and tap Exit to exit the Control Panel window.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Communications  
4-21  
Host Computer Configuration  
The host computer must be setup with the appropriate communication software and connection  
settings. This describes using Microsoft® ActiveSync software on both the terminal and the host  
computer. To configure the host computer:  
1. Download and install ActiveSync. See Installing ActiveSync on page 4-3.  
2. Configure the connection settings. The host computer must be configured for TCP/IP  
network communications.  
a. Click the ActiveSync icon  
b. Click on File - Connection settings  
c. In the Connection settings dialog box, select the Allow Network (Ethernet) and Remote  
Access Service (RAS) server connection with this desktop computer option.  
Other options may be selected, for example, Allow serial cable or infrared connection to  
this COM port.  
3. Click OK.  
Before communicating through an ethernet connection, create a partnership  
between the mobile computer and the host computer. See Setting up a  
Partnership on page 4-4 for detailed instructions.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-22 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
DHCP Server Configuration  
If you use a DHCP server to distribute IP addresses and other network parameters, setup the server  
as following:  
IP address pool (1 or 5 IP address per cradle)  
Router/gateway address  
One or more DNS server addresses  
One or more WINS server addresses  
Subnet mask.  
To assign the initial cradle IP address, you can either use a DHCP server, as  
shown above, or use the MobileDox Cradle Manager, see Installing  
MobileDox Cradle Manager on page 4-16. DHCP server is the preferred  
method.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Communications  
4-23  
Cradle Configuration  
The MobileDox Cradle Manager allows you to setup the Device IP Address and modify cradle  
settings. See Installing MobileDox Cradle Manager on page 4-16 for instructions to download and  
install the software. To connect the cradle, see Four Slot Ethernet Cradle on page 7-28.  
Setting the Device IP Address  
By default, the cradle will use DHCP to obtain its IP address. However, if DHCP fails, the Cradle  
Manager can assign an IP address.  
This is used if the cradle is connected to the network, but fails to appear in  
MobileDox. Enter the hardware device (MAC) address to locate the cradle  
and assign it a new IP address.  
1. Launch the MobileDox Cradle Manager on your host computer.  
2. Click File - Set IP Address of Unlisted Device. The following screen appears:  
Figure 4-20. MobileDox, Set IP Address of Unlisted Device Window  
3. Enter the appropriate MAC Address and IP address.  
4. Click OK.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
4-24 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Modifying Cradle Settings  
1. Launch the MobileDox Cradle Manager on your host computer.  
2. Select the name of the cradle you want to configure from the list.  
3. Click Device - Modify Settings.  
4. Use the General Settings tab to modify the identification settings of the cradle.  
Field  
Description  
Device Name  
A text string used to describe the  
MobileDox device. Any 15-character  
string may be entered.  
Custom String  
A text string for any desired usage  
(examples are: location, asset ID, etc.).  
Any 15-character string may be  
entered.  
Require Admin  
Privileges to Modify  
Settings checkbox  
Selecting this checkbox will require  
users to have administrative privileges  
in order to modify MobileDox settings.  
Administrative privileges are validated  
using standard Windows  
authentication.  
Figure 4-21. MobileDox, General Settings Window  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Communications  
4-25  
5. Use the TPC/IP Settings tab to modify the DNS and WINS identification settings of the  
cradle.  
Field  
Use DHCP  
Description  
If checkbox is selected, necessary  
information will be retrieved from the  
DHCP server.  
If checkbox is not selected, static  
configuration will be used (information  
needs to be entered).  
IP Address  
The IP address that the MobileDox will  
use when communicating on the  
network.  
Subnet Mask  
The subnet mask that the MobileDox  
will use when communicating on the  
network.  
Gateway Address  
DNS Address  
The IP address that the MobileDox will  
use to send non-local IP network data.  
The IP address of a server(s) that can  
resolve Internet names into IP  
addresses.  
WINS Address  
The IP address of a server(s) that can  
resolve Windows network names into IP  
addresses.  
This field must be populated correctly  
when using ActiveSync.  
Figure 4-22. MobileDox, TPC/IP Settings Window  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-26 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
6. Use the Port Settings tab to modify the USB port settings of the cradle.  
Field  
Port Name  
Description  
A text string used to describe the device  
attached to the port. Any 15-character  
string can be entered.  
You can specify up to four port names,  
one for each of the cradles slots.  
IP Address  
The IP address assigned to the cradled  
device. There should be one IP address  
per cradle slot. This box will be disabled  
for all devices if DHCP is used to obtain  
the IP address.  
Use DHCP to obtain The cradle will use DHCP to obtain an IP  
IP Address checkbox address for the handheld.  
Unchecking this selection allows the  
cradle to use Static IP address for the  
handheld.  
Use NAT checkbox The cradle will use Network Address  
Translation (NAT) when forwarding  
handheld traffic onto the network. No IP  
addresses are necessary for the  
handhelds.  
This must be disable when using  
ActiveSync.  
Figure 4-23. MobileDox, Port Settings Window  
7. Click OK.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Communications  
4-27  
Connecting to the Internet on a Wireless Network  
The mobile computer can connect to the Internet across a wireless network. To set up a wireless  
connection:  
1. Tap the Mobile Companion icon  
, on the taskbar.  
2. Tap Find WLANs. The Mobile Companion window appears.  
Figure 4-24. Find WLANs Window  
3. The mobile computer tries to locate Access Points (APs) in the area. When it locates a  
wireless LAN(s), the ESSID name appears in the WLAN Profile list.  
4. Tap the ESSID name and then tap Connect.  
5. The Mobile Companion Mode tab appears.  
Figure 4-25. Mobile Companion - Mode Tab  
6. The profile name and ESSID name appears in the respective fields.  
7. In the Operating Mode: list, select Infrastructure.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
4-28 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
8. Select the Authentication tab to configure server-based authentication through IEEE 802.1x  
or Kerberos. Select an option (None, Kerberos, LEAP, EAP-TLS, PEAP) from the  
Authentication drop-down list.  
.
Kerberos Authentication  
Credential Caching Settings  
(Kerberos Options)  
Figure 4-26. Mobile Companion - Authentication Tab (Kerberos)  
Figure 4-27. Mobile Companion - Authentication Tab (LEAP)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Communications  
4-29  
Install / View Certificates  
EAP-TLS Authentication  
Figure 4-28. Mobile Companion - Authentication Tab (EAP-TLS)  
PEAP Authentication  
Install / View Certificates  
Figure 4-29. Mobile Companion - Authentication Tab (PEAP)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
4-30 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
9. Select the Encryption tab to set the adapter profile security level by configuring the  
encryption scheme and corresponding keys. Select an option (Open System, WEP, Keyguard-  
MCM, TKIP (WPA)) from the Encryption drop-down list. See Table 6-7 on page 6-14 for  
Encryption option descriptions.  
Figure 4-30. Encryption Tab  
The absence of a physical connection makes wireless links vulnerable to information theft.  
Encryption is an efficient method of preventing data theft and improving data security.  
If an AP is set to 40-bit and an adapter is set to 128-bit, the adapter can associate to the AP,  
but no data transmission and reception can take place.  
10. Select the encryption algorithm used on the wireless network (Open System, 40-bit Shared  
Key, 128-bit Shared Key or Kerberos).  
To select 40-bit Shared Key, 128-bit Shared Key or Kerberos, enter the required data in the  
fields that appear in the window. See the network administrator for this information.  
11. Tap the IP Config tab.  
Figure 4-31. Mobile Companion - IP Config Tab (DHCP)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Communications  
4-31  
12. In the IP Type drop-down menu, select either DHCP or Static. To select static IP, enter the  
required data in the fields that appear in the window. See the network administrator for this  
information.  
13. Tap OK and Tap OK.  
14. The Mobile Companion wireless status icon indicates that the mobile computer is connected  
to the AP. If the status icon does not indicate that the mobile computer is connected to the  
AP, see the system administrator.  
15. Select Start - Programs - Internet Explorer.  
16. In the address bar, enter the URL.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
4-32 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Applications  
Chapter Contents  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
5-2 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Applications  
5-3  
Introduction  
Two type of applications are provided. Example applications provide the application developer with  
sample applications that can be used to assist in application development. The source code is  
available for these applications in the Symbol Windows CE SMDK for Series 9000. The remaining  
applications are supplied to provide additional mobile computer functionality.  
Double-tap the application icon to open the application. The application icons are available in the  
Series 9000 Demo window and in the Test Applications window. The Series 9000 Demo window is  
the default menu when the unit is turned on. Double-tap the Test Apps icon on the Series 9000 Demo  
window to access the Test Applications window. Double-tap the Back icon to return to the Series  
9000 Demo window. The Series 9000 Demo window icon functions are provided in Table 5-1.  
Series 9000 Demo Window  
Test Applications Window  
Figure 5-1. Applications Windows  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
5-4 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Table 5-1. Applications  
Icon  
Description  
Displays the ScanSamp2 example application that is used to set up and run the example  
scan application, see ScanSamp2 on page 5-6.  
Displays the InkWiz sample application. This file browser displays the system’s  
file structure, see InkWiz File Browser on page 5-9.  
The file browser is also used to access the following applications:  
Displays the AudioSamp sample application, see AudioSamp on page 5-13.  
Displays the image viewer sample application, see Images on page 5-14.  
PC Link accesses the Microsoft ActiveSync application, see PC Link on page 5-16.  
Displays the OTL version information example application, see About OTL on page 5-17.  
Displays the self test application, see Self Test on page 5-18.  
Displays the notify example application, see Notify on page 5-21.  
Displays the keyboard example application, see Keyboard on page 5-22.  
Displays the display example application, see Display on page 5-23.  
Displays the memory example application, see Memory on page 5-24.  
Displays the MSR 9000 setup application, see MSR9000 on page 5-25.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Applications  
5-5  
Table 5-1. Applications (Continued)  
Icon  
Description  
Displays the MSR 9000 Cameo setup application, see MSR Cameo on page 5-26.  
Displays the Printer application, see Printing on page 5-27.  
The windows shown are configured as part of the factory default demo  
program (OTL.exe). OTL.exe can be configured via registry settings to user  
specified applications.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-6 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
ScanSamp2  
Use the ScanSamp2 example application to enable the mobile computer’s scanner and display  
scanned data. It also allows the user to change the scan parameters.  
From the Series 9000 Demo window, double-tap the Scan icon.  
ScanSamp2 Window  
View Window  
Figure 5-2. ScanSamp2 Examples  
ScanSamp2 Windows  
After a bar code is scanned, the following data displays in the scan window:  
Data - Displays the data encoded in the scanned bar code.  
Type - Indicates the hex type scanned.  
SRC - Indicates the scanner used and the bar code type scanned (e.g., Code 128).  
Time - Displays the time the bar code was scanned.  
Tap Scan to start the scanner (alternative to pushing the scan button).  
Tap View to display the bar code content in a separate window.  
Tap Param to display the Parameters window, see Parameters Window on page 5-7.  
Tap Codes to display the Selected Bar Code window, see Codes Window on page 5-8.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Applications  
5-7  
Parameters Window  
The Parameters window is used to set the scan parameter.  
Tap Code ID to select the code ID value (None, Symbol, AIM).  
Tap Scan Type to select the scan type (Background, Foreground, Monitor).  
Tap Feedback Parameters to select the feedback parameters category (Good Decode,  
Intermediate, Fatal, Start, Activity, Nonfatal). All of the parameter categories use the  
same format Parameters Input Window, see Figure 5-3.  
To change the beep wave file enter a new path and name into the Wave File box. Use the  
left  
and right  
arrow buttons to set the values for the Beep, Freq and LED. Note, units  
that do not have the optional .wav file capability can not use the new .wav file setting.  
Parameters Window  
Parameters Input Windows  
Figure 5-3. ScanSamp2 Examples  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
5-8 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Codes Window  
The Codes window is used to set the scan type parameter.  
Tap Param to select the code types, tap in the box to select a code type.  
To set parameters for a code type, tap the code type to highlight it and then tap Param to  
display the Code Parameters Sample Window, see Figure 5-4. Different code types will have  
parameter settings specific to that code type, so the windows will differ.  
To set length for a code type, tap the code type to highlight it and then tap Length to display  
the code length sample window, see Figure 5-4. Different code types will have length  
settings specific to that code type, so the setting windows will differ.  
Codes Window  
Code Parameters Sample Window  
Code Length Sample Window  
Figure 5-4. ScanSamp2 Examples  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Applications  
5-9  
InkWiz File Browser  
Use the InkWiz file browser example application to browse, cut, copy, paste, delete files and to  
execute programs.  
From the Series 9000 Demo window, double-tap the Files icon. The InkWiz Example window appears.  
Menu Bar  
Button Bar  
Figure 5-5. InkWiz Example Window  
The Menu Bar and Button Bar are used to navigate organize files on the mobile computer.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
5-10 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Internet Explorer  
Use Internet Explorer, to view Internet or intranet Web pages on the mobile computer. A modem, an  
Ethernet connection or a Spectrum24 connection is required to connect to an Internet service provider  
(ISP) or network.  
From the Series 9000 Demo window, double-tap Files icon - double-tap on Application - double-tap  
IEBrowser.exe. The Internet Explorer window appears.  
Figure 5-6. Internet Explorer Window  
Browsing the Web  
To browse the Web:  
1. Connect to a network using a wireless connection. See Connecting to the Internet on a  
2. Once connected, go to a specific Web page in one of the following ways:  
3. Use the keypad to enter the web address In the address bar, press the ENT key.  
4. Tap the address bar drop-down arrow to select a previously entered addresses.  
5. To end the connection, select File - Close.  
If Internet Explorer is selected before setting up the network connections, a  
window may appear to proceed to the connection settings window.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Applications  
5-11  
Setting up a Proxy Server  
Proxy servers are often used when connecting to the Internet through a local network, such as a  
corporate network, for added security. To set the proxy server settings:  
1. From the menu bar, select View - Options - Proxy Server tab.  
2. Select Use Proxy Server.  
3. Enter the proxy server address and port. For more information, see the network  
administrator.  
4. To bypass the proxy server for local addresses, such as corporate intranet pages, select  
Bypass Proxy for Local Addresses.  
5. Tap OK.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
5-12 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Remote Desktop  
Use Remote Desktop connection to log onto a Windows Terminal Server and to use the programs  
installed on the server. For example, instead of running Microsoft Pocket Word, the desktop version  
of Microsoft Word can be run.  
Connecting to a Terminal Server  
To connect to a terminal server:  
1. From the Series 9000 Demo window double-tap on Files icon - Windows - Desktop double-  
tap on Remote Desktop Connection.Ink, or run 'MSTSC' from the command prompt. The  
initial Remote Desktop Connection window appears.  
Figure 5-7. Remote Desktop Connection Window  
2. In the Computer drop-down list, type a Terminal Server name or TCP/IP address, or select a  
server and tap Connect.  
3. In the next Remote Desktop Connection window, type the user name, password and domain  
(if required) and then tap OK.  
Disconnecting Without Ending a Session  
To disconnect a session:  
1. In the Remote Desktop Connection window, select Start - Shutdown.  
2. Tap Disconnect.  
3. Tap OK.  
If Terminal Server was disconnected from without ending the session, the  
Terminal Server will continue to execute any running processes. Remote  
Desktop Connection can later reconnect to this same session (if the  
administrator configured Remote Desktop Connection to reconnect to  
disconnected sessions).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Applications  
5-13  
Disconnecting and Ending a Session  
To end a session:  
1. In the Remote Desktop Connection window, select Start - Shutdown.  
2. Tap Log Off.  
3. Tap OK.  
AudioSamp  
Use the AudioSamp application as an example of how to work with audio files such as recording and  
playback. The AudioSamp application can only be used on mobile computers that have the audio  
enabled option.  
1. From the Series 9000 Demo window, double-tap the Sounds icon. The AudioSamp Example  
window appears.  
Figure 5-8. AudioSamp Application Window  
2. Tap the file folder to access the sounds files. The default directory location is  
\Application\Wav\ this directory provides .wav files that can only be used on the units that  
have the optional .wav file capability. For units that do not have the optional .wav file  
capability select .wav files from the \Platform\Alias\ directory.  
3. Double-tap a file name to select the .wav file.  
4. Tap the green triangle button to play the file.  
5. Tap Exit to return to the Series 9000 Demo window.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
5-14 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Images  
Use the Images application as an example of how to work with image files, panning, zooming, saving  
and reading.  
1. From the Series 9000 Demo window, double-tap the Images icon. The ImagesViewer  
Example window appears..  
Figure 5-9. Image Window  
2. Select the folder icon  
to display the contents of the images folder.  
Figure 5-10. Select File to View Window  
3. Double-tap the image name to display it.  
4. Use the positioning, sizing and save icons to manipulate and save the image, see Table 5-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Applications  
5-15  
Table 5-2. Images Button Descriptions  
Button  
Description  
Button  
Description  
Pan Up (panning mode), increase vertical size  
of image.  
Pan Down (panning mode), decrease vertical  
size of image.  
Pan left (panning mode), decrease horizontal  
size of image.  
Pan right (panning mode), increase horizontal  
size of image.  
Open an image file.  
Set mode to "resize."  
Set mode to "fine panning."  
Set mode to “rough panning.”  
Opens the Images About window.  
Save the current image.  
Exit the Image Viewer application.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
5-16 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
PC Link  
Use the PC Link icon as a shortcut to the device-side Active-Sync component repllog.exe. Microsoft  
ActiveSync, synchronizes the information on the desktop computer with the information on mobile  
computer. Synchronization compares the data on the mobile computer with the desktop computer and  
updates both computers with the most recent information.  
1. From the Series 9000 Demo window, double-tap PC Link icon to start ActiveSync.  
ActiveSync automatically connects when the mobile computer is connected  
to the host computer.  
Figure 5-11. Connecting to Host Computer  
Copying Files  
Copying a file results in separate versions of a file on the mobile computer and desktop computer.  
Since the files are not synchronized, changes made to one file will not affect the other.  
1. Connect the mobile computer to the host computer.  
2. In ActiveSync on the host computer, click Explore. Windows Explorer will open the Mobile  
Device window for the mobile computer.  
3. Open a new Windows Explorer and browse to the file to be copied on the mobile computer  
or host computer.  
4. Do one of the following:  
• To copy the file to the mobile computer, right-click the file and select Copy. Place the  
cursor in the desired folder on the mobile computer, right-click and select Paste.  
• To copy the file to the host computer, right-click the file and select Copy. Open a new  
Windows Explorer, browse to the desired folder on the host computer, right-click and  
select Paste.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Applications  
5-17  
About OTL  
Use About OTL example application window to display the OTL software version information.  
1. From the Series 9000 Demo window, double-tap About OTL icon. The About OTL window  
appears.  
Figure 5-12. About OTL Window  
2. Tap OK to return to the Series 9000 Demo window.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
5-18 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Self Test  
Use Self Test to test the specified mobile computer functions. Table 5-3 lists the tests and the test  
descriptions.  
1. From the Series 9000 Demo window, double-tap Test Apps icon - double-tap - Self Test icon.  
The Self Test window appears.  
Figure 5-13. Self Test Window  
Table 5-3. Self Test Descriptions  
Test  
Display  
Description  
Tests the display function.  
Contrast  
Tests the display contrast function. Note, properly functioning color units will return the following  
error massage: Device not support contrast levels.  
Backlight  
Key Pad  
Tests the display backlight function.  
Tests the keypad function.  
Key Light  
Scan Button  
Tests the keypad backlight function.  
Pull the scan button or press the yellow scan button to test the scan button function. Tap and hold  
the Trig1 Stg1, Trig1 Stg2, Trig2 Stg1, Trig2 Stg1, Trig3 Stg1, or Trig3 Stg2 buttons to test the  
software programed scan button sequences.  
Scanner  
Tests the scan function.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Applications  
5-19  
Table 5-3. Self Test Descriptions (Continued)  
Test  
Speaker  
Description  
Tests the speaker and beeper function with sample beeps. Note, properly functioning that do not  
have the optional .wav file capability will return the following error message:  
PlaySound(\Windows\windmin.wav) failed, error=00000000 if the Wave File Play button is tapped.  
For these units use the Play Beeper button to test the beeper and speaker function.  
Microphone  
Touch Panel  
Batteries  
Tests the (optional) microphone function.  
Provides a test box, the test box is used to test the touch panel.  
Displays a battery status window. Note, do not use the Backup Battery status display.  
Displays a Com Ports test window.  
Com Ports  
Memory  
Displays a memory status window.  
Spectrum 24  
Displays a S24 Test window.  
2. From the Test Applications window (Figure 5-1 on page 5-3), double-tap the Self Test icon to  
enter the Self Test window.  
Select the One Time radio button to run each of the tests only once, or select  
the Continuously radio button to run the tests continuously, or until the  
prompt to stop running them is selected.  
Select the Write Log File checkbox to save the test results to a log file. The  
results are saved to the Selftest.log file located in the \Temp directory. To  
view the test results use ActiveSync to move the file to the host computer  
and then can view it using a text editor. Only one test log file is saved, the  
next write log file test save, appends the existing Selftest.log file.  
3. Tap Settings to display the Self Test Settings window. Tap Cancel to accept the default  
settings or enter new setting values and tap OK to accept the new settings and return to the  
Self Test window.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-20 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Select the Prompt for status after each test, checkbox to display a test  
confirmation window after the completion of each test. The test confirmation  
window prompts the user to confirm if the test was successfully completed.  
If the Write Log File check box is also selected, a test results log file is saved  
that includes the user response to confirmation window prompt. Do not  
select this checkbox if the confirmation window is not required.  
Self Test Settings  
Test Confirm Window  
Figure 5-14. Self Test Settings Windows  
4. Tap on a self test item from the Self Test list to select the item for testing, tap item again to  
de-select the item.  
5. Tap Start in the Self Test window to start the self test for the selected items.  
6. Follow the prompts provided for the test.  
7. Tap Exit to return to the Test Applications window (Figure 5-1 on page 5-3).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Applications  
5-21  
Notify  
Use Notify to test the mobile computer LED functions.  
1. From the Test Applications window, double-tap the Notify icon. The Notify window appears.  
Notify Window  
Edit Notify Parameters Window  
Figure 5-15. Notify Windows  
2. Tap an Object Name to select the item.  
3. Tap Edit to set the parameters. Drag the slide bars to adjust the values.  
4. Tap OK to return to the Notify window.  
5. Repeat edit procedure, if required, for remaining items. The following Notify window  
functions are available:  
• Tap Off to turn off the selected item.  
• Tap On to turn on the selected item.  
• Tap Cycle to cycle the selected item on and off.  
• Tap State to display the selected item’s state (on or off).  
• Tap About to view the software information.  
6. Tap Exit in the Notify window to return to the Test Applications window.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
5-22 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Keyboard  
Use the Keyboard application to test the mobile computer keypad functions.  
1. From the Test Applications window, double-tap Keyboard icon. The KeyCheck window  
appears.  
Figure 5-16. KeyCheck Window  
2. Press any key, the corresponding value displays on the KeyCheck window.  
3. Tap File - Exit to close the window.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Applications  
5-23  
Display  
Use the Display window to test the mobile computer display functions.  
1. From the Test Applications window double-tap Display to enter the Display window. The  
display test automatically runs through the display test windows.  
Figure 5-17. Display Test Window  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
5-24 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Memory  
Use the Memory application illustrates how an application should handle memory messages it  
receives from the Shell in the event of low memory conditions.  
1. From the Test Applications window double-tap the Memory icon. The Memory Test Window  
appears.  
2. The memory test automatically tests the mobile computer’s memory and displays the  
results.  
Figure 5-18. Memory Test Window  
3. Tap Alloc to increase the amount of allocated memory and correspondingly reduce the  
amount of free memory.  
4. Tap Free to increase the amount of free memory and correspondingly decrease the amount  
of allocated memory.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Applications  
5-25  
MSR9000  
The MSR9000 application is designed to work with the MSR. This sample application illustrates how  
an application should handle MSR inputs.  
The MSR must be attached to the mobile computer before the sample application is  
executed.  
1. From the Test Applications window, double-tap the MSR9000 icon. The MSR window  
appears.  
Figure 5-19. MSR Window  
2. Swipe a magnetic stripe card. The content on the card displays in the window.  
3. If the MSR is not properly attached to the mobile computer the MSR error window appears.  
Figure 5-20. MSR Error Window  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
5-26 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
MSR Cameo  
The MSR Cameo application is designed to work with the MSR Cameo magnetic stripe reader and  
printer. This sample application illustrates how an application should handle MSR inputs. See the  
MSR Cameo product documentation for use and setup instructions.  
The MSR must be attached to the mobile computer before the sample application is  
executed.  
1. From the Test Applications window, double-tap the MSR9000 icon. The MSR window  
appears.  
Figure 5-21. MSR Window  
2. Swipe a magnetic stripe card. The content on the card displays in the window.  
3. If the MSR is not properly attached to the mobile computer the MSR error window appears.  
Figure 5-22. MSR Error Window  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Applications  
5-27  
Printing  
The Printing application illustrates how an application should handle printer outputs.  
From the Test Applications window, double-tap the Printer icon. The Printer window appears.  
Figure 5-23. Printing Test Window  
1. From the Select a Printer drop-down list, select a printer.  
2. In the Text text box, enter text to print.  
3. Tap Print.  
4. The printer prints the contents of the Text text box and Barcode text box.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
5-28 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Spectrum24 Network Configuration  
Chapter Contents  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Spectrum24 Network Configuration  
6-3  
Introduction  
Wireless LANs allow the mobile computers to communicate wirelessly and to send captured data  
“real time” to a host device. Before a mobile computer can be used on a Spectrum24 LAN the facility  
must be set up with the equipment required to run the wireless LAN and the mobile computer must  
be properly configured. Refer to the documentation that came with the Access Points (APs) for  
instructions on setting up the required hardware.  
The MC9000-K and MC9000-S Network Adapter settings and Spectrum24 settings configure and  
monitor the wireless connection. The Mobile Companion icon appears in the task tray and indicates  
mobile computer signal strength as follows:  
Icon  
Status  
Excellent signal strength  
Very good signal strength  
Good signal strength  
Fair signal strength  
Poor signal strength  
Out-of-network range (not associated)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
6-4 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Mobile Companion  
The Mobile Companion utility is used to configure the mobile computer’s wireless network settings.  
The Mobile Companion utility starts automatically and appears as an icon on the task tray. The status  
icon changes in real-time to reflect the signal strength and availability of the adapter and the wireless  
network. Double-tap the S24 DS Settings icon or tap the task tray Mobile Companion icon to open  
the Mobile Companion menu..  
Mobile Companion  
Menu  
Mobile Companion  
icons  
Figure 6-1. Mobile Companion Menu  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Spectrum24 Network Configuration  
6-5  
When the menu opens, the user can select Status, WLAN Profiles, Find WLANs, or Options menu  
options.  
Table 6-1. Mobile Companion Menu Descriptions  
Menu Item  
Status  
Description  
Displays the current status and information for the wireless connection.  
Signal tab - Displays radio signal transmission strength from the adapter (using its current profile)  
to the associated AP.  
Info tab - Displays Mobile Companion software, driver, firmware and hardware and country  
information for the current WLAN profile.  
IP Status tab - Displays network address information.  
Ping tab - Displays signal strength data, data rate and conducts data transmission tests between  
the mobile computer and associated AP or client.  
APs tab - Displays APs with the same ESSID as the current mobile computer profile. The mobile  
computer's roaming capabilities can be set from this tab.  
Peers tab - Displays the BSSIDs, power modes, transmit rates and data rates of other networked  
clients within the Ad Hoc (peer-to-peer) network. When in Ad Hoc operating mode, the Peers tab  
appears instead of the APs tab.  
WLAN Profiles  
Find WLANs  
Displays the current profiles and allows the user to add, edit and delete profiles, for more  
information see Changing Profiles on page 6-26.  
Displays a list of those Spectrum24 networks (APs and networked peers) available for association.  
The networks are listed by their ESSID. To the right of each network is a signal strength icon.  
Networks with a signal strength of good (three green bars out of five) or better should be considered  
for connection. Tap a network and tap Connect to interoperate with the AP representing that  
network. Once connected, the Mode, Encryption, IP Config and power tabs display the ESSID,  
security settings, network address information and power consumption level set for that network.  
For more information, see Finding WLANs on page 6-6.  
Options  
Displays settings for system sounds, AP and mobile computer association capabilities, profile  
roaming options, as well as the password protecting the Mobile Companion utility. For more  
information, see Setting Options on page 6-24.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                     
6-6 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Finding WLANs  
A completed profile is a set of mobile computer configuration settings that can be used in different  
locations to connect to a Spectrum24 network. Creating different profiles is a good way of having pre-  
defined operating parameters available for use in various Spectrum24 network environments.  
Select Find WLANs from the Mobile Companion menu to locate the APs in the area. The Mobile  
Companion window displays the available WLAN networks.  
Figure 6-2. Available WLAN Networks  
1. Select an available WLAN network from the list.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Spectrum24 Network Configuration  
6-7  
2. Tap Connect. The Mode tab appears.  
Infrastructure Mode  
Ad Hoc Mode  
Figure 6-3. Mode Tab  
Table 6-2. Mode Tab Fields  
Field  
Profile Name  
Description  
Populated with the name and (WLAN) identifier of the network connection. The Profile  
Name: can bechanged.  
Use the Profile Name field to enter the name of the mobile computer profile used to  
transmit with either an AP or another networked computer.  
802.11 ESSID  
Populated with the name and (WLAN) identifier of the network connection.  
The ESSID is the 802.11 Extended Service Set Identifier. The ESSID is 32-character  
(maximum) string identifying the WLAN. The ESSID assigned to the mobile computer is  
required to match the AP ESSID for the mobile computer to communicate with the AP.  
Operating Mode  
Select the operating mode from the Operating Mode: drop-down list.  
Infrastructure: Select Infrastructure to enable the mobile computer to transmit and  
receive data with an AP. Infrastructure is the mobile computer default mode when  
Mobile Companion initially appears.  
Ad Hoc: Select Ad Hoc to enable the mobile computer to form its own local network  
where mobile computers communicate peer-to-peer without APs using a shared ESSID.  
Select the Long preamble check box if the mobile computer and its profile are using a  
long preamble when transmitting data. A long preamble is approximately 8 bytes of the  
packet header attached to the packet prior to transmission. Devices in Ad Hoc mode are  
required to use the same preamble length to interoperate. The mobile computer  
initiating the Ad Hoc network sets the channel (using the Channel drop-down list) used  
by each peer in the Ad Hoc network.  
Country  
Select the country of operation for the mobile computer from the Country: drop-down list.  
This ensures the mobile computer is using country code information compatible with the  
country code data used by the associated AP.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
6-8 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
3. Select the Authentication tab to configure server-based authentication. Select one of the  
following Authentication options from the Authentication drop-down list.  
• None - Default setting when authentication is not required on the network. The client  
adapter does not use any authentication scheme when Open System is selected on the  
Encryption tab.  
• Kerberos (see Table 6-3)  
• LEAP (see Table 6-4)  
• EAP-TLS (see Table 6-5)  
• PEAP (see Table 6-6).  
.
Kerberos Authentication  
Credential Caching Settings  
(Kerberos Options)  
Figure 6-4. Mobile Companion - Authentication Tab (Kerberos)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Spectrum24 Network Configuration  
6-9  
Table 6-3. Authentication Tab Fields - Kerberos  
Authentication  
Kerberos  
Description  
Kerberos is a different form of 128-bit data security. An adapter is required to have its  
request for access point resources authenticated with a Kerberos server before the server  
permits the access point to transmit and receive data with the associated adapter. When  
Kerberos is selected, the KDC and Realm entry fields appear. The KDC field should remain  
with the default KDC name (krbtgt) unless it is changed in the server. Enter the name of the  
server that hosts the Kerberos KDC in the Realm field. The KDC is located on a server and  
maintains information about the access points and users it supports. The KDC also permits  
the transmission and receipt of data once the credentials of the user are verified.  
(see Figure 6-4)  
Tap Kerberos Options to configure different caching modes for Kerberos credentials.  
When connecting to a Kerberos supported profile, the system can prompt for the  
associated user name and password at specified instances during the authentication  
process. Caching of credentials is optional.  
Kerberos Options:  
Select any combination of the following Kerberos Credential Caching settings:  
Reset: When selected, the system prompts the user for the username and password  
upon a warm boot.  
Connect: When selected, the system prompts the user for login information when the  
system initiates a connection to the ESSID.  
Time: When selected, the system requests a user name and password after the specified  
time parameter. Available time parameters are specified as an Interval (in minutes) or At  
(hh:mm) a specified time (chosen with the pull-down menu). If a time option is not  
selected, authentication continues without a user name and password verification.  
Resume: When enabled, the system prompts the user for username and password after the  
system is suspended and subsequently resumed. If disabled, the system prompts for a  
username and password only if the user's credentials are not in the registry.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
6-10 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Figure 6-5. Mobile Companion - Authentication Tab (LEAP)  
Table 6-4. Authentication Tab Fields - LEAP  
Authentication  
LEAP  
Description  
Select this option to enable LEAP authentication. LEAP is founded on mutual  
authentication. The AP and the mobile computer attempting to connect to it require  
authentication before access to the network is permitted.  
(see Figure 6-5)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Spectrum24 Network Configuration  
6-11  
Install / View Certificates  
EAP-TLS Authentication  
Figure 6-6. Mobile Companion - Authentication Tab (EAP-TLS)  
Table 6-5. Authentication Tab Fields - EAP/TLS and PEAP  
Authentication  
Description  
EAP/TLS  
(see Figure 6-6)  
EAP/TLS is an authentication scheme through IEEE 802.1x. It authenticates users and  
ensures only valid users can connect to the network. It also restricts unauthorized users  
from accessing transmitted information. EAP/TLS achieves this through secure  
authentication certificates.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
6-12 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
PEAP Authentication  
Install / View Certificates  
Figure 6-7. Mobile Companion - Authentication Tab (PEAP)  
Table 6-6. Authentication Tab Fields - EAP/TLS and PEAP  
Authentication  
Description  
PEAP  
(see Figure 6-7)  
Select this option to enable PEAP authentication. This method uses a digital certificate to  
verify and authenticate a user's identity.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Spectrum24 Network Configuration  
6-13  
1. Select the Encryption tab to set the adapter profile security level by configuring the  
encryption scheme and corresponding keys. Select an option (Open System, WEP, Keyguard-  
MCM, TKIP (WPA)) from the Encryption drop-down list. See Table 6-7 on page 6-14 for  
Encryption option descriptions.  
Figure 6-8. Encryption Tab  
The absence of a physical connection makes wireless links vulnerable to information theft.  
Encryption is an efficient method of preventing data theft and improving data security.  
If an AP is set to 40-bit and an adapter is set to 128-bit, the adapter can associate to the AP,  
but no data transmission and reception can take place.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
6-14 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Table 6-7. Encryption Options  
Encryption  
Open System  
Description  
Use the Open System option as the default setting when no data packet encryption is  
needed over the network. Selecting this option provides no security for the data being  
transmitted over the network. The window displays only the OK and Cancel buttons.  
WEP  
Select WEP for the adapter to use the WEP keys for encryption. The window displays  
several radio buttons and edit buttons to configure the WEP keys. Select 40-bit or 128-bit  
key lengths (128-bit is the default). WEP keys are manually entered in the edit boxes. Only  
the required number of edit boxes for a key length is displayed (10 Hex digit value for 40-  
bit keys, 26 Hex digit values for 128-bit keys). Use the Key radio buttons to configure the  
four WEP keys. The adapter uses the selected key. Tap ResetKeys to set the encryption  
key to the default values.  
Note: The default Hex digit keys are visible any time they are used. As a security precaution  
after setting the key values for the network, the digits are replaced with asterisks * within  
the Encryption key fields.  
If the associated access point is using an optional Passkey, the "active" adapter WLAN  
profile is required to use one as well. The Passkey is a plain text representation of the WEP  
keys displayed in the Encryption property window. The Passkey provides an easy way to  
enter WEP key data without having to remember the entire 40-bit (10 character) or 128-bit  
(26 character) Hex digit string.  
Tap Passkey to display the Passkey screen. Enter an easy-to-remember 4 to 32 character  
string to be used as the WEP algorithm. Click OK. The access point transforms the Passkey  
string into a set of four WEP keys using MD5 algorithms and displays them in the WEP  
fields. These are the new WEP keys for the adapter profile. Once displayed in the WEP key  
fields, the adapter profile behaves as if the keys were entered manually.  
TKIP (WPA)  
Select this option for the client adapter to use Wireless Protected Access (WPA) via TKIP.  
Manually enter the pre-shared keys in the edit boxes. Tap ClearKey to clear all previous  
keys and enter new key values. Tap Passkey to display the Passkey screen. Enter an easy-  
to-remember 8 to 63 character string.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Spectrum24 Network Configuration  
6-15  
2. Select the IP Config tab to configure the following mobile computer profile network address  
parameters: IP address, subnet, gateway, DNS and WINS. Changes made within the IP  
Config tab only impact the profile selected in the Mode tab and do not impact the network  
address parameters configured for other profiles.  
Figure 6-9. Mobile Companion - IP Config Tab (DHCP)  
• Select Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol (DHCP) from the IP Type drop down list to  
obtain a leased IP address and network configuration information from a DHCP server.  
DHCP is the default setting for the mobile computer profile. When DHCP is selected, the  
IP address fields are read-only.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
6-16 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
• Select Static to manually assign the IP, subnet mask, default gateway, DNS and WINS  
addresses used by the mobile computer profile.  
Figure 6-10. Mobile Companion - IP Config Tab (Static)  
Table 6-8. IP Config Tab Fields  
Field  
IP Address  
Description  
The Internet is a collection of networks with users that communicate with each other. Each  
communication carries the address of the source and destination networks and the  
particular machine within the network associated with the user or host computer at each  
end. This address is called the IP address (Internet Protocol address). Each node on the IP  
network must be assigned a unique IP address that is made up of a network identifier and  
a host identifier. Enter the IP address as a dotted-decimal notation with the decimal value  
of each octet separated by a period, for example, 192.168.7.27.  
Subnet Mask  
Most TCP/IP networks use subnets in order to effectively manage routed IP addresses.  
Having an organization's network divided into subnets allows it to be connected to the  
Internet with a single shared network address, for example, 255.255.255.0.  
Gateway  
DNS  
The default gateway is a device that is used to forward IP packets to and from a remote  
destination.  
The Domain Name System (DNS) is a distributed Internet directory service. DNS is used  
mostly to translate domain names and IP addresses. It is also used to control Internet email  
delivery. Most Internet service requires DNS to operate properly. If DNS is not configured,  
Web sites cannot be located and/or email delivery fails.  
®
WINS  
WINS is a Microsoft Net BIOS name server. WINS eliminates the broadcasts needed to  
resolve computer names to IP addresses by providing a cache or database of translations.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                 
Spectrum24 Network Configuration  
6-17  
3. Select the Power tab to set the Radio Transmission Power level and the Power Saving  
Modes for the mobile computer profile.  
Infrastructure Mode  
Ad Hoc Mode  
Figure 6-11. Mobile Companion - Power Tab)  
Adjust the Radio Transmission Power level to expand or confine the transmission area to with  
respect to other wireless devices that could be operating nearby. Reducing coverage in a high  
traffic area improves transmission quality by reducing the amount of noise in that coverage area.  
Table 6-9. Power Tab Fields  
Field  
Description  
Radio Transmission Power  
In Infrastructure mode  
There are two transmission power options:  
Select Automatic to use the AP power level. Automatic is the default mode for mobile  
computers operating in Infrastructure mode.  
Select Power Plus to set the mobile computer transmission power one level higher than the  
level set for the AP.  
In Ad Hoc mode  
There are five transmission power options:  
Select Maximum power to set the mobile computer to the highest transmission power  
level. Select Maximum power when operating in highly reflective environments and areas  
where other devices could be operating nearby. Additionally, use the maximum power level  
when attempting to communicate with devices at the outer edge of a coverage area.  
Select 50%, 25% or 10% to set the transmit power level to that percentage of the  
maximum power level.  
Select Minimum power to set the mobile computer to the lowest transmission power level.  
Use the minimum power level when communicating with other devices in very close  
proximity. Additionally, select minimum power in instances where little or no radio  
interference from other devices is anticipated.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
6-18 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Table 6-9. Power Tab Fields (Continued)  
Field  
Description  
Automatic Power Saving  
Mode  
Switches to Best Network Performance when an AC power supply is detected. If a battery  
is used, an appropriate setting between Best Network Performance and Acceptable  
Network Performance is automatically chosen based on a real-time analysis of network  
usage. The Automatic Power Saving Mode is the default setting and extends the operating  
time before the battery is recharged.  
Manual Power Saving Mode Use to select a performance level suited to intended operation. There are six settings  
ranging from the Best Network Performance (using the most battery power) to Acceptable  
Network Performance (using the least battery power). A network performance description  
is displayed for each power range.  
4. Tap OK to implement power consumption changes for the mobile computer profile.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Spectrum24 Network Configuration  
6-19  
Status  
To view the status of the wireless network connection, select Status from the Mobile Companion  
menu.  
1. Select the Signal tab to display a real-time graph of the signal quality of the mobile  
computer to the associated AP (Infrastructure Mode only). The number of times the mobile  
computer has roamed to and from APs, the current data rate and the network status are  
displayed. Signal quality is an indicator of how clearly the adapter can hear the associated  
AP.  
Figure 6-12. Mobile Companion - Signal Tab  
The Signal tab is view only and is not available if the current operating mode is Ad  
Hoc.  
Table 6-10. Signal Fields  
Field  
Description  
Missed Beacons  
Displays the amount of beacons (uniform system packets broadcast by the AP to  
keep the network synchronized) missed by the mobile computer. The fewer the  
missed beacons the better the signal. As long as the LED to the right of the graph is  
green the AP association is not jeopardized by an excess of missed AP beacons. If  
the LED is Red, an association with a different AP could be warranted to reduce the  
amount of missed beacons and improve the signal.  
Txmit Retries (Transmit  
Retries)  
Displays the number of data packets retransmitted by the mobile computer. The  
fewer transmit retries the stronger the signal. As long as the LED to the right of the  
graph is green the AP association is not jeopardized. If the LED is red, an association  
with a different AP could be warranted to reduce the amount of transmit retries and  
improve the signal.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
6-20 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Table 6-10. Signal Fields (Continued)  
Field  
Description  
Signal  
Displays the Relative Signal Strength Indicator (RSSI) of the signal transmitted  
between the AP and mobile computer. As long as the LED to the right of the graph  
is green the AP association is not jeopardized. If the LED is red, an association with  
a different AP could be warranted to improve the signal.  
2. Select the Info tab to view the mobile computer’s current software and driver revision data  
as well as the operating parameters of the current profile.  
Figure 6-13. Mobile Companion - Info Tab  
The Version and Current Status information on this window may differ from the  
actual screen on the mobile computer.  
Table 6-11. Info Fields  
Field  
Description  
Version Information  
Displays Mobile Companion software, driver, firmware and hardware versions as  
well as country information. This data is consistent for the mobile computer  
regardless of which mobile computer profile is the current profile.  
Current Status  
Displays the mobile computers current Profile Name, ESSID and Encryption mode.  
Mobile computer performance is displayed using a verbal indicator of signal  
strength. Mobile computer operating information differs depending on which profile  
was enabled as the current profile.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Spectrum24 Network Configuration  
6-21  
3. Select the IP Status tab to view the mobile computers network address information. Unlike  
the IP Config tab in Finding WLANs, the IP Status tab is view only with no user-configurable  
data fields.  
Figure 6-14. Mobile Companion - IP Status Tab  
Table 6-12. IP Status Fields  
Field  
Description  
IP Type  
If DHCP was selected from the IP Config tab, leased IP address and network address  
data displays for the mobile computer. If Static was selected, the values displayed  
were input manually in the IP Config tab on page 15.  
IP Address  
The Internet is a collection of networks with users that communicate with each  
other. Each communication carries the address of the source and destination  
networks and the particular machine within the network associated with the user  
or host computer at each end. This address is called the IP address. Each node on  
the IP network must be assigned a unique IP address that is made up of a network  
identifier and a host identifier. Enter the IP address as a dotted-decimal notation  
with the decimal value of each octet separated by a period, for example,  
192.168.7.27.  
Subnet Mask  
Most TCP/IP networks use subnets in order to effectively manage routed IP  
addresses. Having an organization's network divided into subnets allows it to be  
connected to the Internet with a single shared network address, for example,  
255.255.255.0.  
Gateway  
DNS  
The gateway is a device that is used to forward IP packets to and from a remote  
destination.  
The Domain Name System (DNS) is a distributed Internet directory service. DNS is  
used mostly to translate domain names and IP addresses. It is also used to control  
Internet e-mail delivery. Most Internet service requires DNS to operate properly. If  
DNS is not configured, Web sites cannot be located or e-mail delivery fails.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
6-22 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Table 6-12. IP Status Fields (Continued)  
Field  
Description  
WINS  
WINS is a Microsoft Net BIOS name server. WINS eliminates the broadcasts  
needed to resolve computer names to IP addresses by providing a cache or database  
of translations.  
MAC Address  
Host Name  
An IEEE 48-bit address the mobile computer is assigned at the factory that uniquely  
identifies the adapter at the physical layer.  
Displays the name of the mobile computer.  
4. Tap Renew to refresh the information displayed on the IP Status tab. The mobile device is  
releases the existing IP address and requests a new IP address from a DHCP server.  
5. Select the Ping tab to send and receive ICMP ping packets across the network to the  
specified IP address.  
Figure 6-15. Mobile Companion - Ping Tab  
6. In the IP drop-down list, select a target device IP address.  
7. In the Size drop-down list, select the size of the packet transmission.  
8. Tap Start Test to begin the ping test.  
9. Tap Stop Test to terminate the ping test.  
The average mega-bits per second, signal strength, data rate currently in use, test statistics  
and round trip (RT) times are displayed for each test. The associated AP MAC address is also  
displayed. The signal strength level and the data transmission rate are displayed in real-time  
bar graphs.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Spectrum24 Network Configuration  
6-23  
10. Select the APs tab to view APs with the same ESSID as the mobile computer’s profile.  
Figure 6-16. Mobile Companion - APs Tab  
The associated AP displays a radio wave radiating from its antenna to indicate its  
associated status. Tapping the icon displays a menu with Set Mandatory and Set Roaming  
options.  
Selecting the Set Mandatory item prohibits the mobile computer from associating with a  
different AP. The letter M appears on top of the icon when the Set Mandatory option has  
been selected.  
Selecting Set Roaming allows the mobile computer to roam to any AP with a better signal.  
These settings are temporary and never saved to the registry.  
Tap Refresh to update the list of the APs with the same ESSID. A signal strength value of  
32 is the highest possible. The APs tab only appears when Infrastructure is selected as the  
mobile computer operating mode from the Mode tab.  
11. If the mobile computer is in Ad Hoc mode, select the Peers tab to display the BSSID or MAC  
addresses of the other mobile computers in the network, their operating mode (PSP or CAM),  
their transmit rate, their supported data rate and the length of time an adapter has been out  
of the Ad Hoc network. Tap Refresh to update the Peers tab to the latest Ad Hoc network  
performance and mobile computer membership data.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
6-24 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Figure 6-17. Mobile Companion - Peers Tab  
Setting Options  
Select Options from the Mobile Companion menu to:  
Access APs or Ad-Hoc networks for the Find WLAN search  
Enable or disable profile roaming  
Enable system sounds  
Enable Rogue AP Detection to check the system for unauthorized APs  
Place password protection on the current WLAN profile.  
Figure 6-18. Mobile Companion - Option Settings  
1. Select the Access AP networks checkbox to display available AP networks and their signal  
strength within the Available WLAN Networks tab. These are the APs available to the  
mobile computer profile for association. If this option was previously disabled, refresh the  
Available WLAN Networks tab to display the AP networks available to the mobile computer.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Spectrum24 Network Configuration  
6-25  
2. Select the Access Ad-Hoc networks checkbox to display available peer (adapter) networks  
and their signal strength within the Available WLAN Networks tab. These are peers  
available to the mobile computer profile for association. If this option was previously  
disabled, refresh the Available WLAN Networks tab to display the Ad Hoc networks  
available to the mobile computer.  
3. Select the Disable Profile Roaming check box to to configure the adapter profile to not roam  
to another AP profile or peer profile (if in Ad Hoc mode) if a stronger signal is detected.  
4. Select the Enable Sounds checkbox to initiate an audible signal when performing a ping test  
and associating with an AP. The tones are important to notify users if the pinging is received  
or if the mobile computer has roamed to another AP.  
5. Select the Enable Rogue AP Detection check box to inform the system of unauthorized APs  
on the network.  
Mobile Companion has a password protection feature. When Mobile  
Companion initially appears, the password is off by default.  
6. To create a password, tap Change Password.  
Figure 6-19. Mobile Companion - Change Password  
7. In the Change Password window, tap in the Current Password box and enter the current  
password. The password is case sensitive and a maximum of 10 characters. Enter the new  
password in both the New Password and the Confirm New Password boxes and tap OK.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6-26 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Changing Profiles  
Select WLAN Profiles from the Mobile Companion menu to view, connect to, create and edit a profile.  
A completed profile is a set of adapter configuration settings that can be used in different locations  
to connect to a wireless network. Creating different profiles is a good way of having pre-defined  
operating parameters available for use in various network environments. When the WLAN Profiles  
initially appears, existing profiles appear in the WLAN Profiles list.  
Figure 6-20. Mobile Companion - WLAN Profiles  
Select a profile from the list and tap Connect to set that profile as the active profile. The active  
profile displays the transmit and receive icon to the left. Once selected, the mobile computer is using  
the ESSID, encryption and power consumption settings initially configured for that profile.  
Editing a Profile  
Select a profile from the list and tap Edit to display the Mode tab where the ESSID and operating  
mode can be changed for the profile. Use the Encryption, IP Config and Power tabs as necessary to  
edit the profile power consumption and security parameters.  
Creating a New Profile  
Tap New to display the Mode tab, used to set the profile name and ESSID. Use the Encryption, IP  
Config and Power tabs as required to set security, network address information and power  
consumption level for the new profile.  
Deleting a Profile  
Select a profile to delete from the list and tap Delete to remove the selected profile.  
Ordering Profiles  
Select a profile from the list and tap Move Up or Move Down to order the profile. If the current  
profile association is lost, Mobile Companion attempts to associate with the first profile in the list  
and then the next until a new association is achieved.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                 
Spectrum24 Network Configuration  
6-27  
Using LEAP for Wireless Network Security  
LEAP is a security protocol that provides authentication and encryption for wireless networks.  
Authentication is provided through the use of user names and passwords. There are multiple options  
for caching of these credentials available to the administrator of the device through the registry.  
There are multiple password caching options used for LEAP. The methods are:  
Save the password in the registry.  
Save the password until a warm boot (soft reset), but not saved in the registry. This method  
also has a timeout available.  
Never save the password, requiring a dialog box on every power-up (suspend/resume).  
The default is set to cache the password until a warm boot, with no timeout. If a different password  
caching option is desired, the Spectrum24DS.reg registry file in the Platform folder must be re-  
configured.  
Configuring Advanced Password Options  
All password caching options are configured in the file Spectrum24DS.reg, located in the Platform  
folder. The file must be edited on a PC and copied back onto the device after editing is complete. The  
section of this file which needs editing reads “[HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\Comm\NETWLAN1\Parms].”  
Cache the Password  
To cache the password, edit the registry file using a text editor with the following changes:  
1. Change the LCachePwd value from 1 to 0:  
LCachePwd = dword:0  
2. Uncomment the UNAME and UPwd values (deleting the semicolons at the beginning of each  
line):  
UNAME = yLEAPUserName  
UPwd = myLEAPPassword  
3. Change myLEAPUserName and myLEAPPassword to the correct username and password.  
Note that the user name and password should be in quotes. If a domain name is required,  
this can be entered in the user name as: domain\username.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
6-28 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
A backslash is used and most setups do not require a domain name even if  
Microsoft Windows® NT/2000 domains are used.  
4. After changing the Spectrum24DS.reg file, copy the file onto the mobile computer into the  
Platform using ActiveSync and overwriting the old file. Then, cold boot the mobile computer  
for the changes to take effect.  
Cache the Password until a Warm Boot  
Cache the password until a warm boot is the default setting. A timeout value can also be set in the  
registry. The timeout forces the user to enter the username and password after a power-on if the  
device had not gone through the LEAP authentication processes after the set period of time. Normally,  
the device goes through the LEAP authentication process at every power-up and every time it roams  
between APs.  
The timeout setting can be set in minutes using hexadecimal in the registry file. The default setting  
of zero disables the timeout feature. To change the timeout setting, edit the registry file using a text  
editor (e.g., Notepad) as follows:  
1. Ensure the “LCachePwd” value is set to dword:1.  
LCachePwd = dword:1  
2. If a timeout is desired, change the LTimeoutMinutes value from 00000000 to a desired value.  
Examples are provided in the registry file. The following example is for 240 minutes which  
is represented as 000000F0 in hexadecimal.  
LTimeoutMinutes = dword:000000F0  
3. Ensure that the UNAME and UPwd lines are commented out by putting a semicolon at the  
beginning of each line.  
4. After these changes are made to the Spectrum24DS.reg file, the file must be copied onto  
the terminal. Copy the file into the Platform folder of the device using ActiveSync,  
overwriting the old file. Once this is done, cold boot the mobile computer for the changes to  
take effect.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Spectrum24 Network Configuration  
6-29  
Prevent Password Cache  
To prevent password caching, edit the registry file using a text editor with the following  
changes:  
1. Change the LCachePwd value from 1 to 2:  
LCachePwd=dword:2  
2. Ensure that the UNAME and UPwd lines are commented out by putting a semicolon at the  
beginning of each line.  
3. After the changes are made use ActiveSync to copy the Spectrum24DS.reg file (overwriting  
the old file) onto the mobile computer’s Platform folder. Then cold boot the mobile computer  
for the changes to take effect.  
LEAP Usage  
After LEAP setup is complete, the only noticeable difference is the password dialog box. If  
the caching method selected requires a user name and password, then they appear when  
required. If the user name is an NT domain user, the domain can be entered in the domain  
field if necessary (not normally required).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6-30 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Spectrum24 Frequency Hopping (FH) Settings (1 and 2 MB  
Radios)  
Double-tap the S24 FH Settings icon on the Series 9000 Demo window to open the Symbol  
Spectrum24 WLAN menu.  
Figure 6-21. Spectrum24 FH Settings Menus  
Table 6-13. S24 FH Tab Descriptions  
Tab  
Mobile Unit  
Description  
The Mobile Unit tab configures the mobile computer ESSID, power management, RTS threshold,  
International Roaming capability and AP options, see Mobile Unit Tab on page 6-31.  
MicroAP  
The MicroAP tab sets the mobile computer to operate as an AP and establishes a single-cell  
wireless network, see MicroAP Tab on page 6-33.  
Encryption  
WLAN Adapter  
The Encryption tab sets the WLAN adapter to make the wireless link less vulnerable to  
information theft, see Encryption Tab on page 6-34.  
The WLAN Adapter tab sets the hardware and radio settings. The password protection feature  
is turned on and off from the WLAN Adapter tab, seeWLAN Adapter Tab on page 6-36.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Spectrum24 Network Configuration  
6-31  
Mobile Unit Tab  
Use the Mobile Unit tab to configure the mobile computer ESSID, power management, RTS threshold,  
International Roaming capability and AP options.  
Figure 6-22. Mobile Unit Tab  
Table 6-14. Mobile Unit Tab Fields  
Field  
Description  
ESSID  
Use the ESSID field to set the 802.11 Extended Service Set Identifier. The ESSID is a 32-  
character string (maximum) address identifying the wireless LAN. The ESSID assigned to  
the mobile computer is required to match the AP ESSID for the two devices to associate.  
RTS Threshold  
Use the RTS Threshold drop-down list to select the data transmission size at which the  
mobile computer alerts the AP with a Request To Send (RTS) signal prior to transmission.  
Once the mobile computer receives a Clear To Send (CTS) signal from the AP, the mobile  
computer transmits the data packet. Establishing an RTS threshold in advance of sending  
large volumes of data helps ensure data transmission with little interference.  
International Roaming Check the International Roaming check box to enable the mobile computer to associate  
with APs with different country codes.  
Preferred BSS  
Use the Preferred BSS field to enter the IEEE MAC address of the AP where the mobile  
computer prefers to associate. The mobile computer assigns a higher priority to this AP  
when transmitting over the network.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
6-32 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Table 6-14. Mobile Unit Tab Fields (Continued)  
Field  
Description  
Mandatory BSS  
Use the Mandatory BSS field to enter the IEEE MAC address of the AP where the mobile  
computer is required to associate. The mobile computer associates to only this AP when  
communicating on the network. Enter an AP MAC address to associate to an AP that has a  
compatible ESSID.  
Power Mode  
A Spectrum24 radio has two main power consumption modes, Continuous Aware Mode  
(CAM) and Power Save Poll (PSP) mode. Use the Power Mode drop-down list to specify the  
power mode to be used by the radio. CAM provides the best performance but uses the most  
power. CAM is the preferred mode for devices running on AC power. PSP saves significant  
amounts of power over CAM and is the preferred mode for devices running on battery  
power.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Spectrum24 Network Configuration  
6-33  
MicroAP Tab  
Use the MicroAP tab to configure the mobile computer to operate as an AP. The MicroAP establishes  
a single-cell wireless network for devices in mobile unit mode.  
Each MicroAP requires a unique ESSID. MicroAP cells can coexist as separate individual networks  
within the same site without interference. The MicroAP does not roam, but it does support roaming.  
The mobile computer in MicroAP mode operates in CAM, and supports devices operating in both PSP  
and CAM. The MicroAP supports up to 16 mobile computers.  
Figure 6-23. MicroAP Tab  
Figure 6-24.  
Table 6-15. MicroAP Tab Fields  
Field  
Description  
Enable MicroAP  
Tap the Enable MicroAP checkbox to support MicroAP operations.  
Tap the 1 or 2 Megabit Base Rate check boxes to specify the data rate within the MicroAP  
cell. A MicroAP and the mobile computer are required to use the same data rate.  
Frequency Hop Settings Tap the Frequency Hop Settings drop-down list to establish the Hop Set, Hop Sequence and  
DTIM Delay to be used within the MicroAP cell.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
6-34 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Encryption Tab  
Use the Encryption tab for configuring encryption settings. The absence of a physical connection  
makes wireless links vulnerable to information theft. Encryption is an efficient method of preventing  
data theft and improving data security. The firmware supports Open System and Shared Key (40-bit)  
Encryption algorithms.  
MicroAP Authentication Options A MicroAP can use Open System, Shared Key or both. If Shared Key  
is enabled and Open System is not, the MicroAP grants access to adapters that have Shared Key  
enabled and are using the correct Encryption Key algorithm.  
Adapters using Open System cannot associate to the MicroAP when the MicroAP has Shared Key  
enabled. Only when the MicroAP is using Open System can Open System mobile computers associate  
to it.  
Figure 6-25. Encryption Tab  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Spectrum24 Network Configuration  
6-35  
Table 6-16. Encryption Tab Fields  
Field  
Description  
MicroAP Authentication A MicroAP can use Open System Algorithm, Shared Key Algorithm or both. If Shared Key  
Options  
is enabled and Open System is not, the MicroAP grants access to adapters that have  
Shared Key enabled and are using the correct Encryption Key algorithm.  
Adapters using Open System cannot associate to the MicroAP when the MicroAP has  
Shared Key enabled. Only when the MicroAP is using Open System can Open System  
mobile computers associate to it.  
Encryption Algorithm  
Use the Encryption Algorithm drop-down list to select the adapter Encryption algorithm.  
The Open System algorithm (default setting) does not encrypt packets over the network.  
Select Open System to disable Encryption for the WLAN adapter and allow for the  
transmission and receipt of data with no security.  
Shared Encryption Key Use the Shared Encryption Key option to enable 40-bit Encryption. Select the Encryption  
Index key radio button (to be used for the mobile computer) and enter 10 hex digits for each  
key used. Tap ok to save and implement the encryption key data.  
Select an Encryption Index key radio button and tap Reset Keys to clear the entries in the  
Shared Encryption Key fields.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
6-36 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
WLAN Adapter Tab  
Use the WLAN Adapter tab to configure hardware and radio settings. Use the Card Type: PCMCIA to  
specify the antenna type and the Radio Link Rate radio buttons to specify the data rate supported.  
Figure 6-26. WLAN Adapter Tab  
Table 6-17. WLAN Adapter Tab Fields  
Field  
Description  
Diversity Antenna  
Select Diversity Antenna if dual antenna support is required. Diversity improves  
communication in highly reflective environments. Do not select diversity if a secondary  
antenna is not being used. Using diversity in a single antenna application can cause poor  
wireless network performance.  
Radio Link Rate  
Password  
Use the Radio Link Rate radio buttons to specify the data rate supported. The mobile  
computer can use 1MB, 2MB or both. If Both 1MB and 2MB Support is selected, the mobile  
computer defaults to a 1 Mbps data rate if a 2 Mbps data rate cannot be established.  
Spectrum24 FH settings has a password protection feature that can be turned on and off  
from the WLAN Adapter tab. When the Spectrum24 FH program is initially launched, the  
password is off (default).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Spectrum24 Network Configuration  
6-37  
Password Protecting NCPA  
NCPA has a password protection feature that can be turned on and off from the WLAN Adapter tab.  
When the NCPA program is initially launched, the password is off (default). To create a password for  
the NCPA advanced pages:  
1. Tap Password... from the WLAN Adapter tab. The Change Password dialog box appears.  
Figure 6-27. Change Password  
2. Enter the case-sensitive password (10 characters maximum) in the Current Password field  
and tap OK.  
3. The NCPA advanced pages dialog box is enabled and now appears when the Advanced  
button is tapped from Easy Setup window.  
4. To disable the password dialog box, enter the current password and leave the New  
Password and Confirm New Password fields blank. Tap OK.  
5. To change the password, enter the current password and enter a new password in the New  
Password and Confirm New Password fields.  
6. Tap OK.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
6-38 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Configuring the S24 DS (11 Mb) Radio Using a Registry File  
Default settings for the Spectrum24 radio card can be set on the mobile computer using registry (.reg)  
files. There are two registry files: Spectrum24DS.reg contains the global registry settings for Mobile  
Companion and S24Profiles.reg contains the profile specific and operating registry settings for  
Mobile Companion.  
A sample S24Profiles.reg file is provided as part of the DCP for MC9000w. Edit the file using a text  
editor. See notes in the sample file for the key information that can be modified.  
Save this text file as S24Profiles.reg. Use ActiveSync to copy this file to the Platform folder on the  
mobile computer. Once this file is loaded onto the mobile computer, these settings are restored after  
a cold boot.  
Configuring the S24 FH (2 Mb) Radio Using a Registry File  
Default settings for the Spectrum24 radio card can be set on the mobile computer using registry (.reg)  
files. There is one registry file (FHDOTNET.reg) that contains the global registry settings, profile  
specific and operating registry settings for Network Interface Card Task Tray Applet (NICTT).  
A sample FHDOTNET.reg file is provided as part of the DCP for MC9000w. Edit the file using a text  
editor. See notes in the sample file for the key information that can be modified.  
Save this text file as FHDOTNET.reg in order to override the existing reg file on the terminal. Use  
ActiveSync to copy this file to the Platform folder on the mobile computer. Once this file is loaded  
onto the mobile computer, these settings are restored after a cold boot.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Accessories  
Chapter Contents  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
7-2 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Universal Battery Charger (UBC) Adapter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7-42  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Accessories  
7-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
7-4 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Accessories  
7-5  
Introduction  
Series 9000 accessories provide a variety of product support capabilities. Accessories include  
cradles, keypads, Magnetic Stripe Reader (MSR) and Cable Adapter Module (CAM) snap-ons, four  
slot spare battery charger, headphone. Multimedia Card (MMC), Universal Battery Charger (UBC)  
adapter, wall mounting bracket and shelf slide.  
Cradles  
Single Slot Serial/USB Cradle charges the mobile computer main battery and/or a spare  
battery. It also synchronizes the mobile computer with a host computer through either a  
serial or a USB connection.  
Four Slot Charge Only Cradle charges the mobile computer main battery.  
Four Slot Ethernet Cradle charges the mobile computer main battery and synchronizes the  
mobile computer with a host computer through an Ethernet connection.  
Keypads  
Optional Keypads include the five interchangeable modular application specific keypads  
listed below. The modular keypads can be changed in the field as necessary to support  
specialized applications.  
• 28-key keypad (MC9000-K)  
• 43-key keypad (MC9000-K)  
• 53-key keypad (MC9000-K)  
• 28-key keypad (MC9000-S).  
Miscellaneous  
Four Slot Spare Battery Charger charges up to four mobile computer spare batteries.  
Headphone can be used in noisy environments.  
The MMC provides optional secondary non-volatile storage (a SD card may also be used).  
UBC Adapter adapts the UBC for use with the MC9000 batteries.  
Wall Mounting Bracket and Shelf Slide is used for wall mounting applications.  
Short Battery Adapter, required to charge MC9000-S spare batteries in a Single Slot Serial/  
USB Cradle or Four Slot Spare Battery Charger.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                           
7-6 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Snap-on Modules  
There are two snap on modules:  
MSR snaps on to the mobile computer and adds magstripe read capabilities.  
CAM snaps on to the mobile computer and is used to connect the cables to the mobile  
computer.  
Both of the snap on modules use the same cables:  
AC line cord (country-specific) and power supply, charges the mobile computer.  
Auto charge cable, charges the mobile computer using a vehicle’s cigarette lighter.  
DEX cable, connects the mobile computer to a vending machine.  
Serial cable, adds serial communication capabilities.  
USB cable, adds USB communication capabilities.  
Printer cable, adds printer communication capabilities.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Accessories  
7-7  
Keypads  
The mobile computer has interchangeable modular keypads. The modular keypads can be changed in  
the field as necessary to support specialized applications.  
Do not remove the keypad while the mobile computer is on and do not operate  
the mobile computer with the keypad detached.  
Follow proper ESD precautions to avoid damaging the MMC (or SD) card.  
Proper ESD precautions include, but are not limited to, working on an ESD mat  
and ensuring that the operator is properly grounded.  
Replacing the Keypad  
1. Suspend the mobile computer.  
2. Remove the two keypad screws. Slide the keypad down and lift up.  
Screws  
Keypad  
Multi Media Card Holder  
Figure 7-1. Removing the Keypad  
Do not apply more than 4 in-lbs of torque when tightening the keypad  
screws.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
7-8 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
3. Replace the keypad and re-attach using the two screws.  
Figure 7-2. Installing the Keypad  
Multi Media Card (MMC)  
The MMC provides secondary non-volatile storage, however the flash memory is slower than RAM.  
The MMC is located under the keypad, see Figure 7-1 on page 7-7.  
Do not remove the keypad while the mobile computer is on and do not operate  
the mobile computer with the keypad detached. Follow proper Electro-Static  
Discharge (ESD) precautions to avoid damaging the MMC. Proper ESD  
precautions include, but are not limited to, working on an ESD mat and  
ensuring that the operator is properly grounded.  
A Secure Device (SD) card may also be used, however security is not  
supported and only one bit is supported.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Accessories  
7-9  
To insert the MMC:  
1. Suspend the mobile computer.  
2. Remove the two keypad screws and slide the keypad down and lift off (see Figure 7-1 on  
3. Lift the MMC retaining door.  
4. Position the MMC, with the contacts down, into the MMC holder. The MMC corner notch  
fits into the holder only one way. Snap the retaining door closed.  
MMC  
MMC Retaining Door  
Figure 7-3. Inserting the MMC  
Do not apply more than 4 in-lbs of torque when tightening the keypad screws.  
5. Replace the keypad and re-attach using the two screws (see Figure 7-2 on page 7-8).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
7-10 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Single Slot Serial/USB Cradle  
This section describes how to set up and use a CRD 9000-1000S Single Slot Serial/USB Cradle with  
the MC9000-K and MC9000-S. For cradle setup see Figure 7-4, for cradle communications setup  
Indicator  
LED Bar  
Spare  
Battery  
Spare  
Battery  
Charging  
Well  
Spare  
Battery  
Charging  
LED  
Serial Port USB Port Power Port  
Mobile  
Computer Slot  
Figure 7-4. Single Slot Serial/USB Cradle  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Accessories  
7-11  
MC9000-S  
Battery  
Short Battery  
Adapter  
Spare  
Battery  
Charging  
Well  
Spare  
Battery  
Charging  
LED  
Figure 7-5. MC9000-S Spare Battery Charging  
The Single Slot Serial/USB Cradle:  
Provides 15VDC power for operating the mobile computer  
Provides serial/USB ports for data communication between the mobile computer and a host  
computer or other serial devices (e.g., a printer)  
Synchronizes information between the mobile computer and a host computer (with  
customized or third party software, it can also be used to synchronize the mobile computer  
with corporate databases)  
Charges the mobile computer’s battery  
Charges a spare battery.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
7-12 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Setup  
The cradle requires a dedicated port on the host computer.  
Serial Port  
Serial Cable  
Serial Port  
USB Port  
Power Port  
DC Cable  
Power Supply  
USB Port  
USB Cable  
AC Line Cord  
Figure 7-6. Single Slot Serial/USB Cradle, Power/Serial/USB Connections  
Select either serial or USB for communications, do not connect cradle to both  
serial and USB ports.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Accessories  
7-13  
Battery Charging  
The the single slot serial/USB cradle can charge the mobile computer’s main battery and a spare  
battery simultaneously.  
The mobile computers amber charge LED, located in the Indicator LED Bar (see Figure 1-1 on page  
1-3), shows the mobile computer battery charging status.  
The cradle has an amber spare battery charging LED (see Figure 7-4 on page 7-10) that shows the  
spare battery charging status, see Table 7-1 for charging status indications.  
The battery usually charges in less than four hours.  
Table 7-1. LED Charging Status Indicators  
LED  
Indication  
Mobile Computer Charging (LED on mobile computer)  
Off  
Mobile computer not in cradle; mobile computer not placed correctly; cradle is not powered.  
Error in charging; check placement of mobile computer.  
Mobile computer is charging.  
Fast Blinking Amber  
Slow Blinking Amber  
Solid Amber  
Charging complete.  
Spare Battery Charging (LED on cradle)  
Off  
No spare battery in slot; spare battery not placed correctly; cradle is not powered.  
Fast Blinking Amber  
Slow Blinking Amber  
Solid Amber  
Error in charging; check placement of spare battery.  
Spare battery is charging.  
Charging complete.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
7-14 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Vehicle Cradle  
There are two versions of the VCD9000 Vehicle Cradle, one is used with the MC9000-K mobile  
computer and one is used with the MC9000-S mobile computer. Both of the VCD9000 Vehicle Cradles  
are functionally identical. This section describes how to install and use a VCD9000 vehicle cradle with  
the mobile computer.  
Mobile computer  
release button  
Mobile computer  
slot  
Spare battery  
slot  
Spare battery  
charging LED  
Figure 7-7. VCD9000 Vehicle Cradle - Front  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Accessories  
7-15  
BACK  
Mounting holes  
Self-locking screws  
BOTTOM  
Serial port  
Power port  
Figure 7-8. VCD9000 Vehicle Cradle - Back / Bottom  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
7-16 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
The vehicle’s 12 V or 24 V electrical system powers the cradle. The operating voltage range is 9 V to  
32 V and requires a maximum current of 4A. Once installed into the cab of the vehicle, the cradle holds  
the mobile computer securely in place. In addition, it also:  
Provides power for operating the mobile computer  
Provides a serial port for data communication between the mobile computer and an external  
device (e.g., a printer)  
Charges the mobile computer’s battery  
Charges a spare battery.  
ROAD SAFETY - Do not use the mobile computer while driving. Park  
the vehicle first. Ensure the mobile computer is fully inserted in the  
cradle. Do not place it on the seat or where it can break loose in a  
collision or sudden stop. Improper insertion can result in property  
damage or personal injury. Remember: Safety comes first.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Accessories  
7-17  
Setup  
Table 7-2 lists the requirements for setting up and using the VCD9000.  
Table 7-2. VCD9000 Setup Requirements  
Feature  
Requirements  
Mounting (See page 7-18)  
Four 8-32 X 1” long screws with locking washers (provided as part of the  
cradle).  
Four #8 washers recommended.  
A drill with a #6 drill bit (0.204”).  
Power Connection (See page 7-20)  
Power input cable (provided) connects to vehicle power.  
For continued protection  
agains risk of fire, replace only  
with same type and rating of  
fuse according to the input  
voltage used.  
UL-listed in-line fuse rated 4A or 5A (both included), must be used if not  
connecting to vehicle’s fuse panel.  
For 12 V operation use UL-listed 5A fuse (included).  
For 24 V operation use UL-listed 4A fuse (included).  
In-line fuse holder (included), must be used if not connecting to vehicle’s  
fuse panel.  
Serial Connection (See page 7-23)  
DB9 female serial cable (some external devices require a null modem  
cable). The port is a Standard RS-232 for direct connection to a serial  
device.  
Communication  
An MC9000 Series mobile computer.  
Setup of mobile computer and external device (as determined by the  
application used).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
7-18 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Mounting  
To mount the Vehicle Cradle without using a mounting bracket or mounting device compatible with  
the VCD9000:  
1. Prepare the mounting surface to accept four 8-32 X 1” long self-locking screws, using a copy  
of the mounting template below. Drill four holes (0.204” diameter) with a #6 drill bit.  
1.2”  
1.5”  
Figure 7-9. Mounting Template  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Accessories  
7-19  
2. Remove the four self-locking screws from the back of the cradle.  
Figure 7-10. Vehicle Cradle - Back  
3. Place the back of the cradle on the mounting bracket or other mounting device/surface, with  
the four holes in the back of the cradle aligned with the four holes in the mounting surface.  
4. Insert the four self-locking screws through the holes in the mounting surface, into the back  
of the cradle.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
7-20 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Symbol recommends using #8 washers to protect the mounting surface.  
Figure 7-11. Sample Mounting Configuration  
Do not install the cradle on or near an air bag cover plate or within  
an aerobic zone. Also, do not install it in a location that affects  
vehicle safety or driving ability.  
Power Connection  
Read the following instructions completely before beginning.  
A properly trained technician must perform the power connection. Improper  
connection can damage the vehicle or cradle.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Accessories  
7-21  
To connect the cradle to power:  
1. Locate the vehicle power source.  
An accessory output in the vehicles fuse panel is the ideal location for  
connecting the vehicle cradle power input cable. The vehicle cradle should be  
added to a circuit with a maximum load capacity for the cradle and the  
original circuit. Refer to the vehicle’s owner’s manual for identification of the  
circuit. If a fused output is not available, the cradle must be installed with the  
provided in-line fuse holder and UL-listed fuse (rated 4A for 24 V operation,  
5A for 12 V operation). The fuse protects the vehicle from an electrical short  
on the power line to the cradle.  
To use the cradle to charge the mobile computer and spare battery, shut off  
the vehicle’s ignition, then connect the cradle to unswitched power.  
2. Route the power input cable from the cradle’s power port to the connection point for the  
vehicle’s power source.  
The means of routing and securing the power input cable from the cradle  
through to the vehicle power source is extremely important. Hazards  
associated with improper wiring can be severe. To avoid unintentional  
contact between the wire and any sharp edges, provide the cable with proper  
bushings and clamping where it passes through openings. If the wire is  
subject to sharp surfaces and excess engine vibration, the wiring harness  
insulation can wear away, causing a short between the bare wire and  
chassis. This can start a fire.  
3. When using the supplied in-line fuse holder (which must be used if not connecting to the  
vehicle’s fuse panel):  
a. Ensure the fuse holder contains a UL-listed fuse (rated 4A for 24 V operation, 5A for 12  
V operation).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
7-22 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
b. Splice the fuse holder to the end of the red V+ wire, as shown below. Make the distance  
from the fuse to the power connection point as short as possible.  
Shield wire  
(bare wire)  
Ground wire  
(black)  
V+ power (red)  
4A fuse and  
fuse holder  
Figure 7-12. Connecting Power to Cradle  
4. Prepare the cable termination.  
a. Red wire: connect to a +12/24 V vehicle power source.  
b. Black wire and shield wire: connect to vehicle ground wire or chassis ground.  
How the cable terminates depends on the vehicle. If the vehicle has a power  
output connector, attach a mating connector to the end of the power cable.  
You may be able to connect to a fuse panel with a simple blade terminal or  
commercially available connector. Consult the vehicle owner’s manual for  
information on how to access the vehicle’s power supply.  
5. Connect the power input cable to the power port on the cradle.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Accessories  
7-23  
To confirm that the cradle has power, insert the mobile computer. The mobile computer battery  
charging LED blinks amber to indicate charging, then turns solid amber when the battery is completely  
charged, see LED Indicators on page 7-27 for other indications.  
Serial Connection  
When the mobile computer is inserted into the cradle, the mobile computer’s serial port connects to  
the cradles serial port. The mobile computer can then use the cradle’s serial port to communicate  
with an external device.  
To provide serial communication between the mobile computer and a serial device, connect one end  
of the 9-pin serial cable to the serial port on the cradle, and the other end to the serial port on the  
serial device.  
To serial port of serial  
device  
Figure 7-13. Serial Connection  
Some external devices may require a null modem cable.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
7-24 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
To begin communication:  
1. Insert the mobile computer into the cradle.  
2. Initiate communication on the mobile computer, as determined by the application used.  
Removing the mobile computer during communication disrupts  
communication between the mobile computer and the attached device.  
Mobile Computer Insertion and Removal  
To insert the mobile computer into the cradle, place the bottom of the mobile computer into the  
bottom of the cradle, then press the mobile computer back into the cradle until the release button  
locks it in place.  
Release button  
Figure 7-14. Inserting the Vehicle Cradle  
Ensure the mobile computer is fully inserted into the cradle.  
Improper insertion can result in property damage or personal  
injury. Do not use the product while driving.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Accessories  
7-25  
To remove the mobile computer from the cradle, lift the release button, then lift the mobile computer  
from the cradle.  
Release button  
Figure 7-15. Removing the Vehicle Cradle  
Mobile Computer Battery Charging  
To charge the mobile computer battery:  
1. Ensure the cradle is connected to a power source, see Power Connection on page 7-20.  
2. Insert the mobile computer into the cradle, see Mobile Computer Insertion and Removal on  
The mobile computer starts charging when inserted. This does not deplete the vehicle battery  
significantly.  
The mobile computer battery charging LED blinks amber to indicate charging, then turns solid amber  
when the battery is completely charged. The battery charges in approximately four hours, see LED  
Indicators on page 7-27 for other indications.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
7-26 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Spare Battery Insertion and Removal  
To insert a spare battery:  
1. Insert the battery into the spare battery charging slot in the back of the cradle as shown.  
Spare battery  
latch  
Figure 7-16. Inserting the Vehicle Cradle  
2. Push the battery in. Listen for the click that signifies the battery’s latch has locked the  
battery into place.  
To remove the spare battery, press in the battery latch, then remove the battery from the spare battery  
slot.  
Spare Battery Charging  
1. Ensure the cradle is connected to a power source, see Power Connection on page 7-20.  
2. Insert the spare battery into the cradle, see Spare Battery Insertion and Removal on  
The spare battery charging LED blinks amber to indicate charging, then turns solid amber when the  
battery is completely charged. The battery charges in approximately four hours, see LED Indicators on  
page 7-27 for other indications.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Accessories  
7-27  
LED Indicators  
Table 7-3. LED Charging Indicators  
Cradle LED  
Indication  
Mobile Computer Battery Charging LED  
Off  
Mobile computer is not in cradle; mobile computer is not inserted correctly;  
cradle is not powered.  
Fast Blinking Amber  
Slow Blinking Amber  
Solid Amber  
Error in charging; check placement of mobile computer.  
Mobile computer is charging.  
Charging complete.  
Spare Battery Charging LED (on Cradle)  
Off  
No spare battery in slot; spare battery is not inserted correctly; cradle is not  
powered.  
Fast Blinking Amber  
Slow Blinking Amber  
Solid Amber  
Error in charging; check placement of spare battery.  
Spare battery is charging.  
Charging is complete.  
Care and Cleaning  
Avoid getting oils, grease, or gasoline on the cradle, and do not let debris gather in the bottom of the  
cradle slot. When necessary, clean the cradle with a mild cleaner. If necessary, contact Symbol for  
advice on whether to use a particular cleaner.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
7-28 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Four Slot Ethernet Cradle  
This section describes how to set up and use a Four Slot Ethernet cradle. For cradle communication  
setup procedures, see Ethernet Setup on page 4-16.  
MC9000-S  
MC9000-K  
Power Port  
Ethernet  
Communication Port  
Figure 7-17. Four Slot Ethernet Cradle  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Accessories  
7-29  
The Four Slot Ethernet cradle has the following attributes:  
Provides 12VDC power for operating the mobile computer.  
Enables data communication between the mobile computer (up to four) and a host computer,  
over an Ethernet network (using a standard 10Base-T Ethernet cable).  
Synchronizes information between the mobile computer and a host computer. (With  
customized or third party software, it can also be used to synchronize the mobile computer  
with corporate databases.)  
Simultaneously charges up to four batteries in the mobile computer.  
Setup  
The Ethernet cradle must be connected to a power source and to an Ethernet Hub (when  
applicable).  
DC Cable  
To Ethernet Hub  
AC Line Cord  
Power Supply  
Figure 7-18. Four Slot Ethernet Cradle Power Connection  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
7-30 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Battery Charging Indicators  
The mobile computer’s amber charge LED, located in the Indicator LED Bar, see Figure 1-1 on page 1-  
3, shows the battery charging status. See Table 7-1 on page 7-13 for charging status indications.  
The battery usually charges in less than four hours.  
Four Slot Charge Only Cradle  
This section describes how to set up and use a Four Slot Charge Only Cradle with the mobile  
computer.  
MC9000-S  
MC9000-K  
Power Port  
Figure 7-19. Four Slot Charge Only Cradle  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Accessories  
7-31  
The Four Slot Charge Only Cradle has the following attributes:  
Provides 12VDC power for operating the mobile computer.  
Simultaneously charges up to four batteries in the mobile computer.  
Setup  
DC Cable  
AC Line Cord  
Power Supply  
Figure 7-20. Four Slot Cradle Power Connections  
Battery Charging Indicators  
The mobile computer’s amber charge LED, located in the Indicator LED Bar, see Figure 1-1 on page 1-  
3, shows the battery charging status. See Table 7-1 on page 7-13 for charging status indications.  
The battery usually charges in less than four hours.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
7-32 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Four Slot Spare Battery Charger  
This section describes how to set up and use the Four Slot Spare Battery Charger to charge up to four  
MC9000-K or MC9000-S spare batteries.  
MC9000-K  
Spare  
Battery  
MC9000-S  
Spare  
Battery  
Short  
Battery  
Adapter  
Spare  
Battery  
Charging  
Slot  
Spare Battery  
Charging LEDs (4)  
Power Port  
DC Cable  
AC Cord  
Power Supply  
Figure 7-21. Four Slot Spare Battery Charger  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Accessories  
7-33  
Spare Battery Charging with the Four Slot Spare Battery Charger  
1. Connect the charger to a power source.  
2. For MC9000-K battery charging, insert the battery into a spare battery charging slot and  
gently press down on the battery to ensure proper contact.  
3. For MC9000-S battery charging use the Short Battery Adapter, see Figure 7-5 on page 7-11  
and gently press down on the battery to ensure proper contact.  
LED Charge Indications  
An amber LED is provided on the Four Slot Spare Battery Charger to indicate spare battery charging  
status, see Table 7-1 on page 7-13 for charging indication details.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
7-34 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Magnetic Stripe Reader  
This section describes how to set up and use the snap-on MSR with the MC9000-K and the MC9000-  
S. The MSR snaps on to the mobile computer and can be removed easily when not in use.  
Latches  
Card Reader Slot  
Pogo Pin Passthrough  
Connector  
Latch Grip  
Communications Port  
Power Port  
Figure 7-22. MSR  
The MSR:  
Provides mobile computer’s operating power and battery charging power when used with  
the Symbol approved power supply and cable.  
Allows the mobile computer to capture data from magnetic stripe cards. (To download MSR  
data capture software, visit: http://devzone.symbol.com.)  
Provides serial connection through the serial pass-through port for communication with a  
serial device, such as a host computer. For communication setup procedures, see Serial  
Provides USB connection through the USB pass-through port for communication with a USB  
device, such as a host computer. For communication setup procedures, see USB Connection  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Accessories  
7-35  
MSR and CAM Installation/Removal  
To attach, snap the MSR or the CAM onto the bottom of the mobile computer.  
Latch Grip  
(one on each side)  
Figure 7-23. MSR and CAM Installation  
To remove, squeeze the latch grips and pull the MSR or the CAM from the mobile computer.  
Remove the MSR from the bottom of the mobile computer before using a  
cradle for charging and communication.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
7-36 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Power Connection  
The MSR or CAM can accept power from either a standard AC plug or from a 12 VDC vehicle power  
source:  
1. Select either the universal AC power supply or the 12VDC power cable.  
2. Plug the power cord into the unit.  
3. Plug the other end of the power cord into the power source.  
Or  
AC Power Supply  
Vehicle Power Supply  
Figure 7-24. MSR or CAM Power Connection  
LED Charge Indications  
The mobile computers charging LED blinks amber to indicate that the battery is charging and turns  
solid amber when battery is completely charged. The battery usually charges in less than four hours.  
See Table 7-1 on page 7-13 for charging indication details.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Accessories  
7-37  
Serial/USB Connection  
The MSR can connect to and communicate with a serial/USB device, such as a printer or host  
computer, through its serial port. See CAM and MSR Communications Setup on page 7-41 for the host  
computer communication setup procedure.  
To connect the MSR to a serial/USB device, connect one end of the serial device cable into the  
communications port on the MSR and the other end into the serial/USB port on the device.  
Communications Port  
To Device  
Figure 7-25. MSR or CAM Serial/USB Connection  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
7-38 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Magnetic Stripe Reading  
The MSR9000 application is designed to work with the MSR. This sample application illustrates how  
an application should handle MSR inputs. From the Test Applications window, double-tap the  
MSR9000 icon. The MSR window appears, see MSR9000 on page 5-25 or MSR Cameo on page 5-26.  
The card may be swiped in either direction, from left to right or from right to left, with the magnetic  
stripe facing towards the mobile computer. For best results, gently press down on the card while  
swiping to ensure contact with the bottom of the reader.  
The MSR does not need to be attached to the power supply to read magnetic  
stripes.  
When creating software applications involving the CAM or MSR, the  
application developer should be aware that the devices are designed to  
breakaway from the terminal if accidentally dropped. The application should  
always check for the snap-on presence before talking to the device.  
To use the MSR:  
2. Power on the mobile computer.  
3. Tap the MSR or the MSR Cameo icon to start the application.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Accessories  
7-39  
4. Swipe the magnetic stripe card through the reader, ensuring the magnetic stripe on the card  
is positioned as shown below.  
Figure 7-26. MSR Magnetic Stripe Card Swiping  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
7-40 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Cable Adapter Module  
This section describes how to set up and use the CAM. Both the CAM and the MSR attach to the  
mobile computer the same way, see Figure 7-23 on page 7-35. They also share the same power  
connection, see Figure 7-24 on page 7-36 and the same serial/USB connection, see Figure 7-25 on  
page 7-37. The CAM and the MSR allow connection and charging of the MC9000-K and the MC9000-  
S using the following cables:  
Auto Charge Cable  
DEX Cable  
Serial Cable  
Printer Cable  
USB Cable.  
Latches  
Pogo Pin Connector  
Latch Grip  
Communications Port  
Power Port  
Figure 7-27. CAM  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Accessories  
7-41  
The CAM:  
Provides mobile computer’s operating power and battery charging power when used with  
the Symbol approved power supply and cable.  
Provides serial connection through the serial pass-through port for communication with a  
serial device, such as a host computer. For communication setup procedures, see Serial  
Provides USB connection through the USB pass-through port for communication with a USB  
device, such as a host computer. For communication setup procedures, see USB Connection  
CAM and MSR Communications Setup  
Both the CAM and MSR can be set up to communicate either with a serial connection or a USB  
connection and both devices use the same setup procedure. For detailed communications setup  
1. On the mobile computer double-tap the Ctl Panel icon and double-tap Comm Settings to  
enter the Comm Settings, window.  
Figure 7-28. Comm Settings Window  
2. With Port highlighted, use the left  
and right arrow  
buttons to select the value.  
Select the Comm port setting appropriate for the host computer, choose the default value of  
USB, or set to Serial1 @ 115200.  
3. Tap OK to exit the Comm Settings window and tap Exit to exit the Control Panel window.  
4. Ensure that ActiveSync was installed on the host computer and a partnership was created.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
7-42 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Universal Battery Charger (UBC) Adapter  
There are two UBC Adapters, one for the MC9000-K/G Batteries and one for the MC9000-S Batteries.  
The UBCs can be used with a power supply as a standalone spare battery charger or it can be used  
with the four station UBC2000 to provide charging to simultaneously charge up to four spare  
batteries. For additional information on the UBC 2000 see the UBC 2000 Quick Reference Guide 70-  
33188-xx.  
1. Connect the power supply to the power port on the side of the UBC Adapter.  
Power Port  
DC Cable  
AC Line Cord  
Power Supply  
Figure 7-29. UBC Adapter Power Connection  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Accessories  
7-43  
2. Insert the battery into the battery slot with the charging contacts facing down (over charging  
pins) and gently press down on the battery to ensure proper contact. See Table 7-4 for the  
UBC Adapter LED indications.  
Battery  
Battery Release  
UBC Adapter  
Figure 7-30. Battery Insertion  
3. To remove the battery, press the battery release and lift battery out of slot.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
7-44 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
POW ER  
READY or STANDBY or FAULT  
(SolidYellow)  
(Green)  
(FlashingYellow)  
CHARGING  
(SolidYellow)  
Figure 7-31. UBC Adapter LEDs  
Table 7-4. UBC Adapter Charge LED Status Indications  
LED  
POWER  
Indication  
Green  
Description  
Power is connected to the UBC Adapter.  
READY or  
Green  
Charging complete.  
STANDBY or  
Flashing-  
Yellow  
The battery was deeply discharged and is being trickle charged to bring the voltage up  
to the operating level. After operating level voltage is achieved the battery charges  
normally.  
FAULT  
Yellow  
Yellow  
Charging error, check placement of mobile computer/spare battery.  
Normal charge.  
CHARGING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Accessories  
7-45  
Modem Module  
The MDM9000 Modem Module enables data communication between the MC9000 mobile computer  
and a host computer, remotely through the phone lines, and synchronizes information between the  
MC9000 and a host computer. This section describes how to setup and use the MDM9000 Modem  
Module.  
Serial Port  
Line In Port  
Phone Port  
LEDs  
Figure 7-32. Modem Module  
The Modem Module enables data communication between the mobile computer and a host computer,  
remotely through the phone lines, and synchronizes information between the mobile computer and a  
host computer.  
The following items are required for a modem connection:  
Telephone number, IP address and DNS/WINS address information from the dial-in server  
administrator  
Dial-in account on the host system, including a user ID and password  
RJ11 or RJ12 modem cable  
Telephone jack that supports plug-in modems connected to the local telephone system  
Setup of Country Codes to use the modem with the appropriate country’s telephone network.  
The following items are required for communication:  
MC9000 Series mobile computer  
Cable Adapter Module (CAM), Symbol p/n ADP9000-100 (see Cable Adapter Module on  
Serial Adapter Cable (for communication via cradle), Symbol p/n 25-63856-01  
Microsoft ActiveSync  
Setup of host computer and mobile computer.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
7-46 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Setup  
Connecting to the Mobile Computer  
CAM  
Male 15-pin connector  
1
2
ABC  
4
GHI  
3
DEF  
5
JKL  
7
RECALL  
PRS  
6
MNO  
8
TUV  
FNC  
9
WXY  
*
0
OPER  
CNF  
HOLD  
#
LNR  
SPD  
TRF  
ANS  
SPKR  
Phone port  
Line In port  
Phone cord  
Phone cord  
Figure 7-33. Modem Module Connection - Mobile Computer  
Do not connect the modem's 15-pin connector into a VGA port of a host  
computer.  
Using the Correct Telephone Line Type  
Use a standard analog phone line, as in most households. In an office, use a line connected to a fax  
machine or modem. In a hotel, request a room with a standard phone line or data port. If necessary,  
check with the local phone company or administrator to make sure you are using the right type of line  
before sending data.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Accessories  
7-47  
Connecting to the Single Slot Serial/USB Cradle  
Adapter cable  
Male 15-pin connector  
Phone port  
Line In port  
Phone cord  
Figure 7-34. Modem Module Connection - Single Slot Serial/USB Cradle  
Do not connect the modem's 15-pin connector into a VGA port of a host  
computer.  
If using a phone, connect the cord from the phone to the Phone port on the  
modem.  
Configuring the Mobile Computer for the Modem  
To create a modem connection on the mobile computer:  
1. Connect the modem to the mobile computer, see Connecting to the Mobile Computer on  
2. On the MC9000, tap Settings - Control Panel. Double-tap the Network and Dial-up  
Connections icon.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
7-48 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
3. In the Connection window, double-tap Make New Connection to create a connection.  
Figure 7-35. Network and Connections Windows  
4. Enter a name for the connection on the Make New Connection window, then tap Next.  
5. In the Select a modem list, select Hayes Compatible on COM1, then tap Next.  
Figure 7-36. New Connection and Modem Windows  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Accessories  
7-49  
6. In the Phone Number window, enter the phone number for the connection, then tap Finish.  
Figure 7-37. Phone Number Window  
Depending on the location when dialing, additional numbers may need to be  
dialed (e.g., a 9 prefix is often required if dialing from work; a country code is  
needed if dialing internationally). To avoid creating new modem connections  
for each situation, tap use dialing rules to define frequently used dialing  
locations.  
Connecting the Modem  
To connect to the host computer using the modem connection created in the last section:  
1. Tap Start - Settings - Control Panel. Double-tap the Network and Dialup Connections icon.  
2. In the Connection window, double-tap the name of the connection  
3. created in Creating a Modem Connection on page 8.  
4. To modify dial-up properties, tap Dial Properties..., make the selections in the Device  
Properties window, then tap OK.  
5. Tap Connect. The modem attempts to connect.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
7-50 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Figure 7-38. Dial-Up and Dial Properties Window  
Modem Country Setup  
The modem defaults to operation with US telephone networks (country code: B5). To operate the  
modem with other country telephone networks, enter the Country of Installation command. The  
modem adjusts its operating parameters to comply with the telephone network in the country  
specified.  
Syntax  
+GCI=<country_code>  
Enter this command in the MC9000 when setting up comunication via modem connection.  
Table 7-5. Supported Countries  
Country  
Australia  
Code  
Country  
Greece  
Code  
FD or 46  
Country  
Norway  
Code  
FD or 82  
09  
Austria  
Belgium  
Brazil  
FD or 0A  
FD or 0F  
16  
Iceland  
FD  
Portugal  
Spain  
FD or 8B  
FD or A0  
FD or A5  
FD or A6  
FD  
Ireland  
FD or 57  
FD or 59  
FD  
Italy  
Sweden  
Switzerland  
Canada  
Denmark  
20  
Liechtenstein  
Luxembourg  
FD or 31  
FD  
TBR-21  
(Europe)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Accessories  
7-51  
Table 7-5. Supported Countries (Continued)  
Country  
Finland  
Code  
FD or 3C  
Country  
Mexico  
Code  
Country  
United  
Code  
73  
FD or B4  
Kingdom  
France  
FD or 3D  
Netherlands  
FD or 7B  
United States  
B5  
(Default)  
Germany  
FD or 42  
New Zeland  
7E  
Note: Use FD where possible. If connection problems occur, use the alternate code where provided.  
AT Commands  
The AT Command Set allows you to custom-configure the modem. Only experienced users having  
difficulty with default settings should use this.  
Changing the Initialization String  
To enter AT commands:  
1. On the MC9000, tap Settings -Control Panel. Double-tap the Network and Dial-up  
Connections icon.  
2. In the Connection window, double-tap the My Connection icon to edit the settings.  
Figure 7-39. Network and Connections Windows  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
7-52 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
3. To modify dial-up properties, tap Dial Properties, make the selections in the Device  
Properties window.  
4. To edit the Dialing Patterns, tap Edit.  
Figure 7-40. Dial-Up and Dial Properties Window  
5. The Edit Dialing Patterns window appears.  
.
Figure 7-41. Edit Dialing Patterns Window  
6. Edit the dialing properties, see Table 7-6 on page 7-54.  
7. Tap OK to exit the Edit Dialing Patterns window.  
8. Tap OK to exit the Dialing Patterns window.  
9. Tap Connect at the Dial-Up Connection window. The modem attempts to connect.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Accessories  
7-53  
Basic AT Command Syntax  
A command line is made up of three elements:  
Prefix - consists of the characters “AT” or “at” or, to repeat the execution of the previous  
command line, “A/” or “a/”.  
Body - made up of individual commands described later. Space characters (IA5 2/0) are  
ignored and may be used for formatting purposes, unless they are embedded in numeric or  
string constants. The termination character may not appear in the body. The modem can  
accept at least 40 characters in the body.  
Termination character - may be selected by a user option (parameter S3). The default is  
CR.  
The format of Basic Syntax commands, except for the D and S commands, is as follows:  
<command>[<number>]  
where:  
<command> is either a single character, or the “&” character followed by a single character  
per V.250; or the “%” character followed by a single character, the “*” character followed  
by a single character, or the “^” character followed by a single character.  
<number> is a string of one or more characters from “0” through “9” representing a decimal  
integer value. Commands expecting a <number> are noted in the description of the  
command. If <number> is missing from such a command (<command> is immediately  
followed by another <command> or the termination character), the value “0” is assumed. If  
a command does not expect a <number> and a number is present, an error occurs. All  
leading “0”s in <number> are ignored by the modem.  
Additional commands may follow a command (and associated parameter, if any) on the same  
command line with a separation character. The actions of some commands cause the rest of the  
command line to be ignored.  
S-Parameters  
Commands that begin with the letter “S” are known as “S-parameters”. The number following the  
“S” indicates the “parameter number” referenced. If the number is not recognized as a valid  
parameter number, an ERROR result code issues. Immediately following this number, either a “?” or  
“=” character must appear. “?” is used to read the current value of the indicated S-parameter; “=”  
sets the S-parameter to a new value.  
S<parameter_number>?  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
7-54 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
S<parameter_number>=[<value>]  
If the “=” is used, the new value to be stored in the S-parameter is specified in decimal following the  
“=”. If no value is given (i.e., the end of the command line occurs or the next command follows  
immediately), the S-parameter specified may be set to 0, or an ERROR result code issues and the  
stored value remains. The ranges of acceptable values are given in the description of each S-  
parameter.  
If the “?” is used, the modem transmits a single line of information text to the DTE. The text portion  
of this information text consists of exactly three characters, giving the value of the S-parameter in  
decimal, with leading zeroes included.  
Commands  
The tables that follow summarize the AT commands, result codes, and S-Registers for the MDM 3000.  
<string> represents a letter, number, or symbol to be entered. <value> represents a number to be  
entered. Possible values are listed below the command.  
Table 7-6. AT Command Table  
Country  
Command  
Description  
Specific  
D
Dial “D<string>”  
0-9  
*
DTMF digits 0-9  
The ‘star’ digit (tone dialing only)  
The ‘gate’ digit (tone dialing only)  
DTMF digits A,B,C,D  
Re-dial last number  
#
A-D  
L
X
X
P
Pulse dialing  
T
Tone dialing  
W
Wait for dial tone. (Modem waits for dial tone before dialing digits  
following “W”.)  
@
&
Wait for silence. (Modem waits for at least 5 seconds of silence in the  
call progress  
frequency band before continuing with next dial string parameter.)  
Wait for credit card dialing tone before  
continuing with the dial string.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Accessories  
7-55  
Table 7-6. AT Command Table (Continued)  
Country  
Specific  
Command  
Description  
Dial pause. (Modem pauses for a time specified by S8 before dialing  
the digits following “,”)  
;
Return to command state. (Modem goes off hook and allows entering  
additional AT commands. Use “H” to go back to on hook.)  
() - <space>  
Ignored. (Might be used to format the dial string.)  
A
H
O
Off-hook and attempt to answer a call  
Disconnect – Hang UP  
Return to On-Line Data Mode. O <value>  
0
1
Enters on-line data mode without a retrain.  
Enters on-line data mode with a retrain.  
L
Speaker volume (Not used)  
Speaker control. M <value>  
M
0
1
2
3
Always off.  
On during call establishment. Off when receiving carrier. (default)  
Always on.  
Off when receiving carrier and during dialing. On during answering.  
&G  
Guard tone. &G<value>  
X
X
0
1
2
Disables guard tone. (default)  
Disables guard tone.  
Select 1800 Hz guard tone.  
&V1  
Displays last connection statistics  
+MS  
Modulation Selection. +MS=<carrier>  
B103  
B212  
V21  
Bell 103 (300)  
Bell 212 (1200 Rx/75 or 75Rx/1200 Tx)  
300  
V22  
1200  
V22B  
2400 or 1200  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
7-56 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Table 7-6. AT Command Table (Continued)  
Country  
Specific  
Command  
Description  
V23C  
V32  
1200  
9600 or 4800  
V32B  
V34  
14400, 12000, 9600, 7200 or 4800  
33600, 31200, 28800, 26400, 2400, 21600, 19200, 16800, 14400,  
12000, 9600, 7200, 4800 or 2400  
Enable/Disable Line Quality Monitor and Auto-Retrain or Fall back/Fall  
forward. %E<value>  
%E  
0
1
2
Disable line quality monitor and auto re-train.  
Enable line quality monitor and auto re-train.  
Enable line quality monitor and fallback/fall forward. (default).  
B
CCITT or Bell. B<value>  
0
1
Select CCITT operation at 300 or 1200 bauds.  
Selects Bell operation at 300 or 1200 bauds.  
&L  
Leased Line Operation. &L<value>  
0
Requests dial-up operation. Dial-up operation continues.  
Table 7-7. S-Register Settings  
Default  
Reg  
S0  
Function  
Range  
0-255  
0-255  
0-255  
0-127  
0-127  
De-fault  
Saved  
Units  
rings  
rings  
ASCII  
ASCII  
ASCII  
Rings to Auto Answer  
Ring Counter  
0
*
*
S1  
0
S2  
Escape Character  
43  
13  
10  
S3  
Carriage Return Character  
Line Feed Character  
S4  
* Register value may be stored in on of two user  
** Country-dependent  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Accessories  
7-57  
Table 7-7. S-Register Settings (Continued)  
Default  
Reg  
S5  
Function  
Backspace Character  
Range  
De-fault  
Saved  
Units  
ASCII  
S
0-255  
8
S6  
Wait Time before Blind Dialing or Dial Tone  
Wait Time for Carrier, Silence or Dial Tone  
Pause Time for Dial Delay Modifier  
Carrier Detect Response Time  
Lost Carrier to Hangup Delay  
DTMF Tone Duration  
2-255  
2
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
S7  
1-255  
50  
S
S8  
0-255  
2
S
S9  
1-255  
6
0.1 S  
0.1 S  
mS  
S10  
S11  
S12  
S14  
S16  
S19  
S20  
S21  
S22  
S23  
S24  
S25  
S26  
S27  
S28  
S29  
S30  
S31  
S36  
1-255  
14  
50-255  
95  
Escape Prompt Delay (EPD)  
General Bit Mapped Options Status  
Test Mode Bit Mapped Options Status  
Reserved  
0-255  
50  
.02 S  
-
138 (8Ah)  
-
0
-
0
Reserved  
-
0
V.24 Bit Mapped Options Status  
Speaker/Results Bit Mapped Options  
General Bit Mapped Options Status  
Sleep Inactivity Timer  
-
52 (34h)  
-
117 (75h)  
-
62 (3Dh)  
0-255  
0
S
S
Delay to DTR off  
0-255  
5
RTS-to-CTS Delay  
0-255  
1
.01 S  
General Bit Mapped Options Status  
General Bit Mapped Options Status  
Flash Dial Modifier Time  
-
73 (49h)  
-
0
0-255  
70  
10 mS  
10 S  
Disconnect Inactivity Timer  
General Bit Mapped Options Status  
LAPM Failure Control  
0-255  
0
195 (C0h)  
7
-
-
*
* Register value may be stored in on of two user  
** Country-dependent  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
7-58 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Table 7-7. S-Register Settings (Continued)  
Default  
Reg  
S38  
S39  
S40  
S41  
S46  
S48  
S86  
S91  
S92  
S95  
S210  
Function  
Delay Before Forced Hangup  
Flow Control Bit Mapped Options Status  
General Bit Mapped Options Status  
General Bit Mapped Options Status  
Data Compression Control  
Range  
De-fault  
Saved  
Units  
0-255  
20  
S
-
3
104 (68h)  
195 (C3h)  
138  
-
*
*
*
-
-
V.42 Negotiation Control  
-
7
Call Failure Indication  
0-26  
0-15  
0-15  
0
PSTN Transmit Attenuation Level  
Fax Transmit Attenuation Level  
Extended Result Codes Control  
V.34 Symbol Rate  
10**  
10**  
0
dBm  
dBm  
*
0-255  
13 (0Dh)  
* Register value may be stored in on of two user  
** Country-dependent  
Modem LED Indicators  
Table 7-8. Modem LED Indicators  
LED  
Indication  
Off  
Modem is not properly connected to the mobile computer; modem is not receiving  
power.  
Green  
Modem is connected to the mobile computer and is receiving power.  
Mobile computer is communicating with the host computer.  
Solid Amber  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Accessories  
7-59  
Wall Mounting Bracket and Shelf Slide  
This section describes how to install and set up the MC9000 Wall Mount Bracket and Shelf Slide to  
mount cradles to a wall.  
Wall Mounting  
Bracket  
Shelf Slides  
Mounting one single slot cradle  
Mounting two single slot cradles  
Figure 7-42. Wall Mounting Bracket with Shelf Slide  
When installed on a wall, the mounting bracket and shelf slide enable mounting one or two single  
slot cradles to a wall. Use two brackets to mount a four slot cradle.  
Installing the Wall Mount Bracket  
To install the wall mount bracket for use with one or two single slot cradles or four slot chargers,  
place the smaller surface of the bracket against the wall or vertical support structure, and secure with  
four 1/4” screws (use two of the three screw holes in each row).  
Insert screws  
Insert screws  
Figure 7-43. Wall Mounting Bracket Mounting Screws  
If using the bracket and slide with a four slot cradle, secure a second bracket to the wall next to the  
first, aligning the horizontal screw holes on the second with those of the first.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
7-60 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Attaching the Shelf Slide to the Wall Mount Bracket  
One Single Slot Cradle/Four Slot Battery Charger  
To attach the shelf slide to the wall mount bracket for use with one single slot cradle or four slot  
battery charger:  
1. Place the slide on the bracket, aligning the larger pan-head screw holes in the slide with the  
center two screw holes on the bracket.  
2. Secure the slide to the bracket by inserting the two pan-head screws provided from below  
the bracket, up through the bracket’s screw holes and then through the slide’s pan-head  
screw holes.  
Pan-head Screw Holes  
Insert screws from below  
Figure 7-44. Attaching One Shelf Slide  
Two Single Slot Cradles/Four Slot Battery Chargers  
To attach the shelf slide to the wall mount bracket for use with two single slot cradles or two four  
slot battery chargers:  
1. Place the slide on the bracket, aligning the larger pan-head screw holes in the slide with the  
left or right two screw holes on the bracket.  
2. Secure the slide to the bracket by inserting the two pan-head screws provided from below  
the bracket, up through the bracket’s screw holes and then through the slide’s pan-head  
screw holes.  
3. Secure a second slide to the remaining two screw holes on the bracket in the same manner.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Accessories  
7-61  
Pan-head  
screw holes  
Insert screws from below  
Figure 7-45. Attaching Two Shelf Slides  
Four Slot Cradle  
To attach the shelf slide to the wall mount bracket for use with a four slot cradle:  
1. Place a slide on the left-hand bracket, aligning the larger pan-head screw holes in the slide  
with the left two screw holes on the bracket.  
2. Secure the slide to the bracket by inserting the two pan-head screws provided from below  
the bracket, up through the bracket’s screw holes and then through the slide’s pan-head  
screw holes.  
3. Place a slide on the right-hand bracket, aligning the larger pan-head screw holes in the slide  
with the right two screw holes on the bracket.  
4. Secure the second slide to the bracket as described in Step 2.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
7-62 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Installing the Cradle/Charger on the Bracket  
Install the cradle or charger onto the bracket, inserting the bracket’s slide into the grooves on the  
bottom of the cradle/charger and sliding the cradle/charger into the desired position.  
1. For one single slot cradle/four slot charger, center it on the bracket.  
Slide grooves on bottom of  
cradle/charger over bracket  
Figure 7-46. Attaching Two Shelf Slides  
2. For two single slot cradles/four slot chargers, slide one onto the left-hand slide, and one  
onto the right-hand slide  
Insert set screws  
Figure 7-47. Attaching Two Shelf Slides  
3. For a four slot cradle, slide the cradle on to the slides, across both brackets.  
4. Secure each cradle or charger to its slide using the two set screws provided.  
5. Position the power supply on the shelf, behind the cradle.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Accessories  
7-63  
Power Supply  
Figure 7-48. Positioning the Power Supply  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
7-64 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
8-2 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Software Installation  
8-3  
Introduction  
The Symbol Windows CE SMDK for Series 9000 allows users to develop Windows CE applications  
for Series 9000 mobile computers. This SMDK contains libraries and other Symbol value-add  
software not available in the standard Microsoft® Windows® CE Platform SMDK.  
Symbol Windows CE SMDK  
The SMDK installation program loads the required Windows CE components on the development  
computer used to create the image files for download to the mobile computer.  
Hardware Requirements  
The minimum system configuration required to install the SMDK is:  
IBM-compatible Personal Computer with Pentium 450 MHz processor or higher  
Microsoft Windows XP®, or Microsoft Windows 2000® operating system  
128 MB RAM  
100 MB available hard disk space  
CD-ROM drive  
One available serial port  
Mouse.  
Software Requirements  
Before installing the Symbol Windows CE SMDK for Series 9000, install the following tools:  
Microsoft eMbedded Visual C++ v4.0 and Service Pack 1  
Microsoft ActiveSync version 3.7 or higher  
Adobe® Acrobat® Reader® 3.0 or higher.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
8-4 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
SMDK Components  
The SMDK installation program loads all of the SMDK, Series 9000 components onto the  
development computer. Once installed, the SMDK allows users to create applications and deploy the  
applications to mobile computers.  
The Symbol Windows CE SMDK for Series 9000 includes the following components:  
Help  
PRG  
HTML-based help file containing the Symbol API definitions.  
Product Reference Guide containing information about the setup and use of the  
mobile computer.  
Readme HTML-based file containing release notes and last minute help updates.  
Samples Sample source code, showing how to interface with Symbol API functions.  
Emulator Series 9000 Desktop emulation environment.  
TCM  
Terminal Configuration Manager program used to customize and load software.  
Installing the SMDK  
1. Download the SMDK from the Symbol website, http://devzone.symbol.com.  
2. Double-click the executable file and follow the install screen prompts.  
3. Once installed, the major components of the SMDK can be accessed from the Symbol  
Windows CE SMDK (PDT9000) program group of the Windows Start Menu. The components  
include: Help, PRG, Readme, Samples, TCM, Emulator and Updates.  
4. The sample applications provide a good overview of the SMDK usage. To build a sample  
application, open the Samples folder from the Windows Start menu. Open the folder for the  
desired sample and then open the project file. The project file has an extension of VCP.  
Microsoft Visual C++ v4.0 will automatically launch. Select PDT9000 as the Active WCE  
Configuration. Select Win32 (WCE ARMV4) Debug as the Active Configuration.  
If both Microsoft Visual C++ v3.0 and Microsoft Visual C++ v4.0 are installed  
on the development computer then confirm that Microsoft Visual C++ v4.0 is  
the one being launched.  
Software Updates  
Updates to the SMDK can be downloaded from the Symbol Developer Zone web site at http://  
devzone.symbol.com. This site can be easily accessed using a shortcut added to the Windows start  
menu. It should be checked periodically for important updates and new software versions.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
AirBEAM Smart  
Chapter Contents  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
AirBEAM Smart  
9-3  
Introduction  
The AirBEAM Smart product allows specially designed software packages to be transferred between  
a host server and Symbol wireless handheld devices. Before transfer, AirBEAM Smart checks and  
compares package version, so that only updated packages are loaded.  
AirBEAM Smart resides on radio-equipped client devices and allows them to request, download and  
install software, as well as to upload files and status data. Both download and upload of files can be  
accomplished in a single communications session. The ability to transfer software over a radio  
network can greatly reduce the logistical efforts of client software management.  
In an AirBEAM Smart system, a network-accessible host server acts as the storage point for the  
software transfer. The AirBEAM Smart Client uses the industry standard FTP or TFTP file transfer  
protocols to check the host system for updates and if necessary, to transfer updated software.  
AirBEAM Package Builder  
In a typical distributed AirBEAM Smart system, software to be transferred is organized into packages.  
In general, an AirBEAM Smart package is simply a set of files that are assigned attributes both as an  
entire package and as individual component files. The package is assigned a version number and the  
transfer occurs when an updated version is available.  
An AirBEAM Smart package can optionally contain developer-specified logic to be used to install the  
package. Installation logic is typically used to update client device flash images or radio firmware.  
Examples of common AirBEAM Smart packages would include packages for custom client application  
software, radio firmware and AirBEAM Smart Client software.  
Once these packages are built, they are installed on the host server for retrieval by the handheld  
device. The AirBEAM Package Builder is a utility used to define, generate and install AirBEAM  
packages to a server. The packages are then loaded from the server onto a client device equipped  
with an AirBEAM Smart Client executable.  
For detailed instructions on how to define, generate and install AirBEAM packages to the server, refer  
to the AirBEAM Package Builder Product Reference Guide, p/n 72-55769-xx.  
AirBEAM Smart Client  
The AirBEAM Smart Client is installed on the handheld mobile computer. It is configured with the  
server access information, the names of the packages to be downloaded and other controlling  
parameters. When the AirBEAM Smart Client is launched, the device connects to the specified FTP  
server and checks the packages it is configured to look for. If the package version was updated, the  
client requests the transfer.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
9-4 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
AirBEAM Smart License  
The AirBEAM Smart Client is a licensed software product. The AirBEAM Smart Client's version  
synchronization functionality is enabled through a license key file that is stored on the client device.  
The license key file can be built into AirBEAM Smart Client's image, or downloaded in a special  
AirBEAM package. The AirBEAM Smart license key file contains a unique key and a customer specific  
banner that is displayed when the AirBEAM Smart Client version synchronization logic is invoked.  
The AirBEAM Smart Client package that is included on the mobile computer does not include a  
licence key. This software version is limited to downloading of specific Symbol software products. A  
license key can be purchased that will allow the downloading of custom applications and other non-  
Symbol software products.  
Configuring the AirBEAM Smart Client  
1. Select Start - Programs - AirBEAM Client. The AirBEAM CE window appears.  
2. Tap File - Configure. The AirBEAM configuration window appears  
Figure 9-1. AirBEAM Smart Configuration Window  
The configuration window is used to view and edit AirBEAM Smart Client configurations. This dialog  
box has six tabs that can be modified - Packages(1), Packages(2), Server, Misc(1), Misc(2) and Misc(3).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
AirBEAM Smart  
9-5  
Packages(1) Tab  
This tab is used to specify the package name of the first four of eight packages  
that are to be loaded during the AirBEAM Smart synchronization process. The  
specified package name must correspond to a package that is available on the  
specified package server.  
Table 9-1. Package (1) Tab  
Field  
Package 1  
Description  
Package name of the first of eight packages. This is an optional field.  
Package name of the second of eight packages. This is an optional field.  
Package name of the third of eight packages. This is an optional field.  
Package name of the fourth of eight packages. This is an optional field.  
Package 2  
Package 3  
Package 4  
Packages(2) Tab  
This tab is used to specify the package name of the last four of eight packages  
that are to be loaded during the AirBEAM Smart synchronization process. The  
specified package name must correspond to a package that is available on the  
specified package server.  
Table 9-2. Package (2) Tab  
Field  
Package 5  
Package 6  
Package 7  
Package 8  
Upload Pkg  
Description  
Package name of the fifth of eight packages. This is an optional field.  
Package name of the sixth of eight packages. This is an optional field.  
Package name of the seventh of eight packages. This is an optional field.  
Package name of the eighth of eight packages. This is an optional field.  
Package name of a package that is to be processed for “upload files” during the AirBEAM Smart  
synchronization process. The specified package name must correspond to a package that is  
available on the specified package server. This is an optional field.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
9-6 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Server Tab  
This tab is used to specify the configurations of the server to which the client  
connects during the package synchronization process.  
Table 9-3. Server Tab  
Field  
IP Address  
Directory  
Description  
The IP Address of the server. It may be a host name or a dot notation format.  
The directory on the server that contains the AirBEAM Smart package definition files. All  
AirBEAM Smart package definition files are retrieved from this directory during the package  
synchronization process.  
User  
The FTP user name that is used during the login phase of the package synchronization process.  
Password  
The FTP password that corresponds to the FTP user specified in the User field. The specified  
password is used during the login phase of the package synchronization process.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
AirBEAM Smart  
9-7  
Misc(1) Tab  
This tab is used to configure various miscellaneous features.  
Table 9-4. Misc (1) Tab  
Field  
Auto-load  
Description  
This drop-down list is used to specify how the AirBEAM Smart Client is to be invoked  
automatically when the client device is rebooted. The selections are:  
Disable: the AirBEAM Smart Client is not invoked automatically during the boot  
sequence.  
Interactive: the AirBEAM Smart Client is invoked automatically during the boot sequence.  
The package synchronization process is started automatically. The Synchronization  
Dialog box appears and the user is required to press the OK button when the process is  
complete.  
Non-interactive: the AirBEAM Smart Client is invoked automatically during the boot  
sequence. The package synchronization process is started automatically. The  
Synchronization Dialog box is displayed, but the user is not required to tap OK when the  
process is complete. The Synchronization Dialog box terminates automatically.  
Background: the AirBEAM Smart Client is invoked automatically during the boot  
sequence. The package synchronization process is started automatically. Nothing is  
displayed while the synchronization process is occurring.  
RAM  
Management  
This checkbox specifies whether the automatic RAM management is enabled during the  
package synchronization process.  
If enabled, RAM management logic is invoked when there is not enough free disk space to  
download a package. The RAM management logic attempts to remove any discardable  
AirBEAM Smart packages resident on the client.  
Suppress  
Separator  
This checkbox specifies whether the automatic insertion of a file path separator character  
should be suppressed when the client generated server package definition file names.  
When enabled, the parameter also disables the appending of .apd to the package. This feature  
is useful for AS/400 systems, in which the file path separator character is a period. When this  
feature is enabled, the server directory (Directory) and package name (Package 1, Package 2,  
Package 3 and Package 4) are appended "as is” when building the name for the server package  
definition file.  
When this feature is disabled, a standard file path separator is used to separate the server  
directory (Directory) and package name (Package 1, Package 2, Package 3 and Package 4) when  
building the name for the server package definition file. In addition, an .apd extension is  
appended automatically.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
9-8 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Table 9-4. Misc (1) Tab (Continued)  
Field  
Description  
TFTP  
This checkbox specifies whether the TFTP protocol is to be used to download files. By default,  
the AirBEAM Smart Client uses the FTP protocol.  
WNMS  
This checkbox specifies whether the AirBEAM Smart Client uploads a WNMS information file  
at the end of each version synchronization.  
Misc(2) Tab  
This tab is used to configure various miscellaneous features.  
Table 9-5. Misc (2) Tab  
Field  
Auto-retry  
Description  
This field is used to specify whether the AirBEAM Smart Client automatically retries if there  
is a failure during the synchronization process.  
If this feature is enabled, the AirBEAM Smart Client displays a popup dialog indicating the  
attempt of a retry. The popup dialog is displayed for the number of seconds specified in the  
Retry Delay field.  
The valid values for this field are:  
-1: the AirBEAM Smart Client automatically retries indefinitely.  
0: the AirBEAM Smart Client does not automatically retry.  
-0: the AirBEAM Smart Client automatically retries up to the number of times specified.  
Retry Delay  
In-use Test  
This field specifies the amount of time, in seconds, that the AirBEAM Smart Client will delay  
before automatically retrying after a synchronization failure.  
This checkbox specifies whether the AirBEAM Smart Client tests to determine if a file is in-  
use before downloading. If the In-use Test feature is enabled, the AirBEAM Smart Client  
downloads a temporary copy of any files that are in-use. If any temporary in-use files are  
downloaded the AirBEAM Smart Client automatically resets the client to complete the copy of  
the in-use files. If the In-use Test feature is disabled, the synchronization process fails (-813)  
if any download files are in-use.  
Wait Welcome  
This checkbox specifies whether the AirBEAM Smart Client waits for the WELCOME windows  
to be completed before automatically launching the synchronization process after a reset.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
AirBEAM Smart  
9-9  
Table 9-5. Misc (2) Tab (Continued)  
Field  
Description  
Close Apps  
This checkbox specifies whether the AirBEAM Smart Client automatically attempts to close  
non-system applications prior to resetting the mobile unit. If enabled the AirBEAM Smart  
Client sends a WM_CLOSE message to all non-system applications before resetting the  
mobile unit. This feature offers applications the opportunity to prepare (i.e. close open files)  
for the pending reset.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9-10 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Misc(3) Tab  
This tab is used to configure various miscellaneous features.  
Table 9-6. Misc (3) Tab  
Field  
Description  
Use DHCP server This checkbox control specifies whether the AirBEAM Smart Client uses the DHCP response  
option 66 to specify the IP address of the FTP/TFTP server.  
If enabled, special RF network registry settings are required to force the DHCP server to return  
the "TFTP server name" field (option 66). The special RF network registry settings are included,  
but commented out, in the radio network registry initialization files (essid_xxxx_yy.reg).  
Use DHCP bootfile This check box control specifies whether the AirBEAM Smart Client uses the DHCP response  
option 67 to specify the Package and Package 1 parameters.  
If enabled, special RF network registry settings are required to force the DHCP server to return  
the "Bootfile name" field (option 67). The special RF network registry settings are included, but  
commented out, in the radio network registry initialization files (essid_xxxx_yy.reg).  
Synchronizing with the Server  
When the synchronization process is initiated, the AirBEAM Smart Client attempts to open an FTP  
session using the AirBEAM Smart Client configuration. Once connected, the client processes the  
specified packages. Packages are loaded only if the server version of a given package is different from  
the version loaded on the client. Once the upload process is complete, the AirBEAM Smart Client  
closes the FTP session with the server.  
The AirBEAM Smart Client can launch an FTP session with the server either manually, when initiated  
by the user, or automatically.  
Manual Synchronization  
1. Configure the AirBEAM Smart Client. See Configuring the AirBEAM Smart Client on page  
9-4.  
2. From the main AirBEAM Smart window, select File - Synchronize.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
AirBEAM Smart  
9-11  
3. Once connected, the AirBEAM Synchronize window appears.  
• The Status List displays status messages that indicate the  
progress of the synchronization process.  
• Tap OK to return to the Main Menu. This button remains inactive  
until the synchronization process is complete.  
• Tap Retry to restart the synchronization process. This button is  
activated only if there is an error during the synchronization  
process.  
Automatic Synchronization  
The AirBEAM Smart Client can be configured to launch automatically using the Misc(1) Preference  
tab, see Misc(1) Tab on page 9-7. When setting automatic synchronization, use the Auto-load drop-  
down list is to specify how the AirBEAM Smart Client should be invoked automatically when the  
client device is rebooted. See Misc(1) Tab on page 9-7 for instructions on enabling Auto Sync.  
AirBEAM Smart Staging  
The AirBEAM Smart staging support is intended to speed up and simplify the process of staging  
custom or updated operating software onto mobile devices directly from manufacturing. The staging  
support is part of the AirBEAM Smart CE Client that is integrated into the mobile computer.  
The AirBEAM Smart support works by defaulting the AirBEAM Smart Client configuration to a known  
set of values and launching the AirBEAM Smart package download logic. A staging environment,  
including an RF network, FTP server and AirBEAM Smart packages must be setup. Ideally a staging  
network and server should be setup to match the default AirBEAM Staging client configuration.  
The AirBEAM Smart staging utility is invoked by selecting the Files icon from the Series 9000 Demo  
screen, select \Platform\AirBeam\ and double tap on the abstage.lnk file.  
The AirBEAM Staging support provides several benefits:  
Many devices can be simultaneously loaded over the RF network.  
The AirBEAM staging utility provides a simple single dialog user interface that is used to  
quickly start the software installation process.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
9-12 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Mobile Computer Configuration  
Chapter Contents  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
10-2 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Mobile Computer Configuration  
10-3  
Introduction  
Terminal Configuration Manager (TCM) is an application used to customize flash file system  
partitions for the mobile computer. The most common use is to create an application partition hex file  
that contains the customer's application. TCM can also be used to load hex files to the flash memory  
of the mobile computer.  
The program resident on the mobile computer that receives the hex file and burns it to the flash  
memory is called Initial Program Loader (IPL).  
The customization of partitions is controlled by TCM scripts. The scripts contain all of the necessary  
information for building an image. The script is a list of copy commands specifying the files to copy  
from the development computer to the partition.  
TCM works with a pair of directory windows, one displaying the script and the other displaying the  
source files resident on the development computer. Using standard windows drag and drop  
operations, files can be added and deleted from the script window.  
The SMDK includes scripts used by Symbol Technologies to build the standard factory installed  
Platform and Application partitions provided on the mobile computer. The standard Platform partition  
contains drivers while the Application partition contains demo applications and optional components.  
The standard TCM scripts can be found in the following folder: C:\Program Files\Symbol Windows CE  
SMDK (PDT9000)\SymbolPlatforms \PDT9000\TCMScripts.  
Before creating a script to build a hex image, identify the files required  
(system files, drivers, applications, etc.) and locate the files’ source  
directories to make the script building process easier.  
The required processes for building a hex image in TCM include:  
Starting TCM  
Defining script properties  
Creating the script for the hex image  
Building the image  
Sending the hex image  
Creating a splash screen  
Flash storage.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
10-4 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Starting Terminal Configuration Manager  
Click the Windows start menu TCM icon (Symbol Windows CE SMDK for Series 9000) to start TCM.  
The TCM window appears displaying two child windows: Script1 and File Explorer. The Script1  
window contains a newly created script and the File Explorer window contains a file explorer view  
used for selecting files to be placed in the script.  
Figure 10-1. TCM Startup Window  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Mobile Computer Configuration  
10-5  
The following table lists the components of the TCM window.  
Table 10-1. TCM Components  
Icon  
Component  
Script Window  
Function  
Displays the files to be used in the creation of the partition(s).  
Used to select the files to be added to the script.  
Create a new script file.  
File Explorer Window  
Create button  
Open button  
Open an existing script file.  
Save button  
Save the current script file.  
Large icons button  
Small icons button  
List button  
View the current script items as large icon.  
View the current script items as small icon.  
View the current script items as a list.  
View the current script items with more details.  
Display version information for TCM.  
Details button  
About button  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
10-6 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Table 10-1. TCM Components (Continued)  
Icon  
Component  
Function  
Properties button  
View/change the current script properties.  
Build button  
Check button  
Send button  
Tile button  
Build the current script into a set of hex files.  
Check the script for errors (files not found).  
Download the hex image to the terminal.  
Arrange the sub-windows in a tiled orientation.  
Build and Send  
Build the current script into a set of hex images and send the hex  
images to the mobile computer.  
Preferences button  
View/change the global TCM options.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Mobile Computer Configuration  
10-7  
Defining Script Properties  
Before a script is created, the script properties must be defined. This defines the type of terminal,  
flash type, number of disks being created and the memory configuration of each disk partition.  
To define the script properties:  
1. Select the Script window to make it active.  
2. Click the Properties button. The Script Properties window - Partition Data tab appears.  
Figure 10-2. Script Properties Window - Partition Data Tab  
3. In the Terminal drop-down list, the MC9000w v1.0 64M entry is already selected.  
4. Use the default Flash Type.  
5. In the Disks drop-down list, select the number of disk partitions to create.  
6. Select the (memory) Size for each partition. Note that adding space to one disk. partition  
subtracts it from another.  
7. In the Access drop-down list for each disk partition, determine and select the Read/Write  
access option.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
10-8 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
8. Click the Options tab. The Script Properties window - Options tab appears.  
Figure 10-3. Script Properties Window - Options Tab  
9. Set the paths for the Script File, Flash File and Hex File Build.  
10. Click OK.  
Creating the Script for the Hex Image  
On start-up, TCM displays the TCM window with the Script1 window and File Explorer window  
pointing to the following directory:  
\Program Files\Symbol Device Configuration Packages\MC9000w\v0.1\TCMScripts\  
The Script1 window directory pane displays two partitions: Platform and Application. Depending on  
the type of flash chip, the number of partitions may change. Files can be added to each of the  
partitions. TCM functionality includes:  
Opening a new or existing script file  
Copying components to the script window  
Saving the script file.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Mobile Computer Configuration  
10-9  
Opening a New or Existing Script  
A script file can be created from scratch or based on an existing script file. Click Create to create a  
new script or click Open to open an existing script (for example, a script provided in the Series 9000  
SMDK). If an existing script is opened and changes are made, saving the changes overwrites the  
original script. To use an original or Symbol supplied standard script as a base and save the changes  
in a new script, use the Save As function to save the script using a different file name.  
Updating TCM 1.X Scripts  
Script files that were created with older versions of TCM can be upgraded to TCM 2.0 scripts. Click  
Open to open an existing script created with an older version of TCM. The Conversion window  
appears automatically.  
Figure 10-4. Conversion Window - Upgrading to TCM 2.0  
Copying Components to the Script  
Script contents are managed using standard file operations such as New Folder, Delete and Rename.  
Items can be added to the script by clicking files and folders in the File Explorer window and dragging  
them to the Script window. The File Explorer window supports standard windows; multiple files may  
be selected by clicking while holding the SHIFT or CTRL keys.  
Saving the Script  
Modifications to a script file can be saved using the Save or the Save As function. Saving changes to  
an existing script writes over the original script. To use a Symbol-supplied standard script as a base  
and save the changes in a new script, use the Save As function.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
10-10 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Building the Image  
Once the script is created, the hex image defined by the script can be built.  
As part of the build, TCM performs a check on the script which verifies that all files referenced in the  
script exist. This check is important for previously created scripts to ensure that files referenced in  
the script are still in the designated locations.  
To build scripts:  
1. Click Build on the TCM toolbar. The Configure Build window appears.  
Figure 10-5. Configure Build Window  
2. Select the items (partitions) to build using the check box(es) to the left of each named  
partition.  
3. The Build Path defines where to store all built partitions.  
4. Select (hex image) COMPRESSION to reduce the size and speed up the download.  
5. Click OK and follow the on-screen instructions.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Mobile Computer Configuration  
10-11  
If one of the partitions being built is the ESSID, a prompt appears requesting the ESSID  
value. Deselect the HR (High Rate) check box when building ESSID images for a device with  
an FH radio.  
Figure 10-6. Build ESSID Partition Window  
If one of the partitions being built is the Splash Screen, a prompt appears requesting both  
the source Bitmap file and the destination HEX file.  
6. A check is performed and if there are no errors, the partition hex files are created.  
If the build fails, the hex files are not be created and TCM displays an error message. Two of the most  
common reasons for a build failure are:  
Files defined in the script can not be found. This error can occur when the files referenced  
by the script are no longer stored on the development computer or the folders where they  
are stored were renamed.  
The total amount of flash memory space required by the script exceeds the image size. To  
correct this, reduce the number of files in the partition or increase the size of the partition.  
See Defining Script Properties on page 10-7 for more information about setting the image  
size appropriately.  
Sending the Hex Image  
Once the hex file is built, it can be downloaded to the mobile computer.  
To load the hex files on to the mobile computer:  
1. For downloads using a serial connection, connect the mobile computer to the development  
computer using the Single Slot Serial/USB cradle or CAM.  
2. Press and hold the left scan button and the Power button simultaneously until the mobile  
computer resets into IPL.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
10-12 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
The mobile computer must be inserted in the cradle or attached to the CAM,  
both with their appropriate power supplies connected to a power source, for  
the mobile computer to reset into IPL.  
3. When the Initial Program Loader menu appears, release the scan and Power buttons.  
Initial Program Loader  
Platform  
Application  
PRIMFIRM  
SECFIRM  
ESSID  
Config Block  
Windows CE  
Monitor  
Splash Screen  
Power Micro  
Partition Table  
System Reset  
Auto Select  
Figure 10-7. Initial Program Loader (IPL) Menu  
To ensure a successful download, do not remove power from the mobile  
computer while in IPL mode.  
4. Choose Auto Select or use the up and down scroll buttons to select the partition to  
download, then press Enter.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Mobile Computer Configuration  
10-13  
Table 10-2. IPL Menu Partitions  
Partition Name  
Platform  
Description  
Contains the files in the Platform folder.  
Contains the files in the Application folder.  
Application  
PRIMFIRM  
Contains the primary radio firmware for the Spectrum24 HR radio card.  
Note: These partitions must be loaded to use wireless downloads through IPL with the HR  
radio. They are only used by IPL and are not required by the Operating System or the S24 FH  
radios.  
SECFIRM  
ESSID  
Contains the secondary radio firmware for the Spectrum24 HR radio card.  
Note: These partitions must be loaded to use wireless downloads through IPL with the HR  
radio. They are only used by IPL and are not required by the Operating System or the S24 FH  
radios.  
Identifies the ESSID, used for wireless downloads.  
Note: This partition specifies the ESSID to be used for IPL downloads via all S24 radios. If the  
partition is not present, then an ESSID of 101 is assumed. This partition is only used by IPL and  
is not required by the Operating System.  
Config Block  
Contains information to correctly configure the Operating System for the mobile computer. This  
information is loaded by the manufacturer.  
Note: Great care should be taken to ensure that an incorrect config block is not loaded into the  
mobile computer. Loading an incorrect config block prevents the correct operation of the  
computer.  
Windows CE  
Monitor  
Contains the operating system for the mobile computer.  
Contains the Monitor and IPL programs.  
Splash Screen  
Contains the splash screen that displays while booting the mobile computer.  
Note: Splash screens are generated from .bmp images and must be less than or equal to 240  
pixels wide and 296 pixels deep. For mono displays, the bmp image must be 4 bpp and for color  
screens the color depth must be 8 bpp. Note: 8 bits per pixel only applies to splash screen  
images. Once Windows CE is running, the color density is 16 bits per pixel.  
Power Micro  
The Power Micro is a small computer contained within the mobile computer that controls  
several system resources. In the unlikely event that the Power Micro Firmware needs updating,  
selecting this item allows the device to be programmed.  
Partition Table  
Contains the partition information for all other partitions.  
Note: The partition table should never need changing unless the sizes of the platform and  
application images are changed within TCM. If this is done, then the new partition table should  
be loaded first, followed by both platform and application in any order.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
10-14 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Table 10-2. IPL Menu Partitions (Continued)  
Partition Name  
System Reset  
Auto Select  
Description  
Selecting this item provides a simple method to exit IPL and to boot the operating system.  
Selecting this item allows one or more files to be downloaded without having to manually  
select the destination. (The content of the files being downloaded automatically directs the file  
to the correct destination.) For technical reasons, Auto Select cannot be used to download  
Monitor, Power Micro, or Partition Table. These items must be specifically selected.  
If the platform or application partition sizes are changed, a new partition  
table must be downloaded first.  
5. IPL displays the Select Transport menu which lists the available methods of downloading the  
file.  
Select Transport  
Wireless - S24 DS  
Serial  
Previous  
Top  
Figure 10-8. Select Transport Menu  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Mobile Computer Configuration  
10-15  
If the mobile computer does not have a radio, then the WirelessS24XX  
selection is not available on the Transport menu.  
6. Use the up and down scroll buttons to select the method of transport, then press Enter.  
7. If the Serial transport method is selected, the Baud Rate Menu appears.  
Baud Rate Menu  
115200  
57600  
38400  
19200  
9600  
Previous  
Top  
Figure 10-9. Baud Rate Menu  
8. Use the up and down scroll buttons to select the appropriate baud rate, then press Enter.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
10-16 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
9. If the Wireless S24XX transport method was selected, the Address Configuration menu  
appears.  
Address Configuration  
“DHCP”  
Previous  
Top  
Figure 10-10. Address Configuration Menu  
For wireless downloads, the ESSID must be loaded via serial before Wireless  
S24 DS can be used. The PC running TCM must be on the same network as  
the terminal and the ESSID partition must be loaded with the correct ESSID.  
10. Use the up and down scroll buttons to select DHCP, then press Enter.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Mobile Computer Configuration  
10-17  
11. The Download File? menu appears.  
Download File?  
Download  
Cancel  
Show Parms  
Previous  
Top  
Figure 10-11. Download File? Menu  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
10-18 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
12. Use the up and down scroll buttons to select Show Parms to verify the file to download.  
Press Enter to display the Parameters screen.  
Downloading:  
"Partition Name"  
via  
"Device Parameters"  
Waiting for input...  
Figure 10-12. Parameters Screen  
Partition Name is the name of the partition selected in the Initial Program Loader menu.  
Device Parameters is the device selected in the Select Transport menu with the baud rate  
for serial downloads, or DHCP address for wireless downloads.  
13. Press Enter to return to the Download File? menu.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Mobile Computer Configuration  
10-19  
14. Use the up and down scroll buttons to select Download. Press Enter. The Downloading  
screen appears.  
Downloading:  
“Partition Name”  
via  
Device Parameters  
Waiting for input  
“Partion Name”  
####________20%  
Figure 10-13. Downloading Screen  
Before the download starts, if Serial was selected in the Select Transport menu, Waiting for  
Data appears in the Device Status field. If Wireless S24 DS was selected in the Select  
Transport menu, the IP address appears in the Device Status field.  
Downloading:  
“Partition Name”  
via “Device Parameters”  
Result was: Success!  
Press any key to continue  
Figure 10-14. Downloading Complete Screen  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
10-20 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
15. On the development computer, click Load on the TCM toolbar. The Load Terminal window -  
Serial tab appears.  
Figure 10-15. Load Terminal Window - Serial and Ethernet Tabs  
16. For Serial port connections, click the Serial tab and select the Image Files To Load, Comm  
Port and Baud Rate from their respective drop-down lists.  
For Wireless connections, click the Ethernet tab. A list of available devices and their IP  
addresses appear. Only those devices placed into the Wireless transport mode of IPL appear  
in this dialog. Select the files to download and the device to receive the files. To load a  
device, the status must be "Active."  
17. Click Download to begin the operation.  
18. During download, the Downloading screen on mobile computer displays the Device Status  
and a progress bar.  
19. When complete, Device Status displays Result was Success, or in the case of an error, the  
cause of the error.  
20. On completion, press Enter to return to the IPL menu to select the next partition to  
download.  
21. To exit IPL, select the System Reset item from the IPL menu (see Figure 10-7 on page 10-12).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Mobile Computer Configuration  
10-21  
TCM Error Messages  
TCM validates the cells in the partition table when the Execute button is clicked. Cells highlighted in  
red contain an error. Partition loading is disabled until all errors are corrected.  
Table 10-3. TCM Error Messages  
Error  
Description/Solution  
Failed to build images: flash file TCM could not load the DLL required to build images for the targeting flash file  
system DLL not loaded!  
Failure finding directory xxx  
Failure creating volume  
system. Reinstall TCM or recover the DLL.  
Building process failed because directory xxx was not found.  
Building process failed because a certain disk volume could not be created.  
Build process failed because TCM failed to add a certain system file to the disk image.  
Failure adding system file to  
image  
INVALID PATH  
The path for the image file to build is not valid.  
Nothing Selected To Build  
Illegal ESS ID  
In the Config Build window, no item is selected to build.  
In the Build ESSID Partition window, no ESS ID was entered or the ESS ID entered was  
illegal.  
Disk Full  
TCM failed to create Hex image file at the selected path. Check available disk space.  
Target Disk Full  
Build process failed because TCM failed to add file to the image of a disk volume.  
Remove some files or increase the disk size.  
Hex file is READ ONLY  
The Hex image file to be created exists and is read-only. Delete the existing file or  
change its attribute.  
Error opening the file xxx with  
write access  
TCM could not open file xxx with write access. Check if file is in use.  
Failure creating binary file  
TCM failed to open/create an intermediate binary file.  
Hex File To load is missing or  
invalid  
In Load Terminal window, the file selected to load has invalid status.  
Could not locate terminal name in While loading the Script Properties window, TCM could not find the TCM.ini section  
TCM.ini file  
corresponding to the terminal type specified by the current opening script. Either  
TCM.ini or the script file is invalid.  
Incorrect disk sizes in TCM.ini file The total disk size specified in the script does not match the total disk size defined in  
the corresponding TCM.ini section. Check if the script is corrupt or the TCM.ini has  
changed after the script was created.  
INVALID DIRECTORY  
In Script Properties window, the selected System File Path is not a valid directory.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
10-22 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Table 10-3. TCM Error Messages (Continued)  
Error  
Description/Solution  
One of the disk sizes is one sector In Script Properties window, one of the disks is too small (one sector in size). This may  
in size  
cause problem while building images, especially when cushion is enabled. Increase  
the disk size.  
INVALID VOLUME NAME  
In Script Properties window, one of the volume labels is not valid.  
Corrupt TCM.INI file! (Invalid  
value of VolumeDivisor)  
The VolumeDivisor entry is missing or invalid in the TCM.ini. Reinstall TCM or recover  
TCM.ini.  
Invalid version of TCM script file The TCM script was not created by this version of TCM.  
Corrupt or missing TCM.ini file  
TCM could not find TCM.ini file.  
FAILED CONNECTION TO COM  
PORT (Could not get status)  
While downloading images to terminal, TCM failed to connect to the selected COM  
port. Check if the COM port is free and is properly configured.  
FAILED CONNECTION TO  
TERMINAL (Terminal Not  
While downloading images, TCM failed to connect to the terminal. Check if the  
correct flow control protocol is selected and the terminal is properly connected and is  
Connected Properly/Terminal Not in a listening state.  
Ready to Receive)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Mobile Computer Configuration  
10-23  
IPL Error Detection  
While receiving data, IPL performs many checks on the data to ensure that the data is received  
correctly. If an error is detected, IPL immediately aborts the download, and reports the error on an  
error screen.  
Error screens may vary depending on the action being performed. A sample error screen may look like  
the screen pictured below:  
Downloading:  
Platform  
via Serial Port 115200  
Error # -2 : Messages:  
Cancelled by user  
Press any key to continue  
Figure 10-16. IPL Error Screen  
This error message screen displays until a key is pressed. Once the screen is acknowledged, IPL  
returns to the Initial Program Loader main menu to wait for a new selection.  
To find the probable cause of the error, use the error number and/or the error text displayed on the  
screen to look up the error in Table 10-4.  
.
Table 10-4. IPL Errors  
Error Text  
Unknown error  
Error Number  
Probable Cause  
-1  
A general error occurred. Retry the download. If the  
failure persists, it is most likely due to a hardware  
failure; the terminal requires servicing.  
Cancelled by user  
-2  
The user cancelled the download.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
10-24 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Table 10-4. IPL Errors (Continued)  
Error Text  
Error Number  
Probable Cause  
Can't open the source  
-7  
An error occurred opening the source device (either  
radio card or Serial port). Check source device  
connectivity and retry.  
Can't open the destination  
-8  
An error occurred opening the destination device  
(either flash ROM or Power Micro). Retry the  
download. If the failure persists, it is most likely due  
to a hardware failure; the terminal requires servicing.  
Can't read from the source device  
-9  
The source device (either radio card or Serial port)  
could not be read from. Check source device  
connectivity and retry.  
Can't write to the destination  
device  
-10  
The destination device (either flash ROM or Power  
Micro) could not be written to. Retry the download. If  
the failure persists, it is most likely due to a hardware  
failure; the terminal requires servicing.  
Transmission checksum error  
Readback checksum error  
-11  
-12  
-14  
An error occurred during transmission from the source  
device (either radio card or Serial port) and the  
checksum check failed. Check source device  
connectivity and retry.  
A checksum, generated from reading back data that  
was written to the destination device, was incorrect.  
An error during transmission or a write error to the  
destination device could cause this.  
There is no more heap space  
available  
There is no more heap space available for the  
download procedure. Restart IPL and retry the  
download. If the failure persists, contact service with  
details of what is being downloaded.  
Insufficient data available to  
complete record  
-21  
-23  
-24  
A Symbol HEX file download was attempted but the  
HEX file is invalid. Ensure the file is in Symbol HEX file  
format.  
Invalid Symbol HEX file  
A Symbol HEX file download was attempted but the  
HEX file is invalid. Ensure the file is in Symbol HEX file  
format.  
Unrecognized or unsupported HEX  
record  
The Symbol HEX file being downloaded contains an  
invalid or unrecognized HEX record. Ensure the file is  
in proper Symbol HEX file format.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Mobile Computer Configuration  
10-25  
Table 10-4. IPL Errors (Continued)  
Error Text  
Error Number  
Probable Cause  
Invalid data in HEX file  
-25  
The Symbol HEX file being downloaded contains  
invalid data. Ensure the file is in proper Symbol HEX  
file format with valid HEX data.  
Exceeded max size  
-26  
-27  
-28  
The download file is too large to fit into the space  
allocated for it. Either make the file smaller or increase  
the space allocated for it by altering the partition  
table.  
Partition is not valid on this device  
Wrong destination code  
The downloaded file specifies a partition entry that  
does not exist on the device. Only download files that  
are valid for this device, or change the partition table  
so that the new file is valid on the device.  
A specific partition was chosen from the Main Menu  
(not Auto Select) but the file selected for download  
was for another partition. Ensure that the partition  
selected from the Main Menu matches the file  
selected for download.  
File type does not support IPL Auto  
Select  
-29  
-30  
-31  
-32  
-33  
-34  
Monitor, Power Micro and Partition Table cannot be  
loaded with Auto Select. Select the appropriate area,  
and try again.  
Non-contiguous record found  
Timed Out - No data  
Fail: Buffer Overrun  
A Symbol HEX file download was attempted but the  
HEX file is invalid. Ensure the file is in Symbol HEX file  
format.  
IPL was waiting for data from the source device but  
timed out before receiving any. Check the source  
device connectivity and retry.  
The serial port device could not keep up with incoming  
data. Retry the serial download with a lower baud  
rate.  
Partition Table not Valid  
Invalid file format  
The size of flash memory is different than that  
described in the partition table. Retry the download  
with the correct partition table file.  
The file format is invalid. Only Symbol HEX files are  
supported by IPL.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
10-26 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Creating a Splash Screen  
The source bitmap files used to create the default splash screens for the mobile computer are  
supplied with the Series 9000 SMDK. These files can be modified using any of the standard windows  
image editors, allowing customization for particular customers.  
To create a custom splash screen, perform the following steps:  
1. For mobile computers with monochrome screens, open the Splashmono.bmp file supplied  
with the Series 9000 SMDK using an image editor.  
2. For mobile computers with color screens, open the Splashcolor.bmp file supplied with the  
Series 9000 SMDK using an image editor.  
3. Modify the bitmap file and save.  
4. Create a splash partition using the steps shown in the Building the Image on page 10-10.  
Splash Screen Format  
If the default files are not used to create the new splash screens, be sure to preserve the image  
format. The formats are as follows:  
Table 10-5. Splash Screen Format  
Screen Type  
Monochrome  
Color  
Dimensions  
240x296  
240x296  
Color Format  
4 bits per pixel  
8 bits per pixel*  
* 8 bits per pixel only applies to splash screen images. Once Windows CE  
is running, the color density is 16 bits per pixel.  
See Sending the Hex Image on page 10-11 for information about loading the splash screen using TCM  
and IPL.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Mobile Computer Configuration  
10-27  
Flash Storage  
In addition to the RAM-based storage standard on Windows CE terminals, the mobile computer is  
also equipped with a non-volatile Flash-based storage area which can store data (partitions) that can  
not be corrupted by a cold boot. This Flash area is divided into two categories: Flash File System (FFS)  
Partitions and Non-FFS Partitions.  
FFS Partitions  
The mobile computer includes two FFS partitions. These partitions appear to the mobile computer as  
a hard drive that the OS file system can write files to and read files from. Data is retained even if  
power is removed.  
The two FFS partitions appear as two separate folders in the Windows CE file system and are as  
follows:  
Platform: The Platform FFS partition contains Symbol-supplied programs and Dynamic Link  
Libraries (DLLs). This FFS is configured to include DLLs that control system operation. Since  
these drivers are required for basic mobile computer operation, only experienced users  
should modify the content of this partition.  
Application: The Application FFS partition is used to store application programs needed to  
operate the mobile computer.  
Working with FFS Partitions  
Because the FFS partitions appear as folders under the Windows CE file system, they can be written  
to and read like any other folder. For example, an application program can write data to a file located  
in the Application folder just as it would to the Windows folder. However, the file in the Application  
folder is in non-volatile storage and is not lost on a cold boot (e.g., when power is removed for a long  
period of time).  
Standard tools such as ActiveSync can be used to copy files to and from the FFS partitions. They  
appear as the “Application” and “Platform” folders to the ActiveSync explorer. This is useful when  
installing applications on the mobile computer. Applications stored in the Application folder are  
retained even when the mobile computer is cold booted, just as the Demo 9000 program is retained  
in memory.  
There are two device drivers included in the Windows CE image to assist developers in configuring  
the mobile computer following a cold boot: RegMerge and CopyFiles.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
10-28 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
RegMerge.dll  
RegMerge.dll is a built-in driver that allows registry edits to be made to the Windows CE Registry.  
Regmerge.dll runs very early in the boot process and looks for registry files (.reg files) in certain Flash  
File System folders during a cold boot. It then merges the registry changes into the system registry  
located in RAM.  
Since the registry is re-created on every cold boot from the default ROM image, the RegMerge driver  
is necessary to make registry modifications persistent over cold boots.  
RegMerge is configured to look in the root of two specific folders for .reg files in the following order:  
\Platform  
\Application  
Regmerge continues to look for .reg files in these folders until all folders are checked. This allows  
folders later in the list to override folders earlier in the list. This way, it is possible to override Registry  
changes made by the Platforms partitions folders. Take care when using Regmerge to make Registry  
changes. The Series 9000 SMDK contains examples of .reg files.  
Regmerge only merges the .reg files on cold boots. The merge process is  
skipped during a warm boot.  
Typically, do not make modifications to registry values for drivers loaded before RegMerge. However,  
these values may require modification during software development. Since these early loading  
drivers read these keys before RegMerge gets a chance to change them, the mobile computer must  
be cold booted. The warm boot does not re-initialize the registry and the early loading driver reads  
the new registry values.  
Do not use Regmerge to modify built-in driver registry values, or merge the same Registry value to  
two files in the same folder, as the results are undefined.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Mobile Computer Configuration  
10-29  
CopyFiles  
Windows CE expects certain files to be in the Windows folder, residing in volatile storage. Windows  
CE maintains the System Registry in volatile storage. CopyFiles copies files from one folder to another  
on a cold boot. Files can be copied from a non-volatile partition (Application or Platform) to the  
Windows or other volatile partition during a cold boot. During a cold boot CopyFiles looks for files  
with a .CPY extension in the root of the Platform and Application FFS partitions (Platform first and  
then Application). These files are text files containing the source and destination for the desired files  
to be copied separated by “>”. The following example from the file application.cpy is contained on  
the demo application partition included in the Series 9000 SMDK. It can also be obtained from the  
Symbol web site at http://devzone.symbol.com/.  
Files are copied to the Windows folder from the Flash File System using copy files (*.cpy) in the  
following order:  
\Platform  
\Application  
Example:  
\Application\ScanSamp2.exe>\Windows\ScanSamp2.exe  
This line directs CopyFiles to copy the ScanSamp2.exe application from the \Application folder to the  
\Windows folder.  
Non-FFS Partitions  
Non-FFS Partitions include additional software and data pre-loaded on the mobile computer that can  
be upgraded. Unlike FFS Partitions, these partitions are not visible when the operating system is  
running. They also contain system information. Non-FFS partitions include the following:  
Windows CE: The complete Windows CE operating system is stored on Flash devices. If  
necessary, the entire OS image may be downloaded to the mobile computer using files  
provided by Symbol. The current OS partition on the mobile computer is included as part of  
the TCM installation package. Any upgrades must be obtained from Symbol. This partition  
is mandatory for the mobile computer.  
Splash Screen: a bitmap smaller than 16 Kb (and limited to 8 bits per pixel) is displayed as  
the mobile computer cold boots. To download a customized screen to display, see Creating  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
10-30 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
8 bits per pixel only applies to splash screen images. Once Windows CE is  
running, the color density is 16 bits per pixel.  
IPL: This program interfaces with the host computer and allows downloading via cradle or  
serial cable any or all of the partitions listed above, as well as updated versions of IPL. Use  
caution downloading updated IPL versions; incorrect downloading of an IPL causes  
permanent damage to the mobile computer. IPL is mandatory for the mobile computer.  
Partition Table: Identifies where each partition is loaded in the mobile computer.  
Downloading Partitions to the Terminal  
TCM is used to specify a hex destination file for each partition and download each file to the terminal.  
This download requires a program loader stored on the terminal. The terminal comes with a program  
loading utility, Initial Program Loader (IPL), stored in the terminal's write-protected flash.  
IPL  
IPL allows the user to upgrade the mobile computer with software updates and/or feature  
enhancements.  
Partition Update vs. File Update  
There are two types of update supported by the mobile computer: partitions and files. The file system  
used by the mobile computer is the same as the file system used on a desktop computer. A file is a  
unit of data that can be accessed using a file name and a location in the file system. When a file is  
replaced, only the contents of the previous file are erased. The operating system must be running for  
a file to be updated, so the IPL cannot perform individual file updates as it is a stand-alone program  
that does not require the operating system to be running.  
A typical partition is a group of files, combined into a single "partition" that represents a specific area  
of storage. Examples of partitions are the flash file systems such as Platform or Application. (Using  
the desktop computer comparison, these partitions are roughly equivalent to a C: or D: hard disk  
drive.) In addition to the "hard disk" partitions, some partitions are used for single items such as the  
operating system, monitor, or splash screen. (Again using a desktop computer comparison, these  
partitions are roughly the equivalent of the BIOS or special hidden system files.) When a partition is  
updated, all data that was previously in its storage region is erased - i.e. it is not a merge but rather  
a replacement operation. Typically, the operating system is not running when partitions are update,  
so IPL can perform partition updates.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Mobile Computer Configuration  
10-31  
Partition images for selected partitions can be created by TCM. All partition images suitable for use  
by IPL are in hex file format for transfer by TCM from the development computer to the mobile  
computer.  
Upgrade Requirements  
Upgrade requirements:  
The hex files to be downloaded (on development computer)  
A connection from the host computer and the mobile computer (either serial or wireless)  
TCM (on development computer) to download the files.  
Once these requirements are satisfied, the mobile computer can be upgraded by invoking IPL and  
navigating the menus. See Sending the Hex Image on page 10-11 for procedures on downloading a  
hex file to the mobile computer.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
10-32 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Desktop Emulator  
Chapter Contents  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
11-2 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Desktop Emulator  
11-3  
Introduction  
This chapter provides basic instructions for installing and using the emulator. The emulator provides  
software API emulation of the actual MC9000-K and MC9000-S. The emulator consists of the  
following components:  
System Settings Dialog (SSD)  
Emulator User Interface (emulator skin)  
Simulated External File System (Flash, SD/MMC).  
Software Requirements  
The emulator requires the installation of eMbedded Visual C++ 4.0 and EvC 4.0 service pack 1, before  
the emulator can be installed. To download eMbedded Visual C++ 4.0 go to the Microsoft download  
website: http://www.microsoft.com/downloads/ and enter “eMbedded Visual C++ 4.0” into the  
keyword search parameters. Follow the prompts and download eMbedded Visual C++ 4.0 and EvC 4.0  
service pack 1.  
Installation Procedures  
The emulator is automatically installed as part of the Symbol Windows CE SMDK for Series 9000,  
Starting the Emulator  
The emulator is designed to launch via the SSD. The SSD is accessed from the desktop Start menu  
under the PDT9000 program group.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
11-4 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
1. In the PDT9000 program group, double-click SSD.exe file. The Emulator System Settings  
window appears.  
Figure 11-1. Emulator System Settings Window  
2. Click the Storage tab to set the storage paths:  
\Application - Set Path to:  
C:\Program Files\Windows CE Tools\wce410\PDT9000\Emulation\Flash Partitions\Application  
\Platform - Set Path to:  
C:\Program Files\Windows CE Tools\wce410\PDT9000\Emulation\Flash Partitions\Platform  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Desktop Emulator  
11-5  
Figure 11-2. Emulator Startup Storage Settings  
3. From the Emulator drop-down list, select either:  
PDT9000: Gemini53key for a full view of the mobile computer.  
or  
PDT9000: Gemini53keysplit for a split view of the mobile computer.  
4. The Tool drop down window displays the selected Embedded Visual C++ tool.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
11-6 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Gemini53keysplit, Split View  
Gemini53key, Full View  
Figure 11-3. Emulator View Options  
5. Select the Always on top check box to keep the emulator view on top of all other programs,  
or leave the box unchecked to allow other programs to display on top of the emulator view.  
6. Click Launch to start the emulator.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Desktop Emulator  
11-7  
Emulator Parameter Settings and Displays  
The Emulator System Settings window is divided into three parts, emulator settings, emulator tabs  
and emulator LEDs.  
Emulator Settings  
Emulator Tabs  
Emulator LEDs  
Figure 11-4. Emulator System Settings Window  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
11-8 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Table 11-1. Emulator Window Functions  
Window  
Functions  
Emulator System Settings  
The Emulator drop-down list, used to select either:  
PDT9000: Gemini53key for a full view of the mobile computer.  
or  
PDT9000: Gemini53keysplit for a split view of the mobile computer.  
Launch button, starts the emulator.  
Exit button, exits the emulator.  
Tool drop down window displays the selected Embedded Visual C++ tool.  
Always on Top checkbox.  
Select to keep the Simulator System Settings window on top of other program  
windows.  
Emulator tabs  
LED Indicators  
Provide the Emulator, Storage, Scanner, Spectrum 24, Battery, and Status  
parameter settings and display windows.  
Displays the state (selected or not selected) of the indicators: GREEN, REC, FUNC,  
SHIFT, COMM and POWER.  
A detailed discussion of each of the emulator window tabs settings and displays is provided in the  
following sections:  
Emulator  
Storage  
Scanner  
Spectrum24  
Battery  
Status.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Desktop Emulator  
11-9  
Emulator Tab  
Use the Emulator tab to set the emulator parameters, memory size, launch options and  
communications.  
Figure 11-5. Emulator Tab  
Table 11-2. Emulator Tab Functions  
Setting  
Description  
Memory  
Sets the memory size.  
Stop Action  
Sets the shut down state:  
Turn off emulator - Exits the emulator program.  
Save emulator state - Returns emulator to the same state when re-launched.  
Platform, Application and MMC folders are NOT copied to emulator from the  
desktop hard drive.  
Prompt - Keeps the emulator program running.  
Ethernet  
Select setting: None, Shared, or VirtualSwitch.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
11-10 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Table 11-2. Emulator Tab Functions (Continued)  
Setting  
Description  
Select setting: None, Com1, Com2, or File.  
Select setting: None, Com1, Com2, or File.  
Debug Port  
Emulation COM2  
Storage Tab  
The Emulator Storage settings simulate the storage environment that would be provided by a flash  
file system and MMC. When the emulator starts, the contents of these development computer folders  
are copied to the emulator as separate folders. Once the emulator is running, changes made to the  
desktop folder are not reflected in the emulator folder until the emulator is stopped and launched  
again. Changes made in the emulator folder are not reflected in the desktop folder. These files must  
be captured using remote file viewer.  
The emulator \Application and \Platform storage paths are set when the emulator is started for the  
first time. The \SD-MMC storage path is used to set the SD-MMC path.  
Figure 11-6. Storage Tab  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Desktop Emulator  
11-11  
Scanner Tab  
Use the Scanner tab to allow the user to specify the type of simulated scanning provided by the  
emulator (the emulator does not have an integrated scanner).  
Figure 11-7. Scanner Tab  
Table 11-3. Scanner Tab Functions  
Setting  
Description  
Scanner Options, Manual  
Enter scan data manually to be returned to the scanner  
application.  
Scanner Options, Serial  
Scan data is entered via a serial connection to the specified  
serial port.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
11-12 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Spectrum24 Tab  
Use the Spectrum24 tab to allow the user to modify the simulated characteristics of the Spectrum24  
interface. Both the simulated network card and the access point ESSID2MAC addresses can be  
modified to simulate a specific network environment.  
Figure 11-8. Spectrum24 Tab  
Table 11-4. S24 Tab Functions  
Setting  
Function  
Set the slide bar to represent the signal quality to be simulated.  
Select the simulated date transfer rate, 1MBit, 2MBit, 5.5MBit or 11MBit  
Select the simulation mode.  
Signal Quality  
Link Speed  
Associated and Roamed  
Simulated Access Point  
Enter the simulated ESSID:  
Enter the simulated MAC Address:  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Desktop Emulator  
11-13  
Table 11-4. S24 Tab Functions (Continued)  
Setting  
Function  
Enter the simulated MAC Address:  
Enter the simulated Mfg ID:  
Simulated Trilogy Adapter  
Enter the simulated Model:  
Enter the simulated FW Version:  
Enter the simulated Serial #:  
Battery Tab  
Use the Battery tab to setup the power source to A/C or battery. Battery profiles (life and discharge/  
charge rate) can also be set. Battery status can be modified using the shell icon or using the Windows  
CE battery API calls.  
Figure 11-9. Battery Tab  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
11-14 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Table 11-5. Battery Tab Functions  
Setting  
Function  
Battery Status  
Power Source  
Set the slide bar to represent the simulated remaining battery  
life.  
Select to simulate battery or AC power input.  
Set to simulate battery life.  
Total Battery Life:  
Time to Fully Charge:  
Battery Chemistry  
Set to simulate battery charge time.  
Select to simulate battery type:  
Alkaline, Nickel Cadmium, Nickel Metal Hydride, Lithium Ion,  
Lithium Polymer or Zinc Air  
Voltage (mV)  
Current (mA)  
Temp (.01C)  
Set to simulate battery voltage.  
Set to simulate battery current.  
Set to simulate battery temperature.  
Status Tab  
The Status tab provides a visual indication of backlight, contrast and LEDs. Intensities of backlight  
are indicated by the size of the backlight bar.  
The desktop emulator always displays the emulated terminal screen in color. When  
testing an application targeted for a color terminal, contrast APIs should not be used as  
they are NOT available on actual color terminals.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Desktop Emulator  
11-15  
Figure 11-10. Emulator Status Indications  
Table 11-6. Status Tab Functions  
Setting  
Description  
Backlight - Indicates the BackLight setting.  
Contrast - Indicates the contrast setting.  
Indicates the Key Light setting.  
Display  
Key Light  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
11-16 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Using the Emulator  
Once the Emulator has been launched and is running it functions like the actual terminal, see Starting  
User Inputs  
The Emulator uses both the development computer mouse and the keypad for user inputs.  
Mouse Inputs  
The mouse cursor functions as a the stylus functions in the mobile computer. It can be used for  
selecting items and entering information.  
Click: Right click the mouse once to simulate the stylus screen tap.  
Double-Click: Double click the mouse to simulate the stylus double screen tap. Use double  
click to execute application software.  
Drag: Drag the mouse simulate the stylus screen drag. Use drag across the screen to select  
text and images. Drag in a list to select multiple items.  
Keypad Inputs  
The development computer keypad can also be used for entering data.  
Taskbar  
The Taskbar (at the bottom of the window) displays the Start button, active programs (in this case PC  
Link and Mobile Companion) battery status and the communication status..  
Start Button  
Open Programs and Status Icons  
Desktop  
Menu and Application Buttons  
Keyboard Input Panel  
Figure 11-11. Taskbar  
Start Button  
The Start button is used to launch the Start Menu, see Start Menu on page 11-17.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
               
Desktop Emulator  
11-17  
AC Power/Battery Status Icons  
AC Power/Battery Status icons are shown in the taskbar to indicate present power supply status.  
They appear and function the same as in the mobile computer, see AC Power/Battery Status Icons on  
Taskbar Icons and Buttons  
The Taskbar icons and buttons are displayed in the taskbar. They appear and function the same as in  
Open Programs  
If more than program is open, the taskbar icons can be used to toggle between the open programs  
(applications). Tapping on a icon opens the associated program. These icons only appear if a program  
is open.  
Main Menu  
On Emulator power up, the Main Menu window appears and functions the same as in the mobile  
Start Menu  
On Emulator power up, the Main Menu window appears. The Start button functions the same as in  
the mobile computer, see Series 9000 Demo Window on page 3-39.  
Exiting the Emulator  
The emulator may be exited in one of two ways:  
Press the “Stop Emulation” button on the SSD.  
Press the red Power button and select the “Stop Emulation Button” to turn the emulator off.  
In either case two additional exit states are provided:  
Turn off emulator (re-initiate Emulator on next start)  
Copies all files form the desktop flash file system and restarts the emulator.  
Save emulator state (restore previous state on next start)  
Restores the last Emulator state.  
To restart the emulator see Starting the Emulator on page 11-3.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                     
11-18 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Resetting the Emulator  
The emulator does not support a the reset function. Warm and cold boots cannot be performed on the  
emulator.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Troubleshooting  
Chapter Contents  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
12-2 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance and Troubleshooting  
12-3  
Introduction  
This chapter includes instructions on cleaning and storing the mobile computer and provides  
troubleshooting solutions for potential problems during mobile computer operating.  
Maintaining the Mobile Computer  
For trouble-free service, observe the following tips when using the mobile computer:  
Take care not to scratch the screen of the mobile computer. When working with the mobile  
computer, use the supplied stylus or plastic-tipped pens intended for use with a touch-  
sensitive screen. Never use an actual pen or pencil or other sharp object on the surface of  
the screen.  
Although the mobile computer is water and dust resistant, do not expose it to rain or  
moisture for an extended period of time.  
The touch-sensitive screen of the mobile computer contains glass. Take care not to drop the  
mobile computer or subject it to strong impact.  
Protect the mobile computer from temperature extremes. Do not leave it on the dashboard  
of a car on a hot day and keep it away from heat sources.  
Do not store or use the mobile computer in any location that is extremely dusty, damp or wet.  
Use a soft lens cloth to clean the mobile computer. If the surface of the screen becomes  
soiled, clean it with a soft cloth moistened with a diluted window-cleaning solution.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
12-4 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Troubleshooting  
Table 12-1. Troubleshooting the Mobile Computer  
Problem  
Cause  
Solution  
Mobile computer does not turn Lithium-ion battery not  
Charge or replace the lithium-ion battery in the mobile  
computer.  
on.  
charged.  
Lithium-ion battery not  
installed properly.  
Ensure battery is installed properly. See Main Battery  
System crash.  
Perform a warm boot. If the mobile computer still does  
not turn on, perform a cold boot. See Resetting the  
Rechargeable lithium-ion battery Battery failed.  
did not charge.  
Replace battery. If the mobile computer still does not  
operate, try a warm boot, then a cold boot. See  
Mobile computer removed  
Insert mobile computer in cradle and begin charging.  
from cradle while battery was The lithium-ion battery requires about four hours to  
charging. recharge fully.  
Cannot see characters on display. Mobile computer not powered Press the Power button.  
on.  
During data communication, no Mobile computer removed  
Replace the mobile computer in the cradle, or reattach  
data was transmitted, or  
transmitted data was  
incomplete.  
from cradle or unplugged from the Synchronization cable and re-transmit.  
host computer during  
communication.  
Incorrect cable configuration. See the System Administrator.  
Communication software was Perform setup. See Chapter 4, Communications for  
incorrectly installed or  
configured.  
details.  
No sound is audible.  
Volume setting is low or  
turned off.  
Unit may be a beeper only unit or incorrect Config  
Block is programmed into device.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Maintenance and Troubleshooting  
12-5  
Table 12-1. Troubleshooting the Mobile Computer (Continued)  
Problem  
Cause  
Solution  
Mobile computer turns itself off. Mobile computer is inactive. The mobile computer turns off after a period of  
inactivity. If the mobile computer is running on battery  
power, this period can be set from 1 to 5 minutes, in  
one-minute intervals. If the mobile computer is  
running on external power, this period can be set to 1,  
2, 5, 10, 15 and 30 minutes.  
Battery is depleted.  
Replace the battery.  
Battery is not inserted  
properly.  
Insert the battery properly, see Figure 1-4 on page 1-9.  
Tapping the window buttons or LCD screen not aligned  
Re-calibrate the screen. See Figure on page 1-18.  
icons does not activate the  
corresponding feature.  
correctly.  
The system is hung.  
Warm boot the system. To perform a warm boot, see  
A message appears stating that Too many files stored on the Delete unused memos and records. Save these  
the mobile computer memory is mobile computer.  
full.  
records on the host computer.  
Too many applications  
installed on the mobile  
computer.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
12-6 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Table 12-1. Troubleshooting the Mobile Computer (Continued)  
Problem  
Cause  
Solution  
The mobile computer does not  
accept scan input.  
Scanning application is not  
loaded.  
Verify that the unit is loaded with a scanning  
application. See the System Administrator.  
Unreadable bar code.  
Ensure the symbol is not defaced.  
Distance between exit  
window and bar code is  
incorrect.  
Ensure mobile computer is within proper scanning  
range.  
Mobile computer is not  
Ensure the mobile computer is programmed to accept  
programmed for the bar code. the type of bar code being scanned.  
Mobile computer is not  
programmed to generate a  
beep.  
If a beep on a good decode is expected and a beep is  
not heard, check that the application is set to  
generate a beep on good decode.  
Battery is low.  
If the scanner stops emitting a laser beam when the  
scan button is pressed, check the battery level. When  
the battery is low, the scanner shuts off before the  
mobile computer low battery condition notification.  
Note: If the scanner is still not reading symbols,  
contact the distributor or Symbol Technologies.  
If, after performing these checks, the mobile computer is still not reading  
symbols, contact the distributor or Symbol Technologies.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance and Troubleshooting  
12-7  
Four Slot Charge Only Cradle  
Table 12-2. Troubleshooting the Four Slot Charge Only Cradle  
Problem  
Cause  
Solution  
Mobile computer charge  
indicator LED does not light.  
Cradle is not receiving power.  
Ensure the power supply is securely connected and  
receiving power.  
Mobile computer is not seated  
correctly in the cradle.  
Ensure the battery is properly installed in the mobile  
computer, and re-seat the mobile computer in the  
cradle.  
The battery is not properly  
installed in the mobile computer.  
The battery in the mobile  
computer is faulty.  
Verify that other batteries charge properly. If so,  
replace the faulty battery.  
Note: The Four Slot Charge Only Cradle has no power indication.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
12-8 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Four Slot Ethernet Cradle  
Table 12-3. Troubleshooting the Four Slot Ethernet Cradle  
Symptom  
Cause  
Solution  
Attempt by the mobile computer Mobile computer removed from Wait one minute and reinsert the mobile computer in  
to ActiveSync failed.  
the cradle while the LED was  
blinking green.  
the cradle. This allows the cradle to attempt another  
synchronization.  
ActiveSync on the host  
Wait one minute and reinsert the mobile computer in  
computer has not yet closed the the cradle. This allows the cradle to attempt another  
previous ActiveSync session.  
synchronization.  
Incorrect cable configuration.  
Check your DHCP server and determine which IP  
address was allocated to the cradle, then check  
connectivity by pinging the cradle.  
Communications software  
improperly configured.  
Perform setup as described in Chapter 4,  
Communications. Check your DHCP server and  
determine which IP address was allocated to the  
mobile computer slot, then check connectivity by  
pinging the cradle.  
Mobile computer ActiveSync  
disabled or not configured to  
accept network connection.  
On the mobile computer, tap Start - ActiveSync -  
Tools - Options - Options button. Then, uncheck the  
Enable PC sync using this connection: check box.  
Host ActiveSync disabled or not On the mobile computer, tap Start - Settings and  
configured to accept network  
connection.  
double tap the Network and Dial-up Connections  
icon. Edit an existing connection or create a new  
connection that is configured to accept the network  
connection.  
During communications, no data Mobile computer removed from Replace mobile computer in cradle and retransmit.  
was transmitted, or transmitted cradle during communications.  
data was incomplete.  
Mobile computer has no active An icon will be visible in the status bar if a  
connection.  
connection is currently active.  
Mobile computer has  
Data is being transferred over Temporarily disable the radio link to force data  
successfully connected through the S24 radio link.  
the cradle, but no data is being  
transmitted over the  
transmission through the cradle. Tap the wireless  
LAN icon and tap WLAN Profiles from the menu.  
Tap the Mode tab. Enter an in-valid value in the  
ESSID: text box and tap the OK button. Verify that the  
radio link has been disabled. Once the data  
transmission has been completed, re-enable the  
radio link.  
connection.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Troubleshooting  
12-9  
Table 12-3. Troubleshooting the Four Slot Ethernet Cradle (Continued)  
Symptom  
Cause  
Solution  
All Communication Status LEDs The unit could not configure  
Connect the unit to an Ethernet network with a  
are flashing red.  
itself, or it has lost the lease on correctly functioning DHCP server.  
its IP address.  
Failed automatic cradle  
configuration via local DHCP  
service.  
Connect a properly configured DHCP server or DHCP  
relay agent to the subnet, and power cycle the cradle.  
Check the DHCP server log to verify that the cradle is  
receiving a response to its DHCP request.  
The Ethernet link may be down. Ensure the ethernet cable is connected to an active  
hub.  
Communication Status LED  
does not light up.  
Mobile computer has been  
inserted incorrectly into the  
cradle.  
Remove, wait a minute, and then reinsert the mobile  
computer, ensuring it fits snugly onto the connector  
at the bottom of the cradle.  
Cradle is not receiving power.  
Ensure the power supply is securely connected and  
receiving power.  
Battery is not recharging.  
Mobile computer removed from Replace the mobile computer into the cradle. It can  
the cradle too soon.  
take up to 4 hours to recharge a completely depleted  
battery pack if mobile computer is suspended or  
longer if the mobile computer is on. Tap Start -  
Settings - System - Power to view battery status.  
Battery is faulty.  
Verify that other batteries charge properly. If so,  
replace the faulty battery.  
Mobile computer is not inserted Remove the mobile computer and reinsert it correctly.  
correctly into the cradle.  
Verify charging is active. Tap Start - Settings - System  
- Power to view battery status.  
Warning Message - “! Unable to This message occurs if a  
obtain a server assigned IP suspend/resume cycle is  
address. Try again later or enter performed and the mobile  
Tap OK to close the message. The mobile computer  
will obtain address information and communicate  
through the ethernet cradle.  
an IP address in Network  
Settings.”  
computer radio is not  
associated (e.g. due to being out  
of range)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
12-10 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Four Slot Spare Battery Charger  
Table 12-4. Troubleshooting The Four Slot Spare Battery Charger  
Symptom  
Possible Cause  
Action  
Batteries not charging. Battery was removed from the  
Ensure MSR is receiving power. Ensure mobile computer is  
charger or charger was unplugged attached correctly. Confirm main battery is charging under  
from AC power too soon.  
Battery is faulty.  
Start - Settings - System - Power. If a mobile computer  
battery is fully depleted, it can take up to four hours to fully  
recharge a battery (if the mobile computer is off and longer  
if the mobile computer is operating).  
Verify that other batteries charge properly. If so, replace  
the faulty battery.  
Battery contacts not connected to Verify that the battery is seated in the battery well  
charger.  
correctly with the contacts facing down.  
Single Slot Serial/USB Cradle  
Table 12-5. Troubleshooting the Single Slot Serial/USB Cradle  
Symptom  
Possible Cause  
Action  
LEDs do not light when Cradle is not receiving power.  
mobile computer or  
Ensure the power cable is connected securely to both the  
cradle and to AC power.  
spare battery is  
Mobile computer is not seated  
inserted.  
Remove and re-insert the mobile computer into the cradle,  
ensuring it is firmly seated.  
firmly in the cradle.  
Spare battery is not seated firmly in Remove and re-insert the spare battery into the charging  
the cradle.  
slot, ensuring it is firmly seated.  
Mobile computer  
Mobile computer was removed  
Ensure cradle is receiving power. Ensure mobile computer  
is seated correctly. Confirm main battery is charging under  
Start - Settings - System - Power. If a mobile computer  
battery is fully depleted, it can take up to four hours to fully  
recharge a battery (if the mobile computer is off and longer  
if the mobile computer is operating).  
battery is not charging. from cradle or cradle was  
unplugged from AC power too  
soon.  
Battery is faulty.  
Verify that other batteries charge properly. If so, replace  
the faulty battery.  
The mobile computer is not fully  
seated in the cradle.  
Remove and re-insert the mobile computer into the cradle,  
ensuring it is firmly seated.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Maintenance and Troubleshooting  
12-11  
Table 12-5. Troubleshooting the Single Slot Serial/USB Cradle (Continued)  
Symptom  
Possible Cause  
Action  
Spare battery is not  
charging.  
Battery not fully seated in charging Remove and re-insert the spare battery into the cradle,  
slot.  
ensuring it is firmly seated.  
Battery inserted incorrectly.  
Ensure the contacts are facing down and toward the back  
of the cradle.  
Battery is faulty.  
Verify that other batteries charge properly. If so, replace  
the faulty battery.  
During data  
Mobile computer removed from  
cradle during communications.  
Replace mobile computer in cradle and  
retransmit.  
communications, no  
data was transmitted,  
or transmitted data was  
incomplete.  
Incorrect cable configuration.  
See your system administrator.  
Communications software is not  
installed or configured properly.  
Perform setup as described in Communication Setup on  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
12-12 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Cable Adapter Module  
Table 12-6. Troubleshooting The Cable Adapter Module  
Symptom  
Possible Cause  
Action  
Mobile computer  
Mobile computer was removed  
Ensure CAM is receiving power. Ensure mobile computer  
battery is not charging. from CAM or CAM was unplugged is attached correctly. Confirm main battery is charging  
from AC power too soon.  
under Start - Settings - System - Power. If a mobile  
computer battery is fully depleted, it can take up to four  
hours to fully recharge a battery (if the mobile computer is  
off and longer if the mobile computer is operating).  
Battery is faulty.  
Verify that other batteries charge properly. If so, replace  
the faulty battery.  
The mobile computer is not fully  
attached to the CAM.  
Detach and re-attach the CAM to the mobile computer,  
ensuring it is firmly connected.  
During data  
Mobile computer detached from  
CAM during communications.  
Re-attach mobile computer to CAM and retransmit.  
communications, no  
data was transmitted,  
or transmitted data was  
incomplete.  
Incorrect cable configuration.  
See your System Administrator.  
Communications software is not  
installed or configured properly.  
Perform setup as described in Chapter 4, Communications.  
Magnetic Stripe Reader  
Table 12-7. Troubleshooting the Magnetic Stripe Reader  
Symptom  
Possible Cause  
Action  
MSR cannot read card.  
Mobile computer detached from  
MSR during card swipe.  
Re-attach mobile computer to MSR and reswipe the card.  
Faulty magnetic stripe on card.  
See your System Administrator.  
MSR application is not installed or Ensure the MSR application is installed on the mobile  
configured properly.  
computer.  
Ensure the MSR application is configured correctly.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Maintenance and Troubleshooting  
12-13  
Table 12-7. Troubleshooting the Magnetic Stripe Reader (Continued)  
Symptom  
Possible Cause  
Action  
Mobile computer  
Mobile computer was removed  
Ensure MSR is receiving power. Ensure mobile computer is  
battery is not charging. from MSR or MSR was unplugged attached correctly. Confirm main battery is charging under  
from AC power too soon.  
Start - Settings - System - Power. If a mobile computer  
battery is fully depleted, it can take up to four hours to fully  
recharge a battery (if the mobile computer is off and longer  
if the mobile computer is operating).  
Battery is faulty.  
Verify that other batteries charge properly. If so, replace  
the faulty battery.  
The mobile computer is not fully  
attached to the MSR.  
Detach and re-attach the MSR to the mobile computer,  
ensuring it is firmly connected.  
During data  
Mobile computer detached from  
MSR during communications.  
Reattach mobile computer to MSR and retransmit.  
communications, no  
data was transmitted,  
or transmitted data was  
incomplete.  
Incorrect cable configuration.  
See your System Administrator.  
Communications software is not  
installed or configured properly.  
Perform setup as described in Chapter 4, Communications.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
12-14 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
MDM9000 Modem Module  
Table 12-8. Troubleshooting the MDM9000 Modem Module  
Symptom  
Possible Cause  
Action  
Mobile computer is not The modem cable is not fully  
communicating through connected.  
the modem.  
Connect the modem cable securely to both the modem and  
the telephone jack.  
Modem is not securely connected Reconnect the modem to the mobile computer.  
to the mobile computer.  
Communication software is not  
installed or configured properly.  
Set up the communication software.  
Problem in the telephone lines.  
Connect a conventional telephone and dial the remote  
modem to verify the telephone lines are functioning. If the  
remote modem does not answer the call and emit  
answering tones, contact the remote System  
Administrator.  
Mobile computer’s battery is low or Install a charged battery in the MC9000, or use an external  
discharged, which shuts off power DC power adapter to recharge the battery.  
to the modem.  
ActiveSync fails.  
A partnership was not established Establish a partnership with the host computer.  
with the host computer.  
Host computer is not selected in  
the ActiveSync window on the  
mobile computer.  
Select a host computer in the ActiveSync window, and  
perform setup.  
Modem RAS connection not  
allowed by host computer.  
Select RAS connection in the host computer (File -  
Connection Settings window). Refer to the ReadMe files  
located in the Microsoft ActiveSync folder on the host  
computer.  
Mobile computer or modem was  
Disconnect the modem cable for 30 seconds to hang up  
disconnected from the telephone the local telephone connection. Close any open windows  
line while ActiveSync was in  
progress.  
on the mobile computer and any modem connections.  
Synchronization occurred, but the Verify the synchronizing setting.  
session is configured to close  
immediately after synchronization  
is complete.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Troubleshooting  
12-15  
Table 12-8. Troubleshooting the MDM9000 Modem Module (Continued)  
Symptom  
Dial-out fails  
Possible Cause  
Action  
Location setting is incorrect.  
Verify Dialing Locations. Verify Dialing Patterns are correct  
for the current location. For example, enter ‘G’ in the For  
local calls, dial: field to dial directly, or ‘9,G’ if the  
telephone system requires dialing ‘9’ first to access an  
outside line.  
Incorrect server phone number.  
Verify the connection phone number in the Connecting  
window.  
Pulse dialing not supported for  
country.  
Use a connection within a tone-dialing system.  
Dial-out fails  
continued...  
Dialtone detection not supported. The service you subscribe to (e.g., a remote answering  
service) may use a different type of dialtone. Disable  
dialtone detection on the modem by entering the  
initialization string “ATXO” in the Extra dial-string modem  
commands: text box of the Modem Settings window.  
The following error message  
appears:  
The modem may be required to be powered before  
opening the port for dial-out.  
Trouble Connecting: There is no  
answer at the number dialed.  
Verify the phone...’  
The Connection Manager routes  
are incorrect.  
Warm boot the mobile computer and confirm the  
connection settings.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
12-16 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
VCD9000 Vehicle Cradle  
Table 12-9. Troubleshooting the VCD9000 Vehicle Cradle  
Symptom  
Possible Cause  
Action  
Mobile computer  
battery charging LED  
does not light.  
Cradle is not receiving power.  
Ensure the power input cable is securely connected to the  
cradle’s power port.  
Mobile computer’s  
battery is not  
recharging.  
Mobile computer was removed  
from the cradle too soon.  
Replace the mobile computer in the cradle.  
If the mobile computer’s battery pack is fully depleted, it  
can take four hours to fully recharge the battery.  
Battery is faulty.  
Replace the battery.  
Mobile computer was not placed Remove the mobile computer from the cradle, and re-  
correctly in the cradle.  
insert correctly.  
If the battery still does not charge, contact Customer  
Support.  
The mobile computer battery charging LED blinks amber  
when the mobile computer is correctly inserted and is  
charging.  
No data was  
Mobile computer was removed  
from the cradle during  
communication.  
Replace the mobile computer in the cradle and retransmit.  
transmitted, or  
transmitted data was  
incomplete.  
The external device required a null Retransmit using a null modem cable.  
modem cable, which was not used.  
Incorrect cable configuration.  
See the system administrator.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
A-2 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Technical Specifications A-3  
Mobile Computer Technical Specifications  
The following table summarizes the mobile computer’s intended operating environment.  
Table A-1. Mobile Computer Technical Specifications  
Operating Temperature  
Storage Temperature  
Humidity  
-4° to 122° F (-20° to +50° C)  
-40° to 158° F (-40° to 70° C)  
5% to 90% non-condensing  
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD)  
Drop to Concrete  
+/-15 kVDC (air); +/- 8 kVDC (contact)  
6 feet (1.8 meters) at 14° to 122° F (-10°C to 50°C)  
5 feet (1.52 meters) at 14°F to -4° F (-10°C to -20°C)  
Sealing  
IP64 (electronic enclosure)  
Dimensions  
MC9000-K:  
9.2 in. L x 3.6 in. W x 2.3 in. H  
(233.7 mm L x x 91.4 mm W x 58.4 mm H)  
MC9000-S:  
8 in. L x 3.6 in. W x 2.3 in. H  
(203.2 mm L x x 91.4 mm W x 58.4 mm H)  
Weight (including battery)  
Display  
MC9000-K:  
24 oz - 25 oz (680 g - 708.8 g)  
MC9000-S:  
23 oz - 24 oz (652 g - 680 g)  
Transflective color TFT-LCD, 65K colors, 240 (W) x 320 (L) (QVGA size)  
Monochrome TFT-LCD, 16 shades, 240 (W) x 320 (L) (QVGA size)  
Touch Panel  
Main Battery  
Polycarbonate, analog resistive touch  
MC9000-K:  
Rechargeable Lithium-Ion 2200 mAh minimum (7.4V)  
MC9000-S:  
Rechargeable Lithium-Ion 1550 mAh minimum (7.4V)  
Backup Battery  
CPU  
Ni-MH battery (rechargeable), 20mAh (3.6V) 3 cells  
Intel® XScale™ PXA255 processor at 400 mHz  
®
®
Operating Platform  
Memory  
Microsoft Embedded Windows CE 4.1 (CE .NET)  
32MB RAM/ 32MB Flash  
64MB RAM/ 64MB Flash  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
A-4 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Table A-1. Mobile Computer Technical Specifications (Continued)  
Interface  
RS-232, max. 115.2 kbps min. 1200bps, USB  
Type II  
MMC Card Slot  
Keypad Options  
MC9000-K:  
53-key standard  
Optional Keypads:  
28-key  
43-key  
MC9000-S:  
28-key standard  
Data Capture:  
1D Decode Capability  
Code 39, code 128, code 93, codabar, code 11, discrete 2 of 5, EAN-3, EAN-13,  
EAN-128, interleaved 2 of 5, TLC39 (telecommunications, UPCA, UPCE and UPC/  
EAN supplements.  
Imaging Decode Capability  
Code 39, code 128, code 93, codabar, code 11, discrete 2 of 5, EAN-3, EAN-13,  
EAN-128, interleaved 2 of 5, TLC39 (telecommunications, UPCA, UPCE, UPC/  
EAN supplements composite code (retail), coupon code (retail), macro PDF-417,  
(macro) micro PDF-417 (T&L), micro PDF-417 (telecommunications), MSI  
Plessey, PDF-417 (automotive), RSS expanded, RSS limited and RSS-14Maxi  
Code (UPS), Data matrix (electronics industry, US Postnet (USPS)*, US Planet  
(USPS), UK 4-state, Australian 4-state, Canadian 4-state, Japanese 4-state,  
Dutch Kix  
*To be supported at a later date. Go to http://software.symbol.com/ for a list of  
the latest supported symbologies.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Technical Specifications A-5  
MDM9000 Modem Module Technical Specifications  
Table A-2. MDM9000 Modem Module Technical Specifications  
Asynchronous character format  
Up to 10 bits, including data, start, stop, and parity bits  
Asynchronous data rates  
Chipset  
Transmission rate fallback through 300 bps  
Conexant SCM  
RJ11  
Compatible public switched network  
jacks  
Dialing capability  
Tone and rotary pulse  
Line requirements  
Operating environment  
Public switched telephone network (PSTN) including international connections  
Altitude: up to 20,000 ft.  
Humidity: 10% to 90% non-condensing  
o
o
o
o
Operating temperature  
Operating: 32 to 122 F / 0 to 50 C  
o
o
o
o
Storage: -4 to 149 F / -20 to 65 C  
Operating modes  
Performance  
Asynchronous, full duplex, automatic and manual call originate  
Line speed up to 33,600 bps  
HHC to modem speed (DTE speed) up to 57,600 bps  
V.42bis data compression  
V.42 LAPM error correction  
Current consumption  
100 mA active  
<10 mA sleep  
Pulse dialing rate  
10 pulses per second  
(except where prohibited under TBR-21  
rules)  
Pulse dialing duty cycle: 39/61% (US) make-to-break ratio  
Ringer equivalence  
0.1 dBm  
Standards & protocols  
Bell 103, Bell 212A, Hayes AT command set, and ITU Vs. 17, 21, 22 A & B, 22bis,  
23, 25bis, 27 ter, 29, 32, 32bis, 42bis  
Tone detected  
AC Adapter  
Dial, busy, ring back, modem answer tones.  
Blind dialing based on time-out periods available for incompatible tones.  
9V, 2 amp regulated AC/DC adapter allows unlimited modem use. Do NOT  
substitute an AC adapter; using an incorrect AC power supply causes electrical  
damage to the mobile computer and voids warranty.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
A-6 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Technical Specifications A-7  
Mobile Computer Pin-Outs  
Pin 17  
Pin 1  
Figure A-1. Pin Locations  
Table A-3. MC9000-K and MC9000-S, Pin-Outs  
PIN Number  
Signal Name  
USB_GND  
Function  
1
USB  
2
USB_D_PLUS  
TXD  
USB  
3
RS232C  
RS232C  
RS232C  
RS232C  
RS232C  
Ground, 2.5A max.  
RS232C  
4
RXD  
5
DCD  
6
RTS  
7
DSR  
8
GND  
9
RI  
10  
11  
CRADLE_DET  
DTR  
Grounded by cradle when in cradle  
RS232C  
(12) Opended  
NC (not connected)  
POWER_IN  
CTS  
NC  
13  
14  
15  
16  
17  
12V, 2.5A max  
RS232C  
USB_5V_DET  
USB_D_MINUS  
EXT_PWR_OUT  
USB  
USB  
3.3V @500mA max  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
A-8 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Accessory CAM and MSR Pin-Outs  
Figure A-2. CAM and MSR Serial Connector  
Table A-4. CAM and MSR Serial Connector Pinouts  
Pin  
1
Signal  
USB_5V_DET  
2
USB_D_MINUS  
3
USB_D_PLUS  
4
GND  
5
GND  
6
PWR_EXT_OUT  
7
CRADLE_DET*  
8
DSR  
DCD  
TXD  
CTS  
DTR  
RI  
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
RTS  
RXD  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Keypad Maps  
Appendix Contents  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
B-2 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Keypad Maps B-3  
Introduction  
This appendix contains the keypad maps for the keypad configurations. Each key is listed in the table  
with its value, depending on the state of the keypad.  
Keypads  
Each of the MC9000-K and MC9000-S mobile computers have interchangeable modular Keypads:  
28-key Keypad (MC9000-K)  
43-key Keypad (MC9000-K)  
53-key Keypad (MC9000-K)  
3270 Emulator (MC9000-K)  
5250 Emulator (MC9000-K)  
VT Emulator (MC9000-K)  
28-key Keypad (MC9000-S).  
The modular keypads can be changed in the field as necessary to support specialized applications.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
B-4 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Keypad Maps B-5  
28-Key Keypad (MC9000-K)  
The 28-key keypad contains a Power button, application keys, scroll keys and a function key. See  
Table B-3 for key functions and Table B-4 for the keypad mappings. The mapping functions include:  
28-key functions  
28-key character map.  
Figure B-1. MC9000-K: 28-Key Keypad  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
B-6 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Table B-1. MC9000-K: 28-Key Functions  
Local Function  
Display Backlight On/Off  
Key Sequence  
<Func><#>  
Keypad Backlight On/Off  
Contrast +  
<Func><0>  
<Func><1>  
<Func><4>  
<Func><3>  
<Func><6>  
Contrast -  
Volume +  
Volume -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Keypad Maps B-7  
Table B-2. MC9000-K: 28 Key Keypad Mapping  
Key  
1
49  
49  
42  
*
106  
1
*
*
* See Table 2-7 on page 2-23 for keypad special functions.  
Note: Blank lines are provided to allow the application developer to use this table as a keypad mapping worksheet.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
B-8 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Table B-2. MC9000-K: 28 Key Keypad Mapping (Continued)  
Key  
2
50  
65  
66  
67  
50  
97  
98  
99  
ABC  
2
a
b
c
A
160+65 65  
160+66 66  
160+67 67  
B
C
* See Table 2-7 on page 2-23 for keypad special functions.  
Note: Blank lines are provided to allow the application developer to use this table as a keypad mapping worksheet.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Keypad Maps B-9  
Table B-2. MC9000-K: 28 Key Keypad Mapping (Continued)  
Key  
3
51  
51  
DEF  
d
68  
69  
70  
100  
101  
102  
3
e
f
D
160+68 68  
160+69 69  
160+70 70  
E
F
*
*
* See Table 2-7 on page 2-23 for keypad special functions.  
Note: Blank lines are provided to allow the application developer to use this table as a keypad mapping worksheet.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
B-10 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Table B-2. MC9000-K: 28 Key Keypad Mapping (Continued)  
Key  
4
52  
71  
72  
73  
52  
GHI  
4
g
103  
104  
105  
h
i
G
160+71 71  
160+72 72  
160+73 73  
H
I
*
*
* See Table 2-7 on page 2-23 for keypad special functions.  
Note: Blank lines are provided to allow the application developer to use this table as a keypad mapping worksheet.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Keypad Maps B-11  
Table B-2. MC9000-K: 28 Key Keypad Mapping (Continued)  
Key  
5
53  
53  
JKL  
5
j
74  
75  
76  
106  
107  
108  
k
l
J
160+74 74  
160+75 75  
160+76 76  
K
L
5
53  
53  
61  
=
187  
+
160+187 43  
* See Table 2-7 on page 2-23 for keypad special functions.  
Note: Blank lines are provided to allow the application developer to use this table as a keypad mapping worksheet.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
B-12 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Table B-2. MC9000-K: 28 Key Keypad Mapping (Continued)  
Key  
6
54  
77  
78  
79  
54  
MNO  
6
m
109  
110  
111  
n
o
M
160+77 77  
160+78 78  
160+79 79  
N
O
*
*
* See Table 2-7 on page 2-23 for keypad special functions.  
Note: Blank lines are provided to allow the application developer to use this table as a keypad mapping worksheet.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Keypad Maps B-13  
Table B-2. MC9000-K: 28 Key Keypad Mapping (Continued)  
Key  
7
55  
55  
PQRS  
7
p
80  
81  
82  
83  
112  
113  
114  
115  
q
r
s
P
160+80 80  
160+81 81  
160+82 82  
160+83 83  
Q
R
S
+
107  
43  
+
160+107 43  
* See Table 2-7 on page 2-23 for keypad special functions.  
Note: Blank lines are provided to allow the application developer to use this table as a keypad mapping worksheet.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
B-14 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Table B-2. MC9000-K: 28 Key Keypad Mapping (Continued)  
Key  
8
56  
84  
85  
86  
56  
TUV  
8
t
116  
117  
118  
u
v
T
160+84 84  
160+85 85  
160+86 86  
U
V
-
189  
45  
-
160+189 45  
* See Table 2-7 on page 2-23 for keypad special functions.  
Note: Blank lines are provided to allow the application developer to use this table as a keypad mapping worksheet.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Keypad Maps B-15  
Table B-2. MC9000-K: 28 Key Keypad Mapping (Continued)  
Key  
9
57  
57  
WXYZ  
9
w
87  
88  
89  
90  
119  
120  
121  
122  
x
y
z
W
160+87 87  
160+88 88  
160+89 89  
160+90 90  
X
Y
Z
/
191  
47  
/
160+191 47  
* See Table 2-7 on page 2-23 for keypad special functions.  
Note: Blank lines are provided to allow the application developer to use this table as a keypad mapping worksheet.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
B-16 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Table B-2. MC9000-K: 28 Key Keypad Mapping (Continued)  
Key  
.
190  
46  
*
106  
42  
*
160+106 42  
* See Table 2-7 on page 2-23 for keypad special functions.  
Note: Blank lines are provided to allow the application developer to use this table as a keypad mapping worksheet.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Keypad Maps B-17  
Table B-2. MC9000-K: 28 Key Keypad Mapping (Continued)  
Key  
0
48  
32  
48  
32  
0
*
*
* See Table 2-7 on page 2-23 for keypad special functions.  
Note: Blank lines are provided to allow the application developer to use this table as a keypad mapping worksheet.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
B-18 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Table B-2. MC9000-K: 28 Key Keypad Mapping (Continued)  
Key  
#
160+51 35  
#
*
*
* See Table 2-7 on page 2-23 for keypad special functions.  
Note: Blank lines are provided to allow the application developer to use this table as a keypad mapping worksheet.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Keypad Maps B-19  
Table B-2. MC9000-K: 28 Key Keypad Mapping (Continued)  
Key  
Space  
32  
32  
SPACE  
* See Table 2-7 on page 2-23 for keypad special functions.  
Note: Blank lines are provided to allow the application developer to use this table as a keypad mapping worksheet.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
B-20 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Table B-2. MC9000-K: 28 Key Keypad Mapping (Continued)  
Key  
BKSP  
8
8
BKSP  
* See Table 2-7 on page 2-23 for keypad special functions.  
Note: Blank lines are provided to allow the application developer to use this table as a keypad mapping worksheet.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Keypad Maps B-21  
Table B-2. MC9000-K: 28 Key Keypad Mapping (Continued)  
Key  
Up  
38  
-
* See Table 2-7 on page 2-23 for keypad special functions.  
Note: Blank lines are provided to allow the application developer to use this table as a keypad mapping worksheet.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
B-22 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Table B-2. MC9000-K: 28 Key Keypad Mapping (Continued)  
Key  
Down  
40  
-
* See Table 2-7 on page 2-23 for keypad special functions.  
Note: Blank lines are provided to allow the application developer to use this table as a keypad mapping worksheet.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Keypad Maps B-23  
Table B-2. MC9000-K: 28 Key Keypad Mapping (Continued)  
Key  
Right  
39  
-
* See Table 2-7 on page 2-23 for keypad special functions.  
Note: Blank lines are provided to allow the application developer to use this table as a keypad mapping worksheet.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
B-24 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Table B-2. MC9000-K: 28 Key Keypad Mapping (Continued)  
Key  
Left  
37  
-
* See Table 2-7 on page 2-23 for keypad special functions.  
Note: Blank lines are provided to allow the application developer to use this table as a keypad mapping worksheet.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Keypad Maps B-25  
43-Key Keypad (MC9000-K)  
The 43-key keypad contains a Power button, application keys, scroll keys and a function key. See  
Table B-3 for key functions and Table B-4 for the keypad mappings. The mapping functions include:  
43-key functions  
43-key character map.  
Figure B-2. MC9000-K: 43-Key Keypad  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
B-26 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Table B-3. MC9000-K: 43-Key Functions  
Local Function  
Display Backlight On/Off  
Key Sequence  
Keypad Backlight On/Off  
Contrast +  
Contrast -  
Volume +  
Volume -  
<Func><F1>  
<Func><F5>  
<Func><F4>  
<Func><F8>  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Keypad Maps B-27  
Table B-4. MC9000-K: 43 Keypad Mapping  
Default  
(Numlock)  
State  
Shift-  
Func  
State  
Alpha  
State  
Shift  
VK Code  
(Decimal)  
ASCII Value  
(Decimal)  
Key  
AlphaState Func State  
1
49  
49  
u
v
85  
117  
85  
U
160+85  
85  
u
117  
85  
U
V
160+85  
50  
2
3
4
50  
86  
118  
86  
V
160+86  
86  
v
118  
86  
160+86  
51  
51  
w
87  
119  
87  
W
160+87  
87  
w
119  
87  
W
160+87  
52  
52  
r
82  
114  
82  
R
160+82  
82  
r
114  
82  
R
160+82  
* See Table 2-7 on page 2-23 for keypad special functions.  
Note: Blank lines are provided to allow the application developer to use this table as a keypad mapping worksheet.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
B-28 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Table B-4. MC9000-K: 43 Keypad Mapping (Continued)  
Default  
(Numlock)  
State  
Shift-  
Func  
State  
Alpha  
State  
Shift  
VK Code  
(Decimal)  
ASCII Value  
(Decimal)  
Key  
AlphaState Func State  
5
53  
53  
s
83  
115  
83  
S
160+83  
83  
s
115  
83  
S
T
O
P
160+83  
54  
6
7
8
54  
t
84  
116  
84  
T
160+84  
84  
t
116  
84  
160+84  
55  
55  
o
p
79  
111  
79  
O
160+79  
79  
o
111  
79  
160+79  
56  
56  
80  
112  
80  
P
160+80  
80  
p
112  
80  
160+80  
* See Table 2-7 on page 2-23 for keypad special functions.  
Note: Blank lines are provided to allow the application developer to use this table as a keypad mapping worksheet.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Keypad Maps B-29  
Table B-4. MC9000-K: 43 Keypad Mapping (Continued)  
Default  
(Numlock)  
State  
Shift-  
Func  
State  
Alpha  
State  
Shift  
VK Code  
(Decimal)  
ASCII Value  
(Decimal)  
Key  
AlphaState Func State  
9
57  
57  
q
y
a
81  
113  
81  
Q
160+81  
81  
q
113  
81  
Q
Y
160+81  
49  
0
49  
89  
121  
89  
Y
160+89  
89  
y
121  
89  
160+89  
F1  
65  
97  
65  
A
160+65  
*
*
F2  
b
66  
98  
66  
98  
66  
B
160+66  
66  
b
B
160+66  
* See Table 2-7 on page 2-23 for keypad special functions.  
Note: Blank lines are provided to allow the application developer to use this table as a keypad mapping worksheet.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
B-30 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Table B-4. MC9000-K: 43 Keypad Mapping (Continued)  
Default  
(Numlock)  
State  
Shift-  
Func  
State  
Alpha  
State  
Shift  
VK Code  
(Decimal)  
ASCII Value  
(Decimal)  
Key  
AlphaState Func State  
F3  
c
67  
99  
C
160+67  
67  
67  
99  
67  
c
C
*
*
160+67  
F4  
d
68  
100  
68  
D
160+68  
*
F5  
e
69  
101  
69  
E
160+69  
*
* See Table 2-7 on page 2-23 for keypad special functions.  
Note: Blank lines are provided to allow the application developer to use this table as a keypad mapping worksheet.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Keypad Maps B-31  
Table B-4. MC9000-K: 43 Keypad Mapping (Continued)  
Default  
(Numlock)  
State  
Shift-  
Func  
State  
Alpha  
State  
Shift  
VK Code  
(Decimal)  
ASCII Value  
(Decimal)  
Key  
AlphaState Func State  
F6  
f
70  
102  
70  
F
160+70  
70  
f
102  
70  
F
160+70  
F7  
F8  
F9  
g
h
i
71  
103  
71  
G
160+71  
71  
g
103  
71  
G
H
+
160+71  
72  
104  
72  
H
160+72  
72  
h
104  
72  
160+72  
73  
105  
73  
I
160+73  
107  
+
43  
160+107  
43  
* See Table 2-7 on page 2-23 for keypad special functions.  
Note: Blank lines are provided to allow the application developer to use this table as a keypad mapping worksheet.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
B-32 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Table B-4. MC9000-K: 43 Keypad Mapping (Continued)  
Default  
(Numlock)  
State  
Shift-  
Func  
State  
Alpha  
State  
Shift  
VK Code  
(Decimal)  
ASCII Value  
(Decimal)  
Key  
AlphaState Func State  
F10  
j
74  
106  
74  
J
160+74  
189  
-
45  
-
160+189  
45  
F11  
F12  
k
75  
107  
75  
K
160+75  
106  
*
42  
*
?
160+106  
42  
l
76  
108  
76  
L
160+76  
191  
/
47  
160+191  
63  
*
m
77  
109  
77  
M
160+77  
77  
m
109  
77  
M
160+77  
* See Table 2-7 on page 2-23 for keypad special functions.  
Note: Blank lines are provided to allow the application developer to use this table as a keypad mapping worksheet.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Keypad Maps B-33  
Table B-4. MC9000-K: 43 Keypad Mapping (Continued)  
Default  
(Numlock)  
State  
Shift-  
Func  
State  
Alpha  
State  
Shift  
VK Code  
(Decimal)  
ASCII Value  
(Decimal)  
Key  
AlphaState Func State  
*
n
78  
110  
78  
N
160+78  
78  
n
110  
78  
N
160+78  
32  
Space  
BKSP  
UP  
32  
Space  
BKSP  
32  
32  
Space  
160+32  
32  
8
8
8
8
8
8
BKSP  
BKSP  
160+8  
8
38  
-
* See Table 2-7 on page 2-23 for keypad special functions.  
Note: Blank lines are provided to allow the application developer to use this table as a keypad mapping worksheet.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
B-34 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Table B-4. MC9000-K: 43 Keypad Mapping (Continued)  
Default  
(Numlock)  
State  
Shift-  
Func  
State  
Alpha  
State  
Shift  
VK Code  
(Decimal)  
ASCII Value  
(Decimal)  
Key  
AlphaState Func State  
Down  
Right  
Left  
.
40  
-
39  
37  
-
-
190  
46  
x
88  
120  
88  
X
160+88  
88  
x
120  
88  
X
160+88  
* See Table 2-7 on page 2-23 for keypad special functions.  
Note: Blank lines are provided to allow the application developer to use this table as a keypad mapping worksheet.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Keypad Maps B-35  
Table B-4. MC9000-K: 43 Keypad Mapping (Continued)  
Default  
(Numlock)  
State  
Shift-  
Func  
State  
Alpha  
State  
Shift  
VK Code  
(Decimal)  
ASCII Value  
(Decimal)  
Key  
AlphaState Func State  
*
106  
42  
z
90  
122  
90  
Z
160+90  
90  
z
122  
90  
Z
160+90  
* See Table 2-7 on page 2-23 for keypad special functions.  
Note: Blank lines are provided to allow the application developer to use this table as a keypad mapping worksheet.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
B-36 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
53-Key Keypad (MC9000-K)  
There are two physical configurations of the 53-key keypad, however both of the keypads are  
functionally identical. The 53-key keypad contains a Power button, application keys, scroll keys and  
function keys. See Table B-5 for key functions and Table B-6 for the keypad mappings. The mapping  
functions include:  
53-key functions  
53-key character map.  
Figure B-3. MC9000-K: 53 Key Keypad  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Keypad Maps B-37  
Table B-5. MC9000-K: 53 Key Functions  
Local Function  
Display Backlight On/Off  
Key Sequence  
<Func><Z>  
<Func><X>  
<Func><D>  
<Func><I>  
<Func><H>  
<Func><M>  
Keypad Backlight On/Off  
Contrast +  
Contrast -  
Volume +  
Volume -  
Table B-6. MC9000-K: 53-Key Mapping  
Shift-Func  
State  
VK Code  
(Decimal)  
ASCII Value  
(Decimal)  
Key  
Default State Shift State Func State  
1
2
3
49  
49  
!
160+49  
112  
33  
-
F1  
F2  
F3  
F1  
F2  
F3  
1160+12  
50  
-
50  
64  
-
@
#
160+50  
113  
160+113  
51  
-
51  
35  
-
160+51  
114  
160+114  
-
* See Table 2-7 on page 2-23 for keypad special functions.  
Note: Blank lines are provided to allow the application developer to use this table as a keypad mapping worksheet.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
B-38 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Table B-6. MC9000-K: 53-Key Mapping (Continued)  
Shift-Func  
State  
VK Code  
(Decimal)  
ASCII Value  
(Decimal)  
Key  
Default State Shift State Func State  
4
52  
52  
$
160+52  
115  
103  
-
F4  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F7  
F8  
F9  
160+115  
53  
-
5
53  
106  
-
%
160+53  
116  
F5  
160+116  
54  
-
6
54  
94  
-
^
160+54  
117  
F6  
160+117  
55  
-
7
55  
112  
-
&
160+55  
118  
F7  
160+118  
56  
-
8
56  
42  
-
*
160+56  
119  
F8  
160+119  
57  
-
9
57  
41  
-
(
160+57  
120  
F9  
160+120  
-
* See Table 2-7 on page 2-23 for keypad special functions.  
Note: Blank lines are provided to allow the application developer to use this table as a keypad mapping worksheet.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Keypad Maps B-39  
Table B-6. MC9000-K: 53-Key Mapping (Continued)  
Shift-Func  
State  
VK Code  
(Decimal)  
ASCII Value  
(Decimal)  
Key  
Default State Shift State Func State  
0
48  
48  
)
160+48  
121  
40  
-
F10  
F10  
160+121  
38  
-
UP  
-
Down  
Right  
Left  
40  
39  
37  
-
-
-
* See Table 2-7 on page 2-23 for keypad special functions.  
Note: Blank lines are provided to allow the application developer to use this table as a keypad mapping worksheet.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
B-40 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Table B-6. MC9000-K: 53-Key Mapping (Continued)  
Shift-Func  
State  
VK Code  
(Decimal)  
ASCII Value  
(Decimal)  
Key  
Default State Shift State Func State  
ENTER  
13  
13  
a
A
,
65  
97  
65  
44  
60  
98  
66  
46  
60  
99  
67  
39  
34  
100  
68  
160+65  
188  
<
>
160+188  
66  
b
B
.
66  
190  
160+190  
67  
c
C
160+67  
222  
160+222  
68  
b
D
160+68  
*
*
* See Table 2-7 on page 2-23 for keypad special functions.  
Note: Blank lines are provided to allow the application developer to use this table as a keypad mapping worksheet.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Keypad Maps B-41  
Table B-6. MC9000-K: 53-Key Mapping (Continued)  
Shift-Func  
State  
VK Code  
(Decimal)  
ASCII Value  
(Decimal)  
Key  
Default State Shift State Func State  
e
E
[
69  
101  
160+69  
219  
69  
91  
{
}
|
160+219  
70  
123  
102  
70  
f
F
]
160+70  
221  
93  
160+221  
71  
125  
103  
71  
g
G
\
160+71  
220  
92  
160+220  
72  
124  
104  
72  
h
H
160+72  
*
*
* See Table 2-7 on page 2-23 for keypad special functions.  
Note: Blank lines are provided to allow the application developer to use this table as a keypad mapping worksheet.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
B-42 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Table B-6. MC9000-K: 53-Key Mapping (Continued)  
Shift-Func  
State  
VK Code  
(Decimal)  
ASCII Value  
(Decimal)  
Key  
Default State Shift State Func State  
i
73  
105  
I
160+73  
73  
*
*
~
K
?
j
74  
106  
74  
J
K
L
160+74  
192  
96  
160+192  
75  
126  
107  
75  
k
l
160+75  
75  
k
/
107  
75  
160+75  
76  
108  
76  
160+76  
191  
47  
160+191  
63  
* See Table 2-7 on page 2-23 for keypad special functions.  
Note: Blank lines are provided to allow the application developer to use this table as a keypad mapping worksheet.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Keypad Maps B-43  
Table B-6. MC9000-K: 53-Key Mapping (Continued)  
Shift-Func  
State  
VK Code  
(Decimal)  
ASCII Value  
(Decimal)  
Key  
Default State Shift State Func State  
m
77  
109  
M
160+77  
77  
*
*
n
N
-
78  
110  
78  
160+78  
189  
45  
_
O
P
160+189  
79  
95  
o
O
o
111  
79  
160+79  
79  
111  
79  
160+79  
80  
p
P
p
112  
80  
160+80  
80  
112  
80  
160+80  
81  
q
Q
q
113  
81  
160+81  
81  
113  
81  
Q
160+81  
* See Table 2-7 on page 2-23 for keypad special functions.  
Note: Blank lines are provided to allow the application developer to use this table as a keypad mapping worksheet.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
B-44 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Table B-6. MC9000-K: 53-Key Mapping (Continued)  
Shift-Func  
State  
VK Code  
(Decimal)  
ASCII Value  
(Decimal)  
Key  
Default State Shift State Func State  
r
82  
114  
R
160+82  
186  
82  
;
59  
:
160+186  
83  
58  
s
115  
83  
S
160+83  
187  
+
-
43  
+
-
160+187  
84  
43  
t
116  
84  
T
160+84  
109  
45  
160+109  
85  
45  
u
v
117  
85  
U
V
85  
*
/
=
106  
42  
*
?
+
160+106  
86  
42  
118  
86  
160+86  
191  
47  
160+191  
87  
63  
w
119  
87  
W
160+87  
187  
43  
160+187  
43  
* See Table 2-7 on page 2-23 for keypad special functions.  
Note: Blank lines are provided to allow the application developer to use this table as a keypad mapping worksheet.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Keypad Maps B-45  
Table B-6. MC9000-K: 53-Key Mapping (Continued)  
Shift-Func  
State  
VK Code  
(Decimal)  
ASCII Value  
(Decimal)  
Key  
Default State Shift State Func State  
x
88  
120  
X
160+88  
88  
*
*
y
Y
y
89  
121  
89  
160+89  
89  
121  
89  
Y
160+89  
90  
z
122  
90  
Z
90  
*
*
* See Table 2-7 on page 2-23 for keypad special functions.  
Note: Blank lines are provided to allow the application developer to use this table as a keypad mapping worksheet.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
B-46 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
3270 Emulator  
The 3270 emulator keypad contains a Power button, application keys, scroll keys and a function key.  
The 3270 emulator keypad uses the 53-key mapping when not in the emulator mode, see Table B-6  
for descriptions for the 53-key mappings. The emulator mapping functions include:  
3270 key functions  
3270 emulation keys  
3270 character map.  
Figure B-4. 3270 Emulator Keypad  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Keypad Maps B-47  
Table B-7. 3270 Key Functions  
Local Function  
Program Information  
Diagnostics  
Key Sequence  
<Func><Ctrl><P>  
<Func><Ctrl><D>  
<Func><Ctrl><K>  
<Func><Ctrl><Q>  
<Func><Ctrl><C>  
<Func><Ctrl><R>  
<Func><Ctrl><M>  
<Func><Ctrl><F>  
<Func><Ctrl><T>  
<Upper Left Button>  
<Upper Right Button>  
<Func><Shift>  
<Func><Ctrl><Z>  
<Ctrl><Left>  
Keyclicks On/Off  
Quiet Mode On/Off  
Terminal Configuration  
Host Profiles  
Message Recall  
Free Cursor Mode  
Close Session  
Previous Session  
Next Session  
Caps Lock  
View Mode On/Off  
Scroll Left  
Scroll Right  
<Ctrl><Right>  
<Ctrl><Up>  
Scroll Up  
Scroll Down  
<Ctrl><Down>  
<Func><Z>  
Display Backlight On/Off  
Keypad Backlight On/Off  
Contrast +  
<Func><X>  
<Func><D>  
Contrast -  
<Func><I>  
Volume +  
<Func><H>  
Volume -  
<Func><M>  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
B-48 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Table B-8. 3270 Emulation Keys  
3270 Key  
Key Sequence  
Attention  
<Ctrl><G>  
<BKSP>  
Backspace  
Back Tab  
Clear  
<Ctrl><J>  
<Esc>  
Clear EOF  
Delete  
Dup  
<Ctrl><K>  
<Func><BKSP>  
<Ctrl><D>  
Enter  
<Enter>  
Erase Input  
Field Mark  
Home  
<Ctrl><E>  
<Ctrl><F>  
<Func><*>  
<Ctrl><H>  
Insert  
New Line  
Reset  
<Ctrl><N>  
<Ctrl><O>  
System Request  
Tab  
<Ctrl><L>  
<Func><Space>  
<Left Arrow>  
<Right Arrow>  
<Up Arrow>  
<Down Arrow>  
<Ctrl><A>  
Left Arrow  
Right Arrow  
Up Arrow  
Down Arrow  
PA1  
PA2  
<Ctrl><B>  
PA3  
<Ctrl><C>  
F1  
<Func><1>  
<Func><2>  
<Func><3>  
F2  
F3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Keypad Maps B-49  
Table B-8. 3270 Emulation Keys (Continued)  
3270 Key  
Key Sequence  
F4  
<Func><4>  
<Func><5>  
<Func><6>  
<Func><7>  
<Func><8>  
<Func><9>  
<Func><0>  
<Shift><1>  
<Shift><2>  
<Shift><3>  
<Shift><4>  
<Shift><5>  
<Shift><6>  
<Shift><7>  
<Shift><8>  
<Shift><9>  
<Shift><0>  
<Ctrl><1>  
<Ctrl><2>  
<Ctrl><3>  
<Ctrl><4>  
F5  
F6  
F7  
F8  
F9  
F10  
F11  
F12  
F13  
F14  
F15  
F16  
F17  
F18  
F19  
F20  
F21  
F22  
F23  
F24  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
B-50 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Table B-9. 3270 Character Map  
Char  
Key Sequence  
Space  
<space>  
!
<Ctrl><5>  
<Shift><Func><C>  
<Ctrl><6>  
<Ctrl><7>  
<Ctrl><8>  
<Ctrl><9>  
<Func><C>  
<Ctrl><0>  
<Func><Ctrl><A>  
<*>  
"
#
$
%
&
'
(
)
*
+
,
<Func><S>  
<Func><A>  
<Func><T>  
<.>  
-
.
/
<Func><V>  
<0>  
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
<1>  
<2>  
<3>  
<4>  
<5>  
<6>  
<7>  
<8>  
<9>  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Keypad Maps B-51  
Table B-9. 3270 Character Map  
Char  
Key Sequence  
<Shift><Func><R>  
:
;
<Func><R>  
<
=
>
?
<Shift><Func><A>  
<Func><W>  
<Shift><Func><B>  
<Func><Ctrl><G>  
<Func><Ctrl><B>  
<Shift><A>  
<Shift><B>  
<Shift><C>  
<Shift><D>  
<Shift><E>  
@
A
B
C
D
E
F
<Shift><F>  
G
H
I
<Shift><G>  
<Shift><H>  
<Shift><I>  
J
K
L
<Shift><J>  
<Shift><K>  
<Shift><L>  
M
N
O
P
Q
R
S
T
<Shift><M>  
<Shift><N>  
<Shift><O>  
<Shift><P>  
<Shift><Q>  
<Shift><R>  
<Shift><S>  
<Shift><T>  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
B-52 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Table B-9. 3270 Character Map  
Char  
Key Sequence  
<Shift><U>  
U
V
W
X
Y
Z
[
<Shift><V>  
<Shift><W>  
<Shift><X>  
<Shift><Y>  
<Shift><Z>  
<Func><E>  
<Func><G>  
<Func><F>  
<Func><Ctrl><E>  
<Shift><Func><N>  
<Func><J>  
<A>  
\
]
^
_
`
a
b
c
d
e
f
<B>  
<C>  
<D>  
<E>  
<F>  
g
h
i
<G>  
<H>  
<I>  
j
<J>  
k
l
<K>  
<L>  
m
n
o
<M>  
<N>  
<O>  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Keypad Maps B-53  
Table B-9. 3270 Character Map  
Char  
Key Sequence  
p
q
r
<P>  
<Q>  
<R>  
<S>  
<T>  
<U>  
<V>  
<W>  
<X>  
<Y>  
<Z>  
s
t
u
v
w
x
y
z
{
<Shift><Func><E>  
<Shift><Func><G>  
<Shift><Func><F>  
<Shift><Func><J>  
|
}
~
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
B-54 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
5250 Emulator  
The 5250 emulator keypad contains a Power button, application keys, scroll keys and a function key.  
The 5250 emulator keypad uses the 53-key mapping when not in the emulator mode, see Table B-6  
for descriptions for the 53-key mappings. The emulator mapping functions include:  
5250 key functions  
5250 emulation keys  
5250 character map.  
Figure B-5. 5250 Emulator Keypad  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Keypad Maps B-55  
Table B-10. 5250 Key Functions  
Local Function  
Program Information  
Diagnostics  
Key Sequence  
<Func><Ctrl><P>  
<Func><Ctrl><D>  
<Func><Ctrl><K>  
<Func><Ctrl><Q>  
<Func><Ctrl><C>  
<Func><Ctrl><R>  
<Func><Ctrl><M>  
<Func><Ctrl><F>  
<Func><Ctrl><T>  
<Upper Left Button>  
<Upper Right Button>  
<Func><Shift>  
<Func><Ctrl><Z>  
<Ctrl><Left>  
Keyclicks On/Off  
Quiet Mode On/Off  
Terminal Configuration  
Host Profiles  
Message Recall  
Free Cursor Mode  
Close Session  
Previous Session  
Next Session  
Caps Lock  
View Mode On/Off  
Scroll Left  
Scroll Right  
<Ctrl><Right>  
<Ctrl><Up>  
Scroll Up  
Scroll Down  
<Ctrl><Down>  
<Func><Z>  
Display Backlight On/Off  
Keypad Backlight On/Off  
Contrast +  
<Func><X>  
<Func><D>  
Contrast -  
<Func><I>  
Volume +  
<Func><H>  
Volume -  
<Func><M>  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
B-56 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Table B-11. 5250 Emulation Keys  
5250 Key  
Attention  
Key Sequence  
<Ctrl><G>  
<BKSP>  
Backspace  
Back Tab  
Clear  
<Func><Space>  
<Func><Ctrl><Shift><1>  
<Func><BKSP>  
<Ctrl><D>  
Delete  
Dup  
Enter  
<Ent>  
Erase Input  
Field Exit  
Field Minus  
Help  
<Ctrl><E>  
<Field Exit>  
<Func><*>  
<Ctrl><C>  
Home  
<Ctrl><A>  
Insert  
<Ctrl><H>  
Print  
<Ctrl><B>  
Reset  
<Func><.>  
Roll Up  
Roll Down  
System Request  
Tab  
<Ctrl><J>  
<Ctrl><L>  
<Ctrl><K>  
<Ctrl><I>  
Left Arrow  
Right Arrow  
Up Arrow  
Down Arrow  
F1  
<Left Arrow>  
<Right Arrow>  
<Up Arrow>  
<Down Arrow>  
<Func><1>  
<Func><2>  
<Func><3>  
F2  
F3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Keypad Maps B-57  
Table B-11. 5250 Emulation Keys (Continued)  
5250 Key  
Key Sequence  
<Func><4>  
F4  
F5  
<Func><5>  
<Func><6>  
<Func><7>  
<Func><8>  
<Func><9>  
<Func><0>  
<Shift><1>  
<Shift><2>  
<Shift><3>  
<Shift><4>  
<Shift><5>  
<Shift><6>  
<Shift><7>  
<Shift><8>  
<Shift><9>  
<Shift><0>  
<Ctrl><1>  
<Ctrl><2>  
<Ctrl><3>  
<Ctrl><4>  
F6  
F7  
F8  
F9  
F10  
F11  
F12  
F13  
F14  
F15  
F16  
F17  
F18  
F19  
F20  
F21  
F22  
F23  
F24  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
B-58 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Table B-12. 5250 Character Map  
Char  
Key Sequence  
<space>  
Space  
!
<Ctrl><5>  
<Shift><Func><C>  
<Ctrl><6>  
<Ctrl><7>  
<Ctrl><8>  
<Ctrl><9>  
<Func><C>  
<Ctrl><0>  
<Func><Ctrl><A>  
<*>  
"
#
$
%
&
'
(
)
*
+
,
<Func><S>  
<Func><A>  
<Func><T>  
<.>  
-
.
/
<Func><V>  
<0>  
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
<1>  
<2>  
<3>  
<4>  
<5>  
<6>  
<7>  
<8>  
<9>  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Keypad Maps B-59  
Table B-12. 5250 Character Map  
Char  
:
Key Sequence  
<Shift><Func><R>  
;
<Func><R>  
<
<Shift><Func><A>  
<Func><W>  
<Shift><Func><B>  
<Func><Ctrl><G>  
<Func><Ctrl><B>  
<Shift><A>  
<Shift><B>  
<Shift><C>  
<Shift><D>  
<Shift><E>  
=
>
?
@
A
B
C
D
E
F
<Shift><F>  
G
H
I
<Shift><G>  
<Shift><H>  
<Shift><I>  
J
<Shift><J>  
K
L
<Shift><K>  
<Shift><L>  
M
N
O
P
<Shift><M>  
<Shift><N>  
<Shift><O>  
<Shift><P>  
Q
R
S
T
<Shift><Q>  
<Shift><R>  
<Shift><S>  
<Shift><T>  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
B-60 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Table B-12. 5250 Character Map  
Char  
Key Sequence  
<Shift><U>  
U
V
W
X
Y
Z
[
<Shift><V>  
<Shift><W>  
<Shift><X>  
<Shift><Y>  
<Shift><Z>  
<Func><E>  
<Func><G>  
<Func><F>  
<Func><Ctrl><E>  
<Shift><Func><N>  
<Func><J>  
<A>  
\
]
^
_
`
a
b
c
d
e
f
<B>  
<C>  
<D>  
<E>  
<F>  
g
h
i
<G>  
<H>  
<I>  
j
<J>  
k
l
<K>  
<L>  
m
n
o
<M>  
<N>  
<O>  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Keypad Maps B-61  
Table B-12. 5250 Character Map  
Char  
Key Sequence  
p
q
r
<P>  
<Q>  
<R>  
<S>  
<T>  
<U>  
<V>  
<W>  
<X>  
<Y>  
<Z>  
s
t
u
v
w
x
y
z
{
<Shift><Func><E>  
<Shift><Func><G>  
<Shift><Func><F>  
<Shift><Func><J>  
|
}
~
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
B-62 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
VT Emulator Keypad  
The VT Emulator keypad contains a Power button, application keys, scroll keys and a function key. The  
VT emulator keypad uses the 53-key mapping when not in the emulator mode, see Table B-6 for  
descriptions for the 53-key mappings. The emulator mapping functions include:  
VT key functions  
VT-100 emulation keys  
VT-220 emulation keys  
VT/HP character map.  
Figure B-6. VT Emulator Keypad  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Keypad Maps B-63  
Table B-13. VT Terminal Functions  
VT Function  
Key Sequence  
<Func><Ctrl><P>  
Program Information  
Diagnostics  
<Func><Ctrl><D>  
<Func><Ctrl><K>  
<Func><Ctrl><Q>  
<Func><Ctrl><C>  
<Func><Ctrl><R>  
<Func><Ctrl><T>  
<Func><Ctrl><Shift><1>  
<Func><Ctrl><Shift><3>  
<Func><Shift>  
<Func><Ctrl><Z>  
<Ctrl><Left>  
Keyclicks On/Off  
Quiet Mode  
Terminal Configuration  
Host Profiles  
Close Session  
Previous Session  
Next Session  
Caps Lock  
View Mode On/Off  
Scroll Left  
Scroll Right  
<Ctrl><Right>  
<Ctrl><Up>  
Scroll Up  
Scroll Down  
<Ctrl><Down>  
<Func><Z>  
Display Backlight On/Off  
Keypad Backlight On/Off  
Contrast +  
<Func><X>  
<Func><D>  
Contrast -  
<Func><I>  
Volume +  
<Func><H>  
Volume -  
<Func><M>  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
B-64 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Table B-14. VT-100 Emulation Keys  
VT-100 Key  
Key Sequence  
Return  
Backspace  
Tab  
<Return>  
<BKSP>  
<Func><*>  
<Up Arrow>  
<Left Arrow>  
<Esc>  
Up Arrow  
Left Arrow  
ESC  
BS  
<BKSP>  
LF  
<Ctrl><J>  
Hard Terminal Reset  
<Func><Ctrl><H>  
<Return>  
Enter  
Backspace(Delete)  
<BKSP>  
Backtab  
Down Arrow  
Right Arrow  
PF1  
<Func><.>  
<Down Arrow>  
<Right Arrow>  
<Func><1>  
<Func><2>  
<Func><3>  
<Func><4>  
PF2  
PF3  
PF4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Keypad Maps B-65  
Table B-15. VT-220 Emulation Keys  
VT-220 Key  
Key Sequence  
Return  
<Return>  
<BKSP>  
Backspace  
Tab  
<Func><*>  
<Up Arrow>  
Up Arrow  
Left Arrow  
<Left Arrow>  
<Func><Ctrl><H>  
<Func><Ctrl><Left>  
<Func><Space>  
<Func><Ctrl><Shift><4>  
<Func><1>  
Hard Terminal Reset  
Find  
Insert Here  
Prev Screen  
PF1  
PF2  
<Func><2>  
PF3  
<Func><3>  
PF4  
<Func><4>  
BREAK1  
F6  
<Func><5>  
<Func><6>  
F7  
<Func><7>  
F8  
<Func><8>  
F9  
<Func><9>  
F10  
<Func><0>  
F11  
<Shift><1>  
F12  
<Shift><2>  
F13  
<Shift><3>  
F14  
<Shift><4>  
F15/Help  
F16/Do  
F17  
<Shift><5>  
<Shift><6>  
<Shift><7>  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
B-66 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Table B-15. VT-220 Emulation Keys (Continued)  
VT-220 Key  
Key Sequence  
F18  
<Shift><8>  
<Shift><9>  
<Shift><0>  
<Return>  
F19  
F20  
Enter  
Backspace(Delete)  
Backtab  
<Ctrl><BKSP>  
<Func><.>  
Down Arrow  
Right Arrow  
Soft Terminal Reset  
Select  
<Down Arrow>  
<Right Arrow>  
<Func><Ctrl><S>  
<Func><Ctrl><Shift><5>  
<Func><Ctrl><Shift><7>  
<Func><Ctrl><Shift><6>  
Remove  
Next Screen  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Keypad Maps B-67  
Table B-16. VT/HP Character Map  
Char  
Key Sequence  
^@  
^A  
^B  
^C  
^D  
^E  
^F  
<Ctrl><A>  
<Ctrl><B>  
<Ctrl><C>  
<Ctrl><D>  
<Ctrl><E>  
<Ctrl><F>  
<Ctrl><G>  
<Ctrl><H>  
<Ctrl><I>  
<Ctrl><J>  
<Ctrl><K>  
<Ctrl><L>  
<Ctrl><M>  
<Ctrl><N>  
<Ctrl><O>  
<Ctrl><P>  
<Ctrl><Q>  
<Ctrl><R>  
<Ctrl><S>  
<Ctrl><T>  
<Ctrl><U>  
<Ctrl><V>  
^G  
^H  
^I  
^J  
^K  
^L  
^M  
^N  
^O  
^P  
^Q  
^R  
^S  
^T  
^U  
^V  
^W  
^X  
^Y  
<Ctrl><W>  
<Ctrl><X>  
<Ctrl><Y>  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
B-68 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Table B-16. VT/HP Character Map  
Char  
Key Sequence  
^Z  
ESC  
^\  
<Ctrl><Z>  
<ESC>  
<Ctrl><1>  
<Ctrl><2>  
<Ctrl><3>  
<Ctrl><4>  
<space>  
^]  
^^  
^_  
Space  
!
<Func><Q>  
<Shift><Func><C>  
<Ctrl><6>  
<Ctrl><7>  
<Ctrl><8>  
<Ctrl><9>  
<Func><C>  
<Ctrl><0>  
<Func><Ctrl><A>  
<*>  
"
#
$
%
&
'
(
)
*
+
,
<Func><S>  
<Func><A>  
<Func><T>  
<.>  
-
.
/
<Func><V>  
<0>  
0
1
2
3
4
<1>  
<2>  
<3>  
<4>  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Keypad Maps B-69  
Table B-16. VT/HP Character Map  
Char  
Key Sequence  
5
6
7
8
9
:
<5>  
<6>  
<7>  
<8>  
<9>  
<Func><P>  
<Func><R>  
<Func><K>  
<Func><W>  
<Func><L>  
<Func><Ctrl><G>  
<Func><Ctrl><B>  
<Shift><A>  
<Shift><B>  
<Shift><C>  
<Shift><D>  
<Shift><E>  
<Shift><F>  
<Shift><G>  
<Shift><H>  
<Shift><I>  
;
<
=
>
?
@
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
<Shift><J>  
<Shift><K>  
<Shift><L>  
<Shift><M>  
<Shift><N>  
<Shift><O>  
M
N
O
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
B-70 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Table B-16. VT/HP Character Map  
Char  
Key Sequence  
<Shift><P>  
P
Q
R
S
T
U
V
W
X
Y
Z
[
<Shift><Q>  
<Shift><R>  
<Shift><S>  
<Shift><T>  
<Shift><U>  
<Shift><V>  
<Shift><W>  
<Shift><X>  
<Shift><Y>  
<Shift><Z>  
<Func><E>  
<Func><G>  
<Func><F>  
<Func><Ctrl><E>  
<Shift><Func><N>  
<Func><J>  
<A>  
\
]
^
_
`
a
b
c
d
e
f
<B>  
<C>  
<D>  
<E>  
<F>  
g
h
I
<G>  
<H>  
<I>  
j
<J>  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Keypad Maps B-71  
Table B-16. VT/HP Character Map  
Char  
Key Sequence  
k
l
<K>  
<L>  
m
n
o
p
q
r
<M>  
<N>  
<O>  
<P>  
<Q>  
<R>  
<S>  
<T>  
<U>  
<V>  
<W>  
<X>  
<Y>  
<Z>  
s
t
u
v
w
x
y
z
{
<Shift><Func><E>  
<Func><O>  
|
}
<Shift><Func><F>  
<Shift><Func><J>  
~
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
B-72 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
28-Key Keypad (MC9000-S)  
The 28-key keypad contains a Power button, application keys, scroll keys and a function key. See  
Table B-3 for key functions and Table B-4 for the keypad mappings. The mapping functions include:  
28-key functions  
28-key character map.  
ALT  
CTRL  
SPACE  
ALPHA  
ABC  
2
DEF  
3
BKSP  
SHIFT  
1
GHI  
4
JKL  
5
MNO  
6
PQRS  
TUV  
WXYZ  
7
8
9
0
#
Figure B-7. MC9000-S: 28-Key Keypad  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Keypad Maps B-73  
Table B-17. MC9000-S: 28-Key Functions  
Local Function  
Display Backlight On/Off  
Key Sequence  
<Func><#>  
Keypad Backlight On/Off  
Contrast +  
<Func><0>  
<Func><1>  
<Func><4>  
<Func><3>  
<Func><6>  
Contrast -  
Volume +  
Volume -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
B-74 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Table B-18. MC9000-S: 28 Key Keypad Mapping  
Key  
1
49  
49  
42  
*
106  
1
*
*
* See Table 2-7 on page 2-23 for keypad special functions.  
Note: Blank lines are provided to allow the application developer to use this table as a keypad mapping worksheet.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Keypad Maps B-75  
Table B-18. MC9000-S: 28 Key Keypad Mapping (Continued)  
Key  
2
50  
50  
97  
98  
99  
ABC  
2
a
65  
66  
67  
b
c
A
160+65 65  
160+66 66  
160+67 67  
B
C
* See Table 2-7 on page 2-23 for keypad special functions.  
Note: Blank lines are provided to allow the application developer to use this table as a keypad mapping worksheet.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
B-76 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Table B-18. MC9000-S: 28 Key Keypad Mapping (Continued)  
Key  
3
51  
68  
69  
70  
51  
DEF  
3
d
100  
101  
102  
e
f
D
160+68 68  
160+69 69  
160+70 70  
E
F
*
*
* See Table 2-7 on page 2-23 for keypad special functions.  
Note: Blank lines are provided to allow the application developer to use this table as a keypad mapping worksheet.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Keypad Maps B-77  
Table B-18. MC9000-S: 28 Key Keypad Mapping (Continued)  
Key  
4
52  
52  
GHI  
4
g
71  
72  
73  
103  
104  
105  
h
i
G
160+71 71  
160+72 72  
160+73 73  
H
I
*
*
* See Table 2-7 on page 2-23 for keypad special functions.  
Note: Blank lines are provided to allow the application developer to use this table as a keypad mapping worksheet.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
B-78 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Table B-18. MC9000-S: 28 Key Keypad Mapping (Continued)  
Key  
5
53  
74  
75  
76  
53  
JKL  
5
j
106  
107  
108  
k
l
J
160+74 74  
160+75 75  
160+76 76  
K
L
5
53  
53  
61  
=
187  
+
160+187 43  
* See Table 2-7 on page 2-23 for keypad special functions.  
Note: Blank lines are provided to allow the application developer to use this table as a keypad mapping worksheet.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Keypad Maps B-79  
Table B-18. MC9000-S: 28 Key Keypad Mapping (Continued)  
Key  
6
54  
54  
MNO  
6
m
77  
78  
79  
109  
110  
111  
n
o
M
160+77 77  
160+78 78  
160+79 79  
N
O
*
*
* See Table 2-7 on page 2-23 for keypad special functions.  
Note: Blank lines are provided to allow the application developer to use this table as a keypad mapping worksheet.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
B-80 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Table B-18. MC9000-S: 28 Key Keypad Mapping (Continued)  
Key  
7
55  
80  
81  
82  
83  
55  
PQRS  
7
p
112  
113  
114  
115  
q
r
s
P
160+80 80  
160+81 81  
160+82 82  
160+83 83  
Q
R
S
+
107  
43  
+
160+107 43  
* See Table 2-7 on page 2-23 for keypad special functions.  
Note: Blank lines are provided to allow the application developer to use this table as a keypad mapping worksheet.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Keypad Maps B-81  
Table B-18. MC9000-S: 28 Key Keypad Mapping (Continued)  
Key  
8
56  
56  
TUV  
8
t
84  
85  
86  
116  
117  
118  
u
v
T
160+84 84  
160+85 85  
160+86 86  
U
V
-
189  
45  
-
160+189 45  
* See Table 2-7 on page 2-23 for keypad special functions.  
Note: Blank lines are provided to allow the application developer to use this table as a keypad mapping worksheet.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
B-82 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Table B-18. MC9000-S: 28 Key Keypad Mapping (Continued)  
Key  
9
57  
87  
88  
89  
90  
57  
WXYZ  
9
w
119  
120  
121  
122  
x
y
z
W
160+87 87  
160+88 88  
160+89 89  
160+90 90  
X
Y
Z
/
191  
47  
/
160+191 47  
* See Table 2-7 on page 2-23 for keypad special functions.  
Note: Blank lines are provided to allow the application developer to use this table as a keypad mapping worksheet.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Keypad Maps B-83  
Table B-18. MC9000-S: 28 Key Keypad Mapping (Continued)  
Key  
.
190  
46  
*
106  
42  
*
160+106 42  
* See Table 2-7 on page 2-23 for keypad special functions.  
Note: Blank lines are provided to allow the application developer to use this table as a keypad mapping worksheet.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
B-84 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Table B-18. MC9000-S: 28 Key Keypad Mapping (Continued)  
Key  
0
48  
32  
48  
32  
0
*
*
* See Table 2-7 on page 2-23 for keypad special functions.  
Note: Blank lines are provided to allow the application developer to use this table as a keypad mapping worksheet.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Keypad Maps B-85  
Table B-18. MC9000-S: 28 Key Keypad Mapping (Continued)  
Key  
#
160+51 35  
#
*
*
* See Table 2-7 on page 2-23 for keypad special functions.  
Note: Blank lines are provided to allow the application developer to use this table as a keypad mapping worksheet.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
B-86 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Table B-18. MC9000-S: 28 Key Keypad Mapping (Continued)  
Key  
Space  
32  
32  
SPACE  
* See Table 2-7 on page 2-23 for keypad special functions.  
Note: Blank lines are provided to allow the application developer to use this table as a keypad mapping worksheet.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Keypad Maps B-87  
Table B-18. MC9000-S: 28 Key Keypad Mapping (Continued)  
Key  
BKSP  
8
8
BKSP  
* See Table 2-7 on page 2-23 for keypad special functions.  
Note: Blank lines are provided to allow the application developer to use this table as a keypad mapping worksheet.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
B-88 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Table B-18. MC9000-S: 28 Key Keypad Mapping (Continued)  
Key  
Up  
38  
-
* See Table 2-7 on page 2-23 for keypad special functions.  
Note: Blank lines are provided to allow the application developer to use this table as a keypad mapping worksheet.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Keypad Maps B-89  
Table B-18. MC9000-S: 28 Key Keypad Mapping (Continued)  
Key  
Down  
40  
-
* See Table 2-7 on page 2-23 for keypad special functions.  
Note: Blank lines are provided to allow the application developer to use this table as a keypad mapping worksheet.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
B-90 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Table B-18. MC9000-S: 28 Key Keypad Mapping (Continued)  
Key  
Right  
39  
-
* See Table 2-7 on page 2-23 for keypad special functions.  
Note: Blank lines are provided to allow the application developer to use this table as a keypad mapping worksheet.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Keypad Maps B-91  
Table B-18. MC9000-S: 28 Key Keypad Mapping (Continued)  
Key  
Left  
37  
-
* See Table 2-7 on page 2-23 for keypad special functions.  
Note: Blank lines are provided to allow the application developer to use this table as a keypad mapping worksheet.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
B-92 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Glossary  
802.11/802.11b  
A radio protocol that may be used by the Symbol  
Spectrum24 radio card. Symbol radio cards that use the  
802.11 protocol also have an ESS_ID.  
ACK/NAK  
ACK/NAK is the default software handshaking.  
Access Point  
Access Point (AP) refers to Symbol’s Spectrum24 Ethernet  
Access Point. It is a piece of communications equipment  
that manages communications between the host computer  
system and one or more wireless terminals. An AP connects  
to a wired Ethernet LAN and acts as a bridge between the  
Ethernet wired network and IEEE 802.11 interoperable  
radio-equipped mobile units, such as a mobile computer.  
The AP allows a mobile user to roam freely through a  
facility while maintaining a seamless connection to the  
wired network.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
GL-2 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
®
®
AirBEAM Manager  
AirBEAM Manager is a comprehensive wireless network  
management system that provides essential functions that  
are required to configure, monitor, upgrade and  
®
troubleshoot the Spectrum24 wireless network and its  
components (including networked mobile computers).  
Some features include event notification, access point  
configuration, diagnostics, statistical reports, auto-  
discovery, wireless proxy agents and monitoring of access  
points and mobile units.  
®
AirBEAM Smart Client  
AirBEAM® Smart Client is part of Symbol’s AirBEAM®  
suite, which also includes AirBEAM® Safe and AirBEAM®  
Manager. The AirBEAM® Smart Client system uses the  
network accessible host server to store software files that  
are to be downloaded to the mobile computers. The  
AirBEAM® Smart Client provides the mobile computers  
with the "smarts" to request software from the host. It  
allows them to request, download and install software, as  
well as to upload files and status data. The AirBEAM®  
Smart Client uses the industry standard FTP or TFTP file  
transfer protocols to check the host system for updates, and  
if necessary, to transfer updated software. Most often,  
AirBEAM® Smart Client is used with wireless networks,  
but any TCP/IP connection can be used. For more  
information, refer to the AirBEAM® Smart Windows® CE  
Client Product Reference Guide (p/n 72-63060-xx).  
AP  
See Access Point.  
API  
An interface by means of which one software component  
communicates with or controls another. Usually used to  
refer to services provided by one software component to  
another, usually via software interrupts or function calls  
Aperture  
The opening in an optical system defined by a lens or baffle  
that establishes the field of view.  
Application Programming Interface  
ANSI Terminal  
See API.  
A display terminal that follows commands in the ANSI  
standard terminal language. For example, it uses escape  
sequences to control the cursor, clear the screen and set  
colors. Communications programs support the ANSI  
terminal mode and often default to this terminal emulation  
for dial-up connections to online services.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Glossary GL-3  
ASCII  
American Standard Code for Information Interchange. A 7  
bit-plus-parity code representing 128 letters, numerals,  
punctuation marks and control characters. It is a standard  
data transmission code in the U.S.  
Autodiscrimination  
The ability of an interface controller to determine the code  
type of a scanned bar code. After this determination is  
made, the information content is decoded.  
Bar  
The dark element in a printed bar code symbol.  
Bar Code  
A pattern of variable-width bars and spaces which  
represents numeric or alphanumeric data in machine-  
readable form. The general format of a bar code symbol  
consists of a leading margin, start character, data or  
message character, check character (if any), stop character,  
and trailing margin. Within this framework, each  
recognizable symbology uses its own unique format. See  
Symbology.  
Bar Code Density  
Bar Height  
The number of characters represented per unit of  
measurement (e.g., characters per inch).  
The dimension of a bar measured perpendicular to the bar  
width.  
Bar Width  
Thickness of a bar measured from the edge closest to the  
symbol start character to the trailing edge of the same bar.  
Baud Rate  
A measure of the data flow or number of signaling events  
occurring per second. When one bit is the standard "event,"  
this is a measure of bits per second (bps). For example, a  
baud rate of 50 means transmission of 50 bits of data per  
second.  
BIOS  
Bit  
Basic Input Output System. A collection of ROM-based  
code with a standard API used to interface with standard  
PC hardware.  
Binary digit. One bit is the basic unit of binary information.  
Generally, eight consecutive bits compose one byte of data.  
The pattern of 0 and 1 values within the byte determines its  
meaning.  
Bits per Second (bps)  
Bits transmitted or received.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
GL-4 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Bit  
Binary digit. One bit is the basic unit of binary information.  
Generally, eight consecutive bits compose one byte of data.  
The pattern of 0 and 1 values within the byte determines its  
meaning.  
bps  
See Bits Per Second.  
Byte  
On an addressable boundary, eight adjacent binary digits (0  
and 1) combined in a pattern to represent a specific  
character or numeric value. Bits are numbered from the  
right, 0 through 7, with bit 0 the low-order bit. One byte in  
memory is used to store one ASCII character.  
BOOTP  
A protocol for remote booting of diskless devices. Assigns  
an IP address to a machine and may specify a boot file. The  
client sends a bootp request as a broadcast to the bootp  
server port (67) and the bootp server responds using the  
bootp client port (68). The bootp server must have a table of  
all devices, associated MAC addresses and IP addresses.  
boot or boot-up  
The process a computer goes through when it starts. During  
boot-up, the computer can run self-diagnostic tests and  
configure hardware and software.  
CDMA  
CDRH  
Code Division Multiple Access is a cellular technology  
originally know as IS-95.  
Center for Devices and Radiological Health. A federal  
agency responsible for regulating laser product safety. This  
agency specifies various laser operation classes based on  
power output during operation.  
CDRH Class 1  
CDRH Class 2  
This is the lowest power CDRH laser classification. This  
class is considered intrinsically safe, even if all laser output  
were directed into the eye's pupil. There are no special  
operating procedures for this class.  
No additional software mechanisms are needed to conform  
to this limit. Laser operation in this class poses no danger  
for unintentional direct human exposure.  
Cellular Digital Packet Data  
Character  
See CDPD.  
A pattern of bars and spaces which either directly  
represents data or indicates a control function, such as a  
number, letter, punctuation mark, or communications  
control contained in a message.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Glossary GL-5  
Character Set  
Check Digit  
Those characters available for encoding in a particular bar  
code symbology.  
A digit used to verify a correct symbol decode. The scanner  
inserts the decoded data into an arithmetic formula and  
checks that the resulting number matches the encoded  
check digit. Check digits are required for UPC but are  
optional for other symbologies. Using check digits  
decreases the chance of substitution errors when a symbol  
is decoded.  
Codabar  
A discrete self-checking code with a character set  
consisting of digits 0 to 9 and six additional characters: ( -  
$ : / , +).  
Code 128  
A high density symbology which allows the controller to  
encode all 128 ASCII characters without adding extra  
symbol elements.  
Code 3 of 9 (Code 39)  
A versatile and widely used alphanumeric bar code  
symbology with a set of 43 character types, including all  
uppercase letters, numerals from 0 to 9 and 7 special  
characters (- . / + % $ and space). The code name is derived  
from the fact that 3 of 9 elements representing a character  
are wide, while the remaining 6 are narrow.  
Code 93  
An industrial symbology compatible with Code 39 but  
offering a full character ASCII set and a higher coding  
density than Code 39.  
Code Length  
Cold Boot  
Number of data characters in a bar code between the start  
and stop characters, not including those characters.  
A cold boot restarts the mobile computer and erases all  
user stored records and entries.  
COM port  
Communication port; ports are identified by number, e.g.,  
COM1, COM2.  
Continuous Code  
A bar code or symbol in which all spaces within the symbol  
are parts of characters. There are no intercharacter gaps in  
a continuous code. The absence of gaps allows for greater  
information density.  
Cradle  
A cradle is used for charging the terminal battery and for  
communicating with a host computer, and provides a  
storage place for the terminal when not in use.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
GL-6 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Data Communications Equipment (DCE)  
A device (such as a modem) which is designed to attach  
directly to a DTE (Data Terminal Equipment) device.  
See Data Communications Equipment.  
See Device COnfiguration Package.  
DCE  
DCP  
Dead Zone  
An area within a scanner's field of view, in which specular  
reflection may prevent a successful decode.  
Decode  
To recognize a bar code symbology (e.g., UPC/EAN) and  
then analyze the content of the specific bar code scanned.  
Decode Algorithm  
A decoding scheme that converts pulse widths into data  
representation of the letters or numbers encoded within a  
bar code symbol.  
Decryption  
Decryption is the decoding and unscrambling of received  
encrypted data. Also see, Encryption and Key.  
Depth of Field  
The range between minimum and maximum distances at  
which a scanner can read a symbol with a certain minimum  
element width.  
Device Configuration Package  
The Symbol Device Configuration Pacage provides the  
Product Reference Guide (PRG), flash partitions, Terminal  
Configuration Manager (TCM) and the associated TCM  
scripts. With this package hex images that represent flash  
partitions can be created and downloaded to the mobile  
computer.  
DHCP  
(Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol) Software that  
automatically assigns IP addresses to client stations  
logging onto a TCP/IP network. Similar to BOOTP, but also  
permits the leasing of an IP address. It eliminates having to  
manually assign permanent IP addresses. DHCP software  
typically runs in servers and is also found in network  
devices such as routers that allow multiple users access to  
the Internet.  
DHCP Server  
Discrete Code  
A server in the network or a service within a server that  
assigns IP addresses.  
A bar code or symbol in which the spaces between  
characters (intercharacter gaps) are not part of the code.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Glossary GL-7  
Discrete 2 of 5  
DNS Server  
A binary bar code symbology representing each character  
by a group of five bars, two of which are wide. The location  
of wide bars in the group determines which character is  
encoded; spaces are insignificant. Only numeric characters  
(0 to 9) and START/STOP characters may be encoded.  
The Control Panel allows you to set the IP address for a  
DNS Server, if used. This allows users to use server names,  
rather than IP addresses. It is set on the Network tab of the  
Control Panel.  
Domain Name  
DOS  
The Control Panel allows you to set a Domain Name for the  
DNS Server, if used (e.g., symbol.com). It is set on the  
Network tab of the Control Panel.  
Disk Operating System. This is basic software that allows  
you to load and use software applications on your  
computer. Also see NetID.  
DRAM  
DTE  
Dynamic random access memory.  
See Data Terminal Equipment.  
EAN  
European Article Number. This European/International  
version of the UPC provides its own coding format and  
symbology standards. Element dimensions are specified  
metrically. EAN is used primarily in retail.  
Element  
Generic term for a bar or space.  
Encoded Area  
Total linear dimension occupied by all characters of a code  
pattern, including start/stop characters and data.  
ENQ (RS-232)  
Encryption  
ENQ software handshaking is also supported for the data  
sent to the host.  
Encryption is the scrambling and coding of data, typically  
using mathematical formulas called algorithms, before  
information is transmitted over any communications link or  
network. A key is the specific code used by the algorithm to  
encrypt or decrypt the data. Also see, Decryption and Key.  
ESD  
Electro-Static Discharge  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
GL-8 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
ESS_ID  
Extended Service Set Identifier, defines the coverage area.  
Prior to the release of the 802.11 specification the ESS_ID  
was called the Net_ID or Network Identifier. For terminals  
using Spectrum24 radios with the 802.11 protocol, an  
ESS_ID allows facilities to limit which Access Points a  
mobile computer can communicate with. It is set on the  
Network tab of the Control Panel. The terminal can only  
communicate with Spectrum24 Access Points that have  
matching ESS_IDs.  
Ethernet  
Ethernet communication port. Allows a wired interface to a  
radio network.  
Flash Disk  
Flash Memory  
An additional megabyte of non-volatile memory for storing  
application and configuration files.  
Flash memory is nonvolatile, semi-permanent storage that  
can be electronically erased in the circuit and  
reprogrammed. Series 9000 mobile computers use Flash  
memory to store the operating system (ROM-DOS), the  
terminal emulators, and the Citrix ICA Client for DOS.  
File Transfer Protocol (FTP)  
Frequency Hopping  
A TCP/IP application protocol governing file transfer via  
network or telephone lines. See TCP/IP.  
The use of a random sequence of frequency channels to  
achieve spread spectrum compliance. Stations that use  
frequency hopping change their communications frequency  
at regular intervals. A hopping sequence determines the  
pattern at which frequencies are changed. Messages take  
place within a hop. See Hopping Sequence and Spread  
Spectrum.  
FTP  
See File Transfer Protocol.  
Flash Memory  
Flash memory is responsible for storing the system  
firmware and is non-volatile. If the system power is  
interrupted the data is not lost.  
Gateway Address  
An IP address for a network gateway or router. A mobile  
computer may be part of a subnet as specified by its IP  
address and Netmask. It can send packets directly to any  
node on the same subnet. If the destination node is on a  
different subnet, then the terminal sends the packet to the  
gateway first. The gateway determines how to route the  
packet to the destination subnet. This field is an option  
used by networks that require gateways.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Glossary GL-9  
Hard Reset  
See Cold Boot.  
Hopping Sequence  
A set of random frequencies designed to minimize  
interference with other sets of random frequencies. A  
hopping sequence determines the pattern with which a  
station that uses frequency hopping changes its  
communications frequency. See Frequency Hopping.  
Hz  
Hertz; A unit of frequency equal to one cycle per second.  
Host Computer  
A computer that serves other terminals in a network,  
providing such services as computation, database access,  
supervisory programs and network control.  
IDE  
IEC  
Intelligent drive electronics. Refers to the solid-state hard  
drive type.  
International Electrotechnical Commission. This  
international agency regulates laser safety by specifying  
various laser operation classes based on power output  
during operation.  
IEC (825) Class 1  
This is the lowest power IEC laser classification.  
Conformity is ensured through a software restriction of 120  
seconds of laser operation within any 1000 second window  
and an automatic laser shutdown if the scanner's  
oscillating mirror fails.  
IEEE Address  
See MAC Address.  
Interleaved 2 of 5  
A binary bar code symbology representing character pairs  
in groups of five bars and five interleaved spaces.  
Interleaving provides for greater information density. The  
location of wide elements (bar/spaces) within each  
group determines which characters are encoded. This  
continuous code type uses no intercharacter spaces. Only  
numeric (0 to 9) and START/STOP characters may be  
encoded.  
IOCTL  
Input/Output Control.  
Internet Protocol.  
IP  
imaging scanning  
Mobile computers with an integrated imager use digital  
camera technology to take a digital picture of a bar code,  
store the resulting image in memory and execute state-of-  
the-art software decoding algorithms to extract the data  
from the image.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
GL-10 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Intercharacter Gap  
The space between two adjacent bar code characters in a  
discrete code.  
Interleaved Bar Code  
A bar code in which characters are paired together, using  
bars to represent the first character and the intervening  
spaces to represent the second.  
Interleaved 2 of 5  
A binary bar code symbology representing character pairs  
in groups of five bars and five interleaved spaces.  
Interleaving provides for greater information density. The  
location of wide elements (bar/spaces) within each group  
determines which characters are encoded. This continuous  
code type uses no intercharacter spaces. Only numeric (0 to  
9) and START/STOP characters may be encoded.  
Internet Protocol Address  
I/O Ports  
See IP.  
interface The connection between two devices, defined by  
common physical characteristics, signal characteristics,  
and signal meanings. Types of interfaces include RS-232  
and PCMCIA.  
Input/Output Ports  
IP  
I/O ports are primarily dedicated to passing information  
into or out of the terminal’s memory. Series 9000 mobile  
computers include Serial and USB ports.  
(Internet Protocol) The IP part of the TCP/IP communications  
protocol. IP implements the network layer (layer 3) of the  
protocol, which contains a network address and is used to  
route a message to a different network or subnetwork. IP  
accepts “packets” from the layer 4 transport protocol (TCP  
or UDP), adds its own header to it and delivers a  
“datagram” to the layer 2 data link protocol. It may also  
break the packet into fragments to support the maximum  
transmission unit (MTU) of the network.  
IP Address  
(Internet Protocol address) The address of a computer  
attached to an IP network. Every client and server station  
must have a unique IP address. A 32-bit address used by a  
computer on a IP network. Client workstations have either  
a permanent address or one that is dynamically assigned to  
them each session. IP addresses are written as four sets of  
numbers separated by periods; for example, 204.171.64.2.  
IPX/SPX  
Internet Package Exchange/Sequential Packet Exchange. A  
communications protocol for Novell. IPX is Novell’s Layer 3  
protocol, similar to XNS and IP, and used in NetWare  
networks. SPX is Novell's version of the Xerox SPP protocol.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Glossary GL-11  
Kerberos  
Kerberos is a network authentication protocol. It is  
designed to provide strong authentication for client/server  
applications by using secret-key cryptography. A free  
implementation of this protocol is available from the  
Massachusetts Institute of Technology. Kerberos is  
available in many commercial products as well.  
Key  
A key is the specific code used by the algorithm to encrypt  
or decrypt the data. Also see, Encryption and Decrypting.  
LAN  
Local area network. A radio network that supports data  
communication within a local area, such as within a  
warehouse of building.  
laser scanner  
LASER  
A type of bar code reader that uses a beam of laser light.  
Light Amplification by Stimulated Emission of  
Radiation.The laser is an intense light source. Light from a  
laser is all the same frequency, unlike the output of an  
incandescent bulb. Laser light is typically coherent and has  
a high energy density.  
Laser Diode  
A gallium-arsenide semiconductor type of laser connected  
to a power source to generate a laser beam. This laser type  
is a compact source of coherent light.  
LCD  
See Liquid Crystal Display.  
LED Indicator  
A semiconductor diode (LED - Light Emitting Diode) used as  
an indicator, often in digital displays. The semiconductor  
uses applied voltage to produce light of a certain frequency  
determined by the semiconductor's particular chemical  
composition.  
Liquid Crystal Display (LCD)  
A display that uses liquid crystal sealed between two glass  
plates. The crystals are excited by precise electrical  
charges, causing them to reflect light outside according to  
their bias. They use little electricity and react relatively  
quickly. They require external light to reflect their  
information to the user.  
Light Emitting Diode  
See LED.  
®
MAC Address (also called IEEE Address)  
Spectrum24 devices, like other Ethernet devices, have  
unique, hardware-encoded MAC (also called IEEE  
addresses). MAC addresses determine the device sending  
or receiving data. The MAC address is a 48-bit number  
written as six hexadecimal bytes separated by colons.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
GL-12 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
MC  
Mobile Computer.  
MIL  
1 mil = 1 thousandth of an inch.  
Misread (Misdecode)  
A condition which occurs when the data output of a reader  
or interface controller does not agree with the data  
encoded within a bar code symbol.  
Mobile Computer  
In this text, mobile computer refers to the Symbol Series  
9000 wireless portable computer. It can be set up to run  
as a stand-alone device, or it can be set up to communicate  
with a network, using wireless radio technology.  
NCU  
Network Control Unit.  
NetBeui  
A non-routable LAN protocol that is an extension to  
NetBIOS. Used for IBM’s OS/2-based LAN Manager and  
Microsoft’s LAN Manager and Windows for Workgroups.  
NetID  
For terminals using Spectrum24 radios with the Spring  
protocol, a NetID allows facilities to limit which Access  
Points a mobile computer can communicate with. It is set  
on the Network tab of the Control Panel. The terminal can  
only communicate with Spectrum24 Access Points that  
have matching NetIDs. Also see ESS_ID.  
Nominal  
The exact (or ideal) intended value for a specified  
parameter. Tolerances are specified as positive and  
negative deviations from this value.  
Nominal Size  
Null Modem Cable  
Standard size for a bar code symbol. Most UPC/EAN codes  
are used over a range of magnifications (e.g., from 0.80 to  
2.00 of nominal).  
An RS-232 cable used to connect two personal computers  
together in close proximity for file transfer. It attaches to  
the serial ports of both machines and simulates what would  
occur naturally if modems and the phone system were  
used. It crosses the sending wire with the receiving wire.  
NVM  
ODI  
Non-Volatile Memory.  
See Open Data-Link Interface.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Glossary GL-13  
Open Data-Link Interface (ODI)  
Novells driver specification for an interface between  
network hardware and higher-level protocols. It supports  
multiple protocols on a single NIC (Network Interface  
Controller). It is capable of understanding and translating  
any network information or request sent by any other ODI-  
compatible protocol into something a NetWare client can  
understand and process.  
Open System Authentication  
PAN  
Open System authentication is a null authentication  
algorithm.  
Personal area network. Using Bluetooth wireless  
technology, PANs enable devices to communicate  
wirelessly. Generally, a wireless PAN consists of a dynamic  
group of less than 255 devices that communicate within  
about a 33-foot range. Only devices within this limited area  
typically participate in the network.  
Parameter  
PC Card  
A variable that can have different values assigned to it.  
A plug-in expansion card for laptop computers and other  
devices, also called a PCMCIA card. PC Cards are 85.6mm  
long x 54 mm wide, and have a 68 pin connector. There are  
several different kinds:  
Type I; 3.3 mm high; use - RAM or Flash RAM  
Type II; 5 mm high; use - modems, LAN adaptors  
Type III; 10.5 high; use - Hard Disks  
PCMCIA  
Personal Computer Memory Card Interface Association.  
See PC Card.  
PDT  
Portable Data Terminal.  
Percent Decode  
The average probability that a single scan of a bar code  
would result in a successful decode. In a well-designed bar  
code scanning system, that probability should approach  
near 100%.  
PING  
(Packet Internet Groper) An Internet utility used to  
determine whether a particular IP address is online. It is  
used to test and debug a network by sending out a packet  
and waiting for a response.  
Print Contrast Signal (PCS)  
Measurement of the contrast (brightness difference)  
between the bars and spaces of a symbol. A minimum PCS  
value is needed for a bar code symbol to be scannable. PCS  
= (RL - RD) / RL, where RL is the reflectance factor of the  
background and RD the reflectance factor of the dark bars.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
GL-14 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Programming Mode  
Quiet Zone  
The state in which a scanner is configured for parameter  
values. See Scanning Mode.  
A clear space, containing no dark marks, which precedes  
the start character of a bar code symbol and follows the  
stop character.  
QWERTY  
A standard keyboard commonly used on North American  
and some European PC keyboards. “QWERTY” refers to the  
arrangement of keys on the left side of the third row of  
keys.  
RAM  
Random Access Memory. Data in RAM can be accessed in  
random order, and quickly written and read.  
Reflectance  
Resolution  
Amount of light returned from an illuminated surface.  
The narrowest element dimension which is distinguished  
by a particular reading device or printed with a particular  
device or method.  
RF  
Radio Frequency.  
ROM  
Read-Only Memory. Data stored in ROM cannot be changed  
or removed.  
ROM-DOS  
Router  
The name of the licensed Disk Operating System loaded  
into the terminals flash file system.  
A device that connects networks and supports the required  
protocols for packet filtering. Routers are typically used to  
extend the range of cabling and to organize the topology of  
a network into subnets. See Subnet.  
RS-232  
An Electronic Industries Association (EIA) standard that  
defines the connector, connector pins, and signals used to  
transfer data serially from one device to another.  
Scan Area  
Scanner  
Area intended to contain a symbol.  
An electronic device used to scan bar code symbols and  
produce a digitized pattern that corresponds to the bars and  
spaces of the symbol. Its three main components are:  
1. Light source (laser or photoelectric cell) - illuminates a  
bar code.  
2. Photodetector - registers the difference in reflected light  
(more light reflected from spaces).  
3. Signal conditioning circuit - transforms optical detector  
output into a digitized bar pattern.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Glossary GL-15  
Scanning Mode  
The scanner is energized, programmed and ready to read a  
bar code.  
Scanning Sequence  
A method of programming or configuring parameters for a  
bar code reading system by scanning bar code menus.  
SMDK  
Software MobilityDevelopment Kit  
Self-Checking Code  
A symbology that uses a checking algorithm to detect  
encoding errors within the characters of a bar code symbol.  
Shared Key  
Shared Key authentication is an algorithm where both the  
AP and the MU share an authentication key.  
SHIP  
Symbol Host Interface Program.  
Symbol Mobility Developer Kit.  
See Warm Boot.  
SMDK  
Soft Reset  
Space  
The lighter element of a bar code formed by the background  
between bars.  
Spectrum24  
Symbols frequency-hopping, spread spectrum cellular  
network.  
Spectrum One  
Symbols implementation of the Spread Spectrum wireless  
network, utilizing direct sequencing.  
Specular Reflection  
Spread Spectrum  
The mirror-like direct reflection of light from a surface,  
which can cause difficulty decoding a bar code.  
A technique for uniformly distributing the information  
content of a radio signal over a frequency range larger than  
normally required for robust transmission of data.  
Spreading the signal without adding additional information  
adds significant redundancy, which allows the data to be  
recovered in the presence of strong interfering signals such  
as noise and jamming signals. The primary advantage of  
spread spectrum technology is its ability to provide robust  
communications in the presence of interfering signals.  
Spring Radio Protocol  
Start/Stop Character  
A radio protocol that may be used by the Symbol  
Spectrum24 radio card. Symbol Radio cards that use the  
Spring protocol also have an Net ID.  
A pattern of bars and spaces that provides the scanner with  
start and stop reading instructions and scanning direction.  
The start and stop characters are normally to the left and  
right margins of a horizontal code.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
GL-16 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
STEP  
Symbol Terminal Enabler Program.  
Subnet  
A subset of nodes on a network that are serviced by the  
same router. See Router.  
Subnet Mask  
A 32-bit number used to separate the network and host  
sections of an IP address. A custom subnet mask subdivides  
an IP network into smaller subsections. The mask is a  
binary pattern that is matched up with the IP address to turn  
part of the host ID address field into a field for subnets.  
Default is often 255.255.255.0.  
Substrate  
A foundation material on which a substance or image is  
placed.  
SVTP  
Symbol Virtual Terminal Program.  
Symbol  
A scannable unit that encodes data within the conventions  
of a certain symbology, usually including start/stop  
characters, quiet zones, data characters and check  
characters.  
Symbol Aspect Ratio  
Symbol Height  
The ratio of symbol height to symbol width.  
The distance between the outside edges of the quiet zones  
of the first row and the last row.  
Symbol Length  
Symbology  
Length of symbol measured from the beginning of the quiet  
zone (margin) adjacent to the start character to the end of  
the quiet zone (margin) adjacent to a stop character.  
The structural rules and conventions for representing data  
within a particular bar code type (e.g. UPC/EAN, Code 39,  
PDF417, etc.).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Glossary GL-17  
TCP/IP  
(Transmission Control Protocol/Internet Protocol) A  
communications protocol used to internetwork dissimilar  
systems. This standard is the protocol of the Internet and  
has become the global standard for communications. TCP  
provides transport functions, which ensures that the total  
amount of bytes sent is received correctly at the other end.  
UDP is an alternate transport that does not guarantee  
delivery. It is widely used for real-time voice and video  
transmissions where erroneous packets are not  
retransmitted. IP provides the routing mechanism. TCP/IP is  
a routable protocol, which means that all messages contain  
not only the address of the destination station, but the  
address of a destination network. This allows TCP/IP  
messages to be sent to multiple networks within an  
organization or around the world, hence its use in the  
worldwide Internet. Every client and server in a TCP/IP  
network requires an IP address, which is either  
permanently assigned or dynamically assigned at startup.  
Telnet  
A terminal emulation protocol commonly used on the  
Internet and TCP/IP-based networks. It allows a user at a  
terminal or computer to log onto a remote device and run a  
program.  
Terminal  
See Mobile Computer.  
Terminate and Stay Resident (TSR)  
A program under DOS that ends its foreground execution to  
remain resident in memory to service hardware/software  
interrupts, providing background operation. It remains in  
memory and may provide services on behalf of other DOS  
programs.  
Terminal Emulation  
A “terminal emulation” emulates a character-based  
mainframe session on a remote non-mainframe terminal,  
including all display features, commands and function keys.  
The MC9000 Series supports Terminal Emulations in 3270,  
5250 and VT220.  
TFTP  
(Trivial File Transfer Protocol) A version of the TCP/IP FTP  
(File Transfer Protocol) protocol that has no directory or  
password capability. It is the protocol used for upgrading  
firmware, downloading software and remote booting of  
diskless devices.  
Tolerance  
Allowable deviation from the nominal bar or space width.  
Transmission Control Protocol/Internet Protocol See TCP/IP.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
GL-18 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Trivial File Transfer Protocol  
See TFTP.  
TSR  
UPC  
See Terminate and Stay Resident.  
Universal Product Code. A relatively complex numeric  
symbology. Each character consists of two bars and two  
spaces, each of which is any of four widths. The standard  
symbology for retail food packages in the United States.  
UDP  
User Datagram Protocol. A protocol within the IP protocol  
suite that is used in place of TCP when a reliable delivery is  
not required. For example, UDP is used for real-time audio  
and video traffic where lost packets are simply ignored,  
because there is no time to retransmit. If UDP is used and a  
reliable delivery is required, packet sequence checking and  
error notification must be written into the applications.  
Visible Laser Diode (VLD)  
WAN  
A solid state device which produces visible laser light.  
Wide-Area Network. A radio network that supports data  
communication beyond a local area. That is, information  
can be sent across a city, state, or even nationwide.  
Warm Boot  
A warm boot restarts the mobile computer by closing all  
running programs. All data that is not saved to flash  
memory is lost.  
WEP  
Wired Equivalent Privacy, is specified by IEEE for encryption  
and decryption of RF (wireless) communications.  
WEP Encryption  
(Wired Equivalent Privacy encryption) The conversion of  
data into a secret code for transmission over a public  
network. The original text, or plaintext, is converted into a  
coded equivalent called ciphertext via an encryption  
algorithm. The ciphertext is decoded (decrypted) at the  
receiving end and turned back into plaintext. The encryption  
algorithm uses a key, which is a binary number that is  
typically from 40 to 128 bits in length. The greater the  
number of bits in the key (cipher strength), the more  
possible key combinations and the longer it would take to  
break the code. The data is encrypted, or “locked,” by  
combining the bits in the key mathematically with the data  
bits. At the receiving end, the key is used to “unlock” the  
code and restore the original data.  
Wireless Local Area Network (WLAN)  
Wireless Wide Area Network (WWAN)  
See LAN.  
See WAN.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Glossary GL-19  
WNMP  
(Wireless Network Management Protocol) This is Symbols  
proprietary MAC layer protocol used for inter access point  
communication and other MAC layer communication.  
®
®
WNMS (was renamed to AirBEAM Manager) See AirBEAM Manager.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
GL-20 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
Numerics  
A
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
IN-2 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
single-slot serial cradle  
B
backup battery  
batteries  
battery  
bluetooth  
aiming options  
AirBEAM configuration  
boot  
buttons  
C
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index IN-3  
charging  
cradle  
E
cradles  
F
D
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
IN-4 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
IP config  
G
K
H
L
I
M
imager options  
main battery  
internet  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index IN-5  
mobile computer  
parts  
mode  
PDF417  
pin-outs  
power saving mode  
profile  
programs  
N
O
Q
P
R
partitions  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
IN-6 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
reset  
spare batteries  
Symbol Mobility Developer Kit for .NET, see SMDK for  
S
scripts  
SDK  
setting up a partnership  
single-slot serial cradle  
T
TCM  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index IN-7  
terminal  
V
W
wireless  
U
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
IN-8 MC9000-K/S for Embedded Windows® CE .NET Product Reference Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tell Us What You Think...  
We’d like to know what you think about this Manual. Please take a moment to fill out this  
questionnaire and fax this form to: (631) 738-3318, or mail to:  
Symbol Technologies, Inc.  
One Symbol Plaza M/S B-4  
Holtsville, NY 11742-1300  
Attention: Technical Publications Manager  
IMPORTANT: If you need product support, please call the appropriate customer support  
number provided. Unfortunately, we cannot provide customer support at the fax number  
above.  
Manual Title:___________________________________________  
(please include revision level)  
How familiar were you with this product before using this manual?  
Very familiar  
Slightly familiar  
Not at all familiar  
Did this manual meet your needs? If not, please explain.  
___________________________________________________________  
___________________________________________________________  
What topics need to be added to the index, if applicable?  
___________________________________________________________  
___________________________________________________________  
What topics do you feel need to be better discussed? Please be specific.  
___________________________________________________________  
___________________________________________________________  
What can we do to further improve our manuals?  
___________________________________________________________  
___________________________________________________________  
Thank you for your input—We value your comments.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
72-65262-03  
Revision A — June 2004  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  

Shark Thermometer S3101 User Manual
Sonic Alert Clock Radio SBT600ss User Manual
Sony Computer Monitor SDM N80 User Manual
Sony Digital Camera UPX C300 User Manual
Sony Portable Speaker SRS Z30 Z31 User Manual
Sony Printer UP 610 User Manual
Speco Technologies Microphone UHF 128 User Manual
Star Manufacturing Electric Grill TG1 User Manual
State Industries Electric Heater PR6 40 CBDS User Manual
Swann Security Camera Single Channel Digital Security Recorder User Manual